AMKOR TECHNOLOGY INC
424B4, 1998-05-01
SEMICONDUCTORS & RELATED DEVICES
Previous: AMKOR TECHNOLOGY INC, S-1MEF, 1998-05-01
Next: AMKOR TECHNOLOGY INC, 424B4, 1998-05-01



<PAGE>   1
                                                Filed pursuant to Rule 424(b)(4)
                                                Registration no. 333-37235
 
PROSPECTUS
                               35,000,000 SHARES
 
                                  COMMON STOCK
[AMKOR LOGO]                      $180,000,000
                 5 3/4% CONVERTIBLE SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2003
 
                             AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC.
                               ------------------
 
    Amkor Technology, Inc. ("Amkor" or the "Company") hereby offers 30,000,000
shares of Common Stock, par value $.001 per share ("Common Stock"), and
$180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 5 3/4% Convertible Subordinated Notes
due 2003 (the "Convertible Notes"). In addition, a stockholder of the Company
(the "Selling Stockholder") is hereby offering 5,000,000 shares of Common Stock.
The Convertible Notes will mature on May 1, 2003. Interest on the Convertible
Notes is payable on May 1 and November 1 of each year, commencing November 1,
1998. The Convertible Notes are convertible into shares of Common Stock at any
time on or before the close of business on the last trading day prior to
maturity, unless previously redeemed, at a conversion price of $13.50 per share,
subject to adjustment in certain events as described herein.
 
    The Convertible Notes are subordinated in right of payment to all existing
and future Senior Debt (as defined) of the Company and effectively subordinated
to all existing and future liabilities and obligations of the Company's
subsidiaries. The Convertible Notes are not redeemable by the Company prior to
May 3, 2001. On or after May 3, 2001, the Convertible Notes are redeemable, in
whole or from time to time in part, at the option of the Company, at the
redemption prices set forth herein plus accrued interest, if the closing price
of the Common Stock is at least 125% of the conversion price for at least 20
trading days within a period of 30 consecutive trading days ending on the fifth
trading day prior to the notice of redemption. No sinking fund is provided for
the Convertible Notes. In addition, following the occurrence of a Designated
Event (i.e., a Change of Control or Termination of Trading (each as defined)),
each holder has the right to cause the Company to purchase the Convertible Notes
at 101% of their principal amount together with accrued and unpaid interest. See
"Description of Convertible Notes."
 
    Of the 35,000,000 shares of Common Stock (the "Shares") and $180,000,000
aggregate principal amount of Convertible Notes offered hereby, 7,000,000 Shares
and $30,000,000 principal amount of Convertible Notes are being offered by the
International Underwriters (as defined) outside the United States and Canada
(the "International Offering") and 28,000,000 Shares and $150,000,000 principal
amount of Convertible Notes are being offered by the U.S. Underwriters (as
defined) in a concurrent offering in the United States and Canada (the "U.S.
Offering" and, together with the International Offering, the "Offerings"),
subject to transfers between the International Underwriters and the U.S.
Underwriters (collectively, the "Underwriters"). The Price to the Public and
Underwriting Discount per Share and per Convertible Note will be identical for
the International Offering and the U.S. Offering. See "Underwriting." The
closing of the International Offering and U.S. Offering are conditioned upon
each other. Following the Offerings, certain members of management and their
family will beneficially own approximately 68.9% of the Company's outstanding
Common Stock. See "Principal and Selling Stockholders."
 
    Prior to the Offerings, there has not been a public market for the Common
Stock or the Convertible Notes. The Common Stock has been approved for listing
on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol "AMKR," subject to official
notice of issuance. The Convertible Notes have been approved for quotation on
the Nasdaq Stock Market under the symbol "AMKRG."
 
      SEE "RISK FACTORS" BEGINNING ON PAGE 9 FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN FACTORS
THAT SHOULD BE CONSIDERED BY PROSPECTIVE PURCHASERS OF THE SHARES AND THE
CONVERTIBLE NOTES.
                               ------------------
  THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
 EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE SECURITIES
   AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE
ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A
                               CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
================================================================================
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          UNDERWRITING                                PROCEEDS TO
                                      PRICE TO           DISCOUNTS AND          PROCEEDS TO             SELLING
                                     THE PUBLIC          COMMISSIONS(1)        THE COMPANY(2)       STOCKHOLDERS(2)
<S>                             <C>                   <C>                   <C>                   <C>
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Per Share.....................         $11.00                 $.66                 $10.34                $10.34
Per Convertible Note..........        100.00%                3.25%                 96.75%                  --
Total Shares..................      $385,000,000          $23,100,000           $310,200,000          $51,700,000
Total Convertible Notes.......      $180,000,000          $ 5,850,000           $174,150,000               --
Total(3)......................      $565,000,000          $28,950,000           $484,350,000          $51,700,000
======================================================================================================================
</TABLE>
 
(1) For information regarding indemnification of the Underwriters, see
    "Underwriting."
 
(2) Before deducting expenses payable by the Company, estimated at $5,000,000.
 
(3) The Company has granted the International Underwriters and the U.S.
    Underwriters 30-day options to purchase up to 1,050,000 and 4,200,000
    additional shares of Common Stock, respectively, and $4,500,000 and
    $22,500,000 additional principal amount of Convertible Notes, respectively,
    solely to cover over-allotments, if any. If such options are exercised in
    full, the total Price to the Public, Underwriting Discounts and Proceeds to
    the Company will be $649,750,000, $33,292,500 and $564,757,500,
    respectively. See "Underwriting."
                               ------------------
 
    The Shares and the Convertible Notes are offered subject to receipt and
acceptance by the Underwriters, to prior sale and to the Underwriters' right to
reject any order in whole or in part and to withdraw, cancel or modify the offer
without notice. It is expected that delivery of the Shares and the Convertible
Notes will be made at the office of Smith Barney Inc., 333 West 34th Street, New
York, New York 10001 or through the facilities of The Depository Trust Company,
on or about May 6, 1998.
                               ------------------
 
SALOMON SMITH BARNEY INTERNATIONAL
                                   BA ROBERTSON STEPHENS INTERNATIONAL LIMITED
                                                        COWEN INTERNATIONAL L.P.
 
April 30, 1998

<PAGE>   2
 
                                   [ARTWORK]
 
     [Photograph of manufacturing facilities; pictures of products; and diagram
of wafer fabrication, packaging and test operations.]
 
     PowerQuad(R) and SuperBGA(R) are registered trademarks of the Company and
ChipArray(TM), fleXBGA(TM) and PowerSOP(TM) are trademarks of the Company.
MicroBGA(TM) is a trademark of Tessera, Inc. This Prospectus includes other
trademarks and trade names of the Company and other entities.
 
     CERTAIN PERSONS PARTICIPATING IN THE OFFERINGS MAY ENGAGE IN TRANSACTIONS
THAT STABILIZE, MAINTAIN OR OTHERWISE AFFECT THE PRICE OF THE SECURITIES OFFERED
HEREBY, INCLUDING PURCHASES OF SUCH SECURITIES TO STABILIZE THEIR MARKET PRICE,
PURCHASES OF SUCH SECURITIES TO COVER SOME OR ALL OF A SHORT POSITION IN SUCH
SECURITIES MAINTAINED BY THE UNDERWRITERS AND THE IMPOSITION OF PENALTY BIDS.
FOR A DESCRIPTION OF THESE ACTIVITIES, SEE "UNDERWRITING."
                                        2
<PAGE>   3
 
                               PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
 
     The following summary is qualified in its entirety by the more detailed
information found elsewhere in this Prospectus, including under "Risk Factors"
and the Combined Financial Statements and Notes thereto. Certain statements
contained in "Prospectus Summary," "Risk Factors," "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business,"
including statements regarding the anticipated growth in the market for the
Company's products, the Company's anticipated capital expenditures and financing
needs, the Company's expected capacity utilization rates, the belief of the
Company as to its future operating performance, and other statements contained
in this Prospectus that are not historical facts, are "forward-looking"
statements within the meaning of the U.S. federal securities laws. Because such
statements include risks and uncertainties, actual results may differ materially
from those anticipated in such forward-looking statements as a result of certain
factors, including those set forth in "Risk Factors," "Management's Discussion
and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business."
These forward-looking statements are made as of the date of this Prospectus and
the Company assumes no obligation to update such forward-looking statements or
to update the reasons why actual results could differ materially from those
anticipated in such forward-looking statements.
 
                                  THE COMPANY
 
     Amkor is the world's largest independent provider of semiconductor
packaging and test services. The Company believes that it is also one of the
leading developers of advanced semiconductor packaging and test technology in
the industry. The Company offers a complete and integrated set of packaging and
test services including integrated circuit ("IC") package design, leadframe and
substrate design, IC package assembly, final testing, burn-in, reliability
testing, and thermal and electrical characterization. As of December 31, 1997,
the Company had in excess of 150 customers, including many of the largest
semiconductor companies in the world. Such customers include, among others,
Advanced Micro Devices, Inc., International Business Machines Corp., Intel
Corporation, Lucent Technologies, Inc., Motorola, Inc., National Semiconductor
Corp., Philips Electronics N.V., SGS-THOMSON Microelectronics N.V., Siemens AG
and Texas Instruments, Inc. ("TI").
 
     Today, nearly all of the world's major semiconductor companies outsource
some or all of their packaging and test needs. The increasing complexities,
investment requirements and time to market pressures associated with IC design
and production, combined with the growth in the number of ICs being produced and
sold, are driving increasing demand for independent packaging and test services.
According to industry estimates, independent packaging foundry revenues are
expected to grow at a compound annual rate of 16% over a period of five years
from $5.6 billion in 1997 to $11.6 billion in 2002.
 
     The Company provides packaging and test services through its three
factories in the Philippines as well as four factories of Anam Semiconductor,
Inc. (formerly Anam Industrial Co., Ltd.) ("AICL") in Korea pursuant to a supply
agreement between the Company and AICL. The Company and AICL have had a long-
standing relationship. In 1996 and 1997, approximately 72% and 68%,
respectively, of the Company's revenues were derived from sales of services
performed for the Company by AICL. In addition, substantially all of the
revenues of AICL in 1996 and 1997 were derived from services sold by the
Company. Mr. James Kim, the Company's Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, is a
director of AICL, and he and other members of his family beneficially own
approximately 40.7% of AICL's outstanding common stock. The Company expects that
the businesses of the Company and AICL will continue to remain highly
interdependent by virtue of their supply relationship, overlaps and family ties
between their respective shareholders and management, financial relationships,
coordination of product and operation plans, joint research and development
activities and shared intellectual property rights.
 
     The Company recently began offering wafer fabrication services through
AICL's new deep submicron CMOS foundry capable of producing 15,000 8" wafers per
month. Through a strategic relationship with TI, the Company and AICL have
qualified .25 micron CMOS process technology, and TI has agreed to provide to
AICL .18 micron CMOS process technology during 1998. AICL's foundry will
primarily manufacture DSPs, ASICs and other logic devices. By leveraging the
Company's leading position in semiconductor packaging and test services, the new
wafer fabrication services have enabled the Company to become one of the first
providers of a fully integrated, turnkey semiconductor fabrication, packaging
and test service solution.
                                        3
<PAGE>   4
 
     The Company's strategy is to: (i) maintain its product technology
leadership by continuing to design and produce leading-edge packaging
technology; (ii) maintain advanced manufacturing capabilities through continuous
advancement and refinement of its process technology; (iii) leverage the scale
and scope of its packaging and test capabilities to provide Amkor with several
competitive advantages, including procurement of key materials and manufacturing
equipment, the ability to capitalize on economies of scale and the ability to
offer an industry-leading breadth of product offerings; (iv) establish industry
packaging standards to bolster sales of leading-edge, high margin and high
growth product lines; (v) enhance customer and supplier relationships; (vi)
continue to focus on customer support; and (vii) provide an integrated, turnkey
solution comprised of wafer fabrication, packaging and test services.
 
     The Company was organized under the laws of Delaware in September 1997 to
consolidate the ownership of several affiliated entities in the same business
and under common management. See "Reorganization." The Company's principal
executive offices are located at 1345 Enterprise Drive, West Chester, PA 19380
and its telephone number at that address is (610) 431-9600.
 
                                        4
<PAGE>   5
 
                           THE COMMON STOCK OFFERINGS
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                  <C>
Common Stock offered by the Company
  U.S. Offering....................................  24,000,000 shares
  International Offering...........................  6,000,000 shares
                                                     -------------------
          Total....................................  30,000,000 shares
Common Stock offered by Selling Stockholder
  U.S. Offering....................................  4,000,000 shares
  International Offering...........................  1,000,000 shares
                                                     -------------------
          Total....................................  5,000,000 shares
Common Stock to be outstanding after the
  Offerings(1).....................................  112,610,000 shares
Nasdaq National Market symbol......................  "AMKR"
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
 
(1) Excludes 3,145,900 shares of Common Stock issuable upon exercise of options
    to be granted immediately prior to the Offerings under the Company's 1998
    Stock Plan, 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees and 1998 Director
    Option Plan. Also excludes an aggregate of 13,333,333 shares reserved for
    future issuance upon conversion of the Convertible Notes and 3,404,100
    additional shares reserved for future issuance under the Company's 1998
    Stock Plan, 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees, 1998 Director
    Option Plan and 1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. See "Management" and
    "Description of Capital Stock" and Notes 1 and 16 of Notes to Combined
    Financial Statements.
 
                        THE CONVERTIBLE NOTES OFFERINGS
 
Convertible Notes offered by the Company
 
  U.S. Offering............  $150,000,000 aggregate principal amount
 
  International Offering...  $ 30,000,000 aggregate principal amount
                             ---------------------------------------------------
 
          Total............  $180,000,000 aggregate principal amount
 
Maturity...................  The Convertible Notes will mature on May 1, 2003,
                             unless earlier redeemed or converted.
 
Payment of Interest........  Interest on the Convertible Notes at the rate of
                             5 3/4% per annum is payable semi-annually on May 1
                             and November 1 of each year, commencing November 1,
                             1998.
 
Conversion Rights..........  The Convertible Notes are convertible into Common
                             Stock of the Company at the option of the holder at
                             any time on or before the close of business on the
                             last trading day prior to maturity, unless
                             previously redeemed, at a conversion price of
                             $13.50 per share, subject to adjustment in certain
                             events. See "Description of Convertible Notes --
                             Conversion."
 
Redemption at the Option of
the Company................  The Convertible Notes are not redeemable by the
                             Company prior to May 3 , 2001. On or after May 3,
                             2001, the Company may, upon at least 15 days'
                             notice, redeem the Convertible Notes at the
                             redemption prices set forth herein, together with
                             accrued and unpaid interest thereon, if the closing
                             price of the Common Stock is at least 125% of the
                             conversion price for at least 20 trading days
                             within a period of 30 consecutive trading days
                             ending on the fifth trading day prior to the notice
                             of redemption. See "Description of Convertible
                             Notes -- Optional Redemption."
 
Repurchase Upon Designated
  Event....................  The Convertible Notes are required to be
                             repurchased at 101% of their principal amount
                             together with accrued and unpaid interest thereon,
                             at the option of the holder, upon the occurrence of
                             a Designated Event
 
                                        5
<PAGE>   6
 
                             (i.e., a Change of Control or a Termination of
                             Trading (each as defined)). See "Risk
                             Factors -- Limitations on Repurchase of Convertible
                             Notes" and "Description of Convertible
                             Notes -- Repurchase at Option of Holders Upon a
                             Designated Event."
 
Subordination..............  The Convertible Notes will be unsecured obligations
                             of the Company and will be subordinated in right of
                             payment to all existing and future Senior Debt of
                             the Company and effectively subordinated to all
                             existing and future liabilities and obligations of
                             the Company's subsidiaries. As of December 31, 1997
                             (after giving effect to the Reorganization (as
                             defined)), the Company had approximately $32
                             million of outstanding indebtedness that would have
                             constituted Senior Debt, and the indebtedness and
                             other liabilities of the Company's subsidiaries
                             (excluding intercompany liabilities and obligations
                             of a type not required to be reflected on the
                             balance sheet of such subsidiary in accordance with
                             GAAP) that would effectively have been senior to
                             the Convertible Notes were approximately $642
                             million. After giving effect to debt repayments by
                             the Company prior to the Offerings and the
                             application of the estimated net proceeds to the
                             Company of the Offerings, such amounts will be
                             approximately $32 million and $220 million,
                             respectively. See "Risk Factors -- Subordination of
                             Convertible Notes," "Use of Proceeds" and
                             "Description of Convertible
                             Notes -- Subordination."
 
Nasdaq Stock
  Market Symbol............  "AMKRG"
 
Securities Lending
  Arrangement..............  In connection with market-making activities in the
                             Convertible Notes, Smith Barney Inc. may from time
                             to time borrow, return and reborrow up to 7,000,000
                             shares of Common Stock from certain stockholders of
                             the Company. The Underwriters are not obligated,
                             however, to make a market in the Convertible Notes
                             and any such market-making may be discontinued at
                             any time at the sole discretion of the
                             Underwriters. See "Underwriting."
 
                                USE OF PROCEEDS
 
     The net proceeds to the Company of the Offerings, estimated to be
approximately $479 million, will be used primarily to repay approximately $313
million of short-term and long-term debt, including $88 million of amounts due
to Anam USA, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of AICL ("AUSA"), and to repurchase
AICL's minority interest in one of the Company's Philippine manufacturing
subsidiaries for approximately $34 million. The remaining $132 million of such
net proceeds will be used for capital expenditures and working capital. See "Use
of Proceeds."
 
                                  RISK FACTORS
 
     See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 9 for a discussion of certain factors
that should be considered by potential investors.
 
                                        6
<PAGE>   7
 
                        SUMMARY COMBINED FINANCIAL DATA
                (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AND RATIO DATA)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                             ------------------------------------------------------------
                                               1993        1994        1995         1996          1997
                                             --------    --------    --------    ----------    ----------
<S>                                          <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>           <C>
INCOME STATEMENT DATA:
  Net revenues.............................  $442,101    $572,918    $932,382    $1,171,001    $1,455,761
  Gross profit.............................    70,778      58,270     149,047       148,923       213,092
  Operating income.........................    26,374      13,843      84,855        71,368       100,841
  Net income(1)............................    17,236      11,574      61,932        32,922        43,281
  Pro forma adjustment for income
    taxes(2)...............................     2,900         200      10,400         2,900         3,613
  Pro forma net income(2)..................    14,336      11,374      51,532        30,022        39,668
  Basic and diluted pro forma net income
    per common share.......................       .17         .14         .62           .36           .48
  Shares used in per share calculation.....    82,610      82,610      82,610        82,610        82,610
OTHER DATA:
  EBITDA(3)................................  $ 37,437    $ 34,197    $103,434    $  123,082    $  175,111
  Ratio of earnings to fixed charges(4)
    Actual.................................       3.7x        2.0x        4.6x          2.4x          2.5x
    Supplemental pro forma.................                                                           3.2x
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  DECEMBER 31, 1997
                                                                      -----------------------------------------
                                                  DECEMBER 31, 1996    ACTUAL     PRO FORMA(5)   AS ADJUSTED(6)
                                                  -----------------   ---------   ------------   --------------
<S>                                               <C>                 <C>         <C>            <C>
BALANCE SHEET DATA:
  Cash and cash equivalents.....................      $ 49,644        $  90,917    $  63,217        $100,791
  Working capital (deficit).....................        36,785         (196,870)    (224,570)         82,104
  Total assets..................................       804,864          855,592      827,892         897,599
  Short-term borrowings and current portion of
    long-term debt..............................       191,813          325,968      325,968          56,868
  5 3/4% Convertible Subordinated Notes due
    2003........................................            --               --           --         180,000
  Due to AUSA (non-current).....................       234,894          149,776      149,776              --
  Other long-term debt..........................       167,444           38,283       38,283          35,283
  Stockholders' equity..........................        45,812           90,875       61,075         368,040
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Net income for 1997 reflects a $17.3 million loss related primarily to the
    impairment of value of the Company's equity interest in AICL. This
    investment was sold in 1998. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of
    Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and Note 6 of Notes to
    Combined Financial Statements.
 
(2) Prior to the reorganization of the Company, Amkor Electronics, Inc. ("AEI"),
    a predecessor of the Company, elected to be taxed as an S Corporation under
    the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable state tax laws.
    Accordingly, AEI did not recognize any provision for federal income tax
    expense during the periods presented herein. The pro forma adjustment for
    income taxes reflects the additional U.S. federal income taxes which would
    have been recorded by the Company if AEI had not been an S Corporation
    during these periods. See "Reorganization" and Note 1 of Notes to Combined
    Financial Statements.
 
(3) EBITDA is defined as earnings before interest, taxes on income, depreciation
    and amortization. EBITDA is presented here to provide additional information
    about the Company's ability to meet its future debt service, capital
    expenditure, and working capital requirements and should not be construed as
    a substitute for or a better indicator of results of operations or liquidity
    than net income or cash flow from operating activities computed in
    accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.
 
(4) For purposes of calculating the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings
    consist of income before income taxes less undistributed earnings in less
    than 50%-owned subsidiaries, plus fixed charges. Fixed charges consist of
    interest expense incurred and one-third of rental expense which amount is
    deemed by the Company to be representative of the interest factor of rental
    payments under operating leases. The supplemental pro forma ratio of
    earnings to fixed charges reflects the effect on the ratio of earnings to
    fixed charges if the Offerings had been completed and the estimated net
    proceeds to the Company applied as described in "Use of Proceeds" at the
    beginning of the period presented.
 
(5) Pro forma balance sheet data reflects (i) the termination of AEI's S
    Corporation status which resulted in the recording of a deferred tax
    liability of $2.1 million and (ii) a distribution by the Company of
    undistributed earnings of AEI through December 31, 1997 of $27.7 million to
    stockholders of AEI prior to the reorganization of the Company. The amount
    actually distributed by the Company to such stockholders of AEI will reflect
    the amount of undistributed net income (loss) recognized by AEI and Amkor
    Technology, Inc. following December 31, 1997 and prior to such
    reorganization. See "Reorganization -- Termination of S Corporation Status
    and Distributions" and Notes 1, 16 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial
    Statements.
 
(6) As adjusted to give effect to the application of the estimated net proceeds
    to the Company of the Offerings, including the purchase from AICL of its 40%
    interest in Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. for approximately $34 million and the
    related elimination of minority interest and recording of goodwill. The
    acquisition of the minority interest will result in additional amortization
    of approximately $2.5 million per year. Also reflects repayments made after
    December 31, 1997 and prior to the Offerings of $47.1 million of short-term
    borrowings and current portion of long-term debt and $47.6 million of
    amounts due to AUSA (non-current), as well as the assumption by an affiliate
    of the Company of $13.9 million of amounts due to AUSA (non-current), in
    February 1998. See "Reorganization," "Use of Proceeds" and Notes 1, 6 and 16
    of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
                                        7
<PAGE>   8
 
                              RECENT DEVELOPMENTS
 
     For the three months ended March 31, 1998, the Company recognized net
revenues of $371.7 million, gross profit of $61.7 million and pro forma net
income (after giving effect to the termination of AEI's S Corporation status) of
$9.6 million or $0.12 per share.
 
     Capitalized terms used in this summary have the meanings ascribed to such
terms elsewhere in this Prospectus. Unless the context otherwise requires, all
references in this Prospectus to the "Company" or "Amkor" are to Amkor
Technology, Inc. and its subsidiaries. Prior to the Reorganization (as defined
under "Reorganization"), such subsidiaries were under common management and were
in the same business. As a result, the financial statements presented herein
have been prepared on a combined basis. Unless otherwise indicated, all
information in this Prospectus (i) gives effect to the Reorganization, which was
consummated on April 29, 1998, including the issuance of 82,610,000 shares of
Common Stock in connection therewith, and (ii) assumes that the Underwriters
have not exercised the over-allotment options. See "Reorganization,"
"Description of Capital Stock," "Underwriting," and Note 1 of Notes to Combined
Financial Statements. References in this Prospectus to "Korea" are to the
Republic of Korea, and references to "won" or "W" are to the currency of the
Republic of Korea. The won has depreciated significantly against the U.S. dollar
and other foreign currencies in recent months. On April 27, 1998, the base rate
under the market average exchange rate system, as announced by the Korea
Financial Telecommunications and Clearings Institute in Seoul, Korea (the
"Market Average Exchange Rate"), was W1,367 to $1.00. No representation is made
that the won or U.S. dollar amounts referred to herein could have been or could
be converted into U.S. dollars or won, as the case may be, at any particular
rate or at all. Financial information for AICL contained in this Prospectus has
been prepared on the basis of Korean generally accepted accounting principles
("GAAP"), which differ in certain significant respects from U.S. GAAP.
 
     Certain technical terms used throughout this Prospectus are defined in the
Glossary appearing immediately prior to the Combined Financial Statements at the
end of this Prospectus.
 
                                        8
<PAGE>   9
 
                                  RISK FACTORS
 
     Prospective investors should consider carefully the following risk factors,
in addition to the other information contained in this Prospectus concerning the
Company and its business, before purchasing the shares of Common Stock or the
Convertible Notes offered hereby. Certain statements contained in "Prospectus
Summary," "Risk Factors," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business," including statements
regarding the anticipated growth in the market for the Company's products, the
Company's anticipated capital expenditures and financing needs, the Company's
expected capacity utilization rates, the belief of the Company as to its future
operating performance and other statements contained in this Prospectus that are
not historical facts, are "forward-looking" statements within the meaning of the
U.S. federal securities laws. Because such statements include risks and
uncertainties, actual results may differ materially from those anticipated in
such forward-looking statements as a result of certain factors, including those
set forth herein and in "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business." These forward-looking
statements are made as of the date of this Prospectus and the Company assumes no
obligation to update such forward-looking statements or to update the reasons
why actual results could differ materially from those anticipated in such
forward-looking statements.
 
FLUCTUATIONS IN OPERATING RESULTS; DECLINES IN AVERAGE SELLING PRICES
 
     The Company's operating results have varied significantly from period to
period. A variety of factors could materially and adversely affect the Company's
revenues, gross profit and operating income, or lead to significant variability
of quarterly or annual operating results. These factors include, among others,
the cyclical nature of both the semiconductor industry and the markets addressed
by end-users of semiconductors, the short-term nature of its customers'
commitments, timing and volume of orders relative to the Company's production
capacity, changes in capacity utilization, evolutions in the life cycles of
customers' products, rescheduling and cancellation of large orders, rapid
erosion of packaging selling prices, availability of manufacturing capacity,
allocation of production capacity between the Company's facilities and those of
AICL, fluctuations in package and test service charges paid to AICL, changes in
costs, availability and delivery times of labor, raw materials and components,
effectiveness in managing production processes, fluctuations in manufacturing
yields, changes in product mix, product obsolescence, timing of expenditures in
anticipation of future orders, availability of financing for expansion, changes
in interest expense, the ability to develop and implement new technologies on a
timely basis, competitive factors, changes in effective tax rates, the loss of
key personnel or the shortage of available skilled workers, international
political or economic events, currency and interest rate fluctuations,
environmental events, and intellectual property transactions and disputes.
Unfavorable changes in any of the above factors may adversely affect the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition,
the Company increases its level of operating expenses and investment in
manufacturing capacity based on anticipated future growth in revenues. If the
Company's revenues do not grow as anticipated and the Company is not able to
decrease its expenses, the Company's business, financial condition and operating
results would be materially and adversely affected. See "Management's Discussion
and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations."
 
     Beginning in the third quarter of 1996, intense competition in the
semiconductor industry worldwide resulted in decreases in the average selling
prices of many of the Company's lead frame packages. The Company expects that
average selling prices for its services will continue to decline in the future,
principally due to intense competitive conditions. A decline in average selling
prices of the Company's services, if not offset by reductions in the cost of
producing those services or by a shift to higher margin products, would decrease
the Company's gross margins and could materially and adversely affect the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations."
 
DEPENDENCE ON THE HIGHLY CYCLICAL SEMICONDUCTOR AND PERSONAL COMPUTER INDUSTRIES
 
     The Company's business is substantially affected by market conditions in
the semiconductor industry, which is highly cyclical and, at various times, has
been subject to significant economic downturns character-
                                        9
<PAGE>   10
 
ized by reduced product demand, rapid erosion of average selling prices and
production overcapacity. In addition, the markets for semiconductors are
characterized by rapid technological change, evolving industry standards,
intense competition and fluctuations in end-user demand. Because the Company's
business will be dependent on the requirements of semiconductor companies for
independent packaging, test and wafer fabrication services for the foreseeable
future, any future downturn in the semiconductor industry could have a material
adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of
operations. The Company's operating results for 1996 and 1997 were adversely
affected by a downturn in the semiconductor market. In addition, a significant
portion of the Company's net revenues from packaging and test services depends
on the packaging and testing of semiconductors used in personal computer ("PC")
products. The PC industry is subject to intense competition, is highly volatile
and is subject to significant shifts in demand. As a result, any deterioration
of business conditions in the PC industry could have a material adverse effect
on the Company. See "Business -- Industry Background" and "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations."
 
RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH LEVERAGE
 
     The Company has historically operated with significant amounts of debt
relative to its equity. At December 31, 1997, the Company had outstanding $514.0
million in principal amount of indebtedness, including non-current amounts due
to Anam USA, Inc. ("AUSA"), a wholly-owned subsidiary of AICL, and the Company
has incurred prior to the Offerings and intends to continue to incur additional
bank debt in addition to the Convertible Notes issued as part of the Offerings.
In 1996 and 1997, the Company's payments under long-term debt agreements
(excluding payments to AUSA as described in Note 11 of Notes to Combined
Financial Statements) were $3.1 million and $43.5 million, respectively.
Following the expected application of the estimated net proceeds to the Company
of the Offerings and repayments of debt after December 31, 1997 and prior to the
Offerings, the Company will continue to have at least $272 million in principal
amount of indebtedness outstanding, including $57 million of short-term
borrowings and current portions of long-term debt.
 
     The Company is not in compliance with certain covenants with respect to
certain of its loans, the aggregate outstanding amount of which was $176 million
at December 31, 1997 (the "Non-Compliant Loans"). Such non-compliance in turn
triggered cross-defaults with respect to an additional $10 million of the
Company's loans. These loan covenants include restrictions on the ability of one
of the Company's subsidiaries to enter into transactions with affiliates,
requirements that the subsidiary maintain certain debt-to-equity ratios and
requirements that the subsidiary comply with certain notice requirements. The
Company's obligation to repay these loans (including the cross-defaulted loans)
may be accelerated by the lenders at any time. As a result of such
non-compliance, these loans have been classified as current liabilities in the
Company's financial statements included herein, and the report of the Company's
independent public accountants with respect to such financial statements
contains a paragraph stating that there is substantial doubt as to the ability
of the Company to continue as a going concern. The Company will eliminate such
non-compliance and cross-defaults by repaying such loans using part of the net
proceeds to the Company from the Offerings, as well as working capital. See "Use
of Proceeds."
 
     At December 31, 1997, the Company had also guaranteed borrowing facilities
available to companies affiliated with James Kim and other stockholders of the
Company totalling $55.7 million, of which $38.2 million was outstanding at
December 31, 1997. At December 31, 1997, the Company had $90.9 million of
stockholders' equity and a working capital deficit of $196.9 million (which
amounts were $61.1 million and $224.6 million, respectively, on a pro forma
basis, after giving effect to the termination of AEI's S Corporation status and
the distribution of undistributed net income of AEI through December 31, 1997).
See "Reorganization -- Termination of S Corporation Status and Distributions."
 
DEPENDENCE ON RELATIONSHIP WITH AICL; POTENTIAL CONFLICTS OF INTEREST
 
     AICL was founded in 1956 by Mr. H. S. Kim, who currently serves as the
honorary Chairman and a Representative Director of AICL. AICL is a member of the
Anam group of companies (the "Anam Group"), consisting principally of companies
in Korea in the electronics industries. The management of AICL and the other
companies in the Anam Group are influenced to a significant degree by the family
of H. S. Kim, which,
 
                                       10
<PAGE>   11
 
together with the Company, collectively owned approximately 40.7% of the
outstanding common stock of AICL as of December 31, 1997. A significant portion
of the shares owned by the Kim family are leveraged and as a result of this, or
for other reasons, the family's ownership could be substantially reduced. James
Kim, the founder of the Company and currently its Chairman and Chief Executive
Officer, is the eldest son of H. S. Kim. Since January 1992, in addition to his
other responsibilities, James Kim has been serving as acting Chairman of the
Anam Group and a director of AICL. Mr. In-Kil Hwang, the President and a
Representative Director of AICL, is the brother-in-law of James Kim. In
addition, four other members of Mr. Kim's family are on the 13-member Board of
Directors of AICL. After the Offerings, James Kim and members of his family will
beneficially own approximately 68.9% of the outstanding Common Stock of the
Company, and Mr. Kim and other members of his family will continue to exercise
significant control over the Company. See "-- Benefits of the Offerings to
Existing Stockholders; Continued Control by Existing Stockholders" and
"Principal and Selling Stockholders."
 
     The businesses of the Company and AICL have been interdependent for many
years. In 1996 and 1997, approximately 72% and 68%, respectively, of the
Company's revenues were derived from sales of services performed for the Company
by AICL. In addition, substantially all of the revenues of AICL in 1996 and 1997
were derived from services sold by the Company. The Company expects the
proportion of its revenues derived from sales of services performed for the
Company by AICL and the proportion of AICL's revenues from services sold by the
Company to increase as the Company begins selling the wafer fabrication output
of AICL's new wafer foundry and with the Company's assumption from AICL in
January 1998 of substantially all of the marketing rights for the Japanese
market. In the event the ability of AICL to supply the Company were disrupted
for any reason, the Company's facilities in the Philippines would be able to
fill only a small portion of the resulting shortfall in capacity. In addition,
there are currently no significant third party suppliers of packaging and test
services from which the Company could fill its orders. As a result, the
Company's business, financial condition and operating results will continue to
be significantly dependent on the ability of AICL to effectively provide
contracted services on a cost-efficient and timely basis. The termination of the
Company's relationship with AICL for any reason, or any material adverse change
in AICL's business resulting from underutilization of its capacity, the level of
its debt and its guarantees of affiliate debt, labor disruptions, fluctuations
in foreign exchange rates, changes in governmental policies, economic or
political conditions in Korea or any other change, could have a material adverse
effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
     The Company has recently entered into new supply agreements with AICL (the
"Supply Agreements"). Under the Supply Agreements, AICL has granted to the
Company a first right to substantially all of the packaging and test services
capacity of AICL and the exclusive right to all of the wafer output of its new
wafer foundry. The Company expects to continue to purchase substantially all of
AICL's packaging and test services, and to purchase all of AICL's wafer output,
under the Supply Agreements. Under the Supply Agreements, pricing arrangements
relating to packaging and test services provided by AICL to the Company are
subject to quarterly review and adjustment, and such arrangements relating to
the wafer output provided by AICL to the Company are subject to annual review
and adjustment, in each case on the basis of factors such as changes in the
semiconductor market, forecasted demand, product mix, capacity utilization and
fluctuations in exchange rates, as well as the mutual long-term strategic
interests of the Company and AICL. There can be no assurance that any new
pricing arrangements resulting from such review and adjustment will be favorable
to the Company. Pursuant to long-standing arrangements between AICL and the
Company's operating subsidiaries, sales from AICL to the Company will continue
to be made through AUSA, a wholly-owned financing subsidiary of AICL. Under the
Supply Agreements, the Company will continue to reimburse AUSA for the financing
costs incurred by it in connection with trade financing provided to the Company.
The Supply Agreements also provide that Amkor-Anam, Inc., a subsidiary of the
Company, will continue to provide raw material procurement and related services
to AICL on a fee basis. The Supply Agreements have a five-year term and may be
terminated by any party thereto upon five years' written notice at any time
after the expiration of such initial five-year term. There can be no assurance
that AICL will not terminate either Supply Agreement upon the expiration of such
initial term or, if it does terminate a Supply Agreement, that the Company will
be able to obtain a new agreement with AICL on terms that are favorable to the
Company or at all.
 
                                       11
<PAGE>   12
 
     AICL's ability to continue to provide services to the Company will depend
on AICL's financial condition and performance. AICL currently has a significant
amount of debt relative to its equity, which debt the Company expects will
continue to increase in the foreseeable future. The Company is advised that
AICL, as a public company in Korea, has published its most recent consolidated
financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 1997. These
consolidated financial statements are prepared on the basis of Korean GAAP,
which differs significantly from U.S. GAAP. U.S. GAAP financial statements are
not available. The independent auditor's report regarding AICL, included
elsewhere in this Prospectus, includes an explanatory paragraph regarding change
in accounting principles, the impact of the Korean economic situation on AICL
and its ability to continue as a going concern.
 
     The following is a summary of 1996 and 1997 consolidated financial
information pertaining to AICL prepared in accordance with Korean GAAP which
differs from U.S. GAAP in certain significant respects. See Note 6 of Notes to
Combined Financial Statements.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              1996            1997
                                                           ----------    --------------
                                                                  (IN MILLIONS)
<S>                                                        <C>           <C>
INCOME STATEMENT DATA:
  Sales..................................................  W1,338,718      W1,786,457
  Cost of sales..........................................   1,096,117       1,507,271
                                                           ----------      ----------
  Gross profit...........................................     242,601         279,186
  Selling and administrative expenses....................      77,754         103,158
                                                           ----------      ----------
  Operating income.......................................     164,847         176,028
  Non-operating income:
     Interest and dividend income........................      38,569          47,592
     Foreign exchange gains..............................      10,420         122,507
     Other...............................................       9,268          11,196
                                                           ----------      ----------
                                                               58,257         181,295
                                                           ----------      ----------
  Non-operating expenses:
     Interest expenses...................................     138,657         160,658
     Amortization of deferred charges....................       2,861          33,891
     Foreign exchange losses.............................      39,792         339,204
     Loss from forward contract..........................          --          94,644
     Other...............................................       9,962          20,639
                                                           ----------      ----------
                                                              191,272         649,036
                                                           ----------      ----------
  Ordinary income (loss).................................      31,832        (291,713)
  Extraordinary gains....................................         447             774
  Extraordinary losses...................................      11,072           1,812
                                                           ----------      ----------
  Net income (loss) before income taxes..................      21,207        (292,751)
  Income taxes...........................................      17,363           7,922
                                                           ----------      ----------
  Net income (loss) after income taxes...................       3,844        (300,673)
  Minority interests in losses (earnings) of consolidated
     subsidiaries, net...................................      (8,569)          1,206
  Amortization of consolidation adjustments, net.........      (5,326)         (3,009)
  Equity in earnings (losses) of unconsolidated
     equity-method subsidiaries and investees, net.......         666         (46,253)
                                                           ----------      ----------
  Net loss...............................................  W   (9,385)     W (348,729)
                                                           ==========      ==========
</TABLE>
 
                                       12
<PAGE>   13
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              1996            1997
                                                           ----------    --------------
                                                                  (IN MILLIONS)
<S>                                                        <C>           <C>
SUMMARY BALANCE SHEET DATA:
  Cash and bank deposits.................................   W 324,139       W 215,024
  Accounts and notes receivable, net.....................     170,724         189,522
  Inventory..............................................     214,494         260,302
  Other current assets...................................     145,302         241,965
                                                           ----------      ----------
     Total current assets................................     854,659         906,813
                                                           ----------      ----------
  Property, plant and equipment, net.....................     994,931       2,159,466
  Investments............................................      83,715         121,880
  Long-term accounts receivable..........................     198,251         203,739
  Long-term loans........................................         747         258,322
  Other long-term assets.................................      92,985         285,810
                                                           ----------      ----------
     Total long-term assets..............................   1,370,629       3,029,217
                                                           ----------      ----------
          Total assets...................................  W2,225,288      W3,936,030
                                                           ==========      ==========
  Short-term borrowings..................................   1,050,405       1,720,916
  Current maturities of long-term debt...................      85,252         120,913
  Other current liabilities..............................     190,989         282,653
                                                           ----------      ----------
     Total current liabilities...........................   1,326,646       2,124,482
                                                           ----------      ----------
  Long-term debt, net of current maturities..............     475,045         736,784
  Long-term capital lease obligations....................     106,068         861,813
  Other long-term liabilities............................      67,672         111,017
                                                           ----------      ----------
     Total long-term liabilities.........................     648,785       1,709,614
                                                           ----------      ----------
          Total liabilities..............................   1,975,431       3,834,096
                                                           ----------      ----------
  Minority interests.....................................      21,600          25,160
  Stockholders' equity...................................     228,257          76,774
                                                           ----------      ----------
          Total liabilities and stockholders' equity.....  W2,225,288      W3,936,030
                                                           ==========      ==========
</TABLE>
 
     A significant amount of the current and long-term liabilities of AICL are
denominated in U.S. dollars and other foreign currencies. At December 31, 1997,
the amount of U.S. dollar and other foreign currency denominated short-term
borrowings, current maturities of long-term debt, long-term debt (net of current
maturities) and long-term capital lease obligations were W1,222 billion, W59
billion, W159 billion and W834 billion, respectively. Due in part to the
significant depreciation of the won (for example, from a Market Average Exchange
Rate of W884 to $1.00 on December 31, 1996 to W1,415 to $1.00 on December 31,
1997 and W1,367 to $1.00 on April 27, 1998) resulting from the recent economic
crisis in Korea, AICL's liabilities in won terms and its leverage calculated in
won have significantly increased in 1997. The effect of this depreciation on
AICL, however, has been mitigated by the fact that substantial amounts of AICL's
revenues are denominated in U.S. dollars. The increase in AICL's liabilities was
also attributable in part to additional financing obtained in connection with
the construction of its new wafer foundry. See "-- Risks Associated with New
Wafer Fabrication Business" and Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial
Statements.
 
     The recent economic crisis in Korea has also led to sharply higher interest
rates in Korea and reduced opportunities for refinancing or refunding maturing
debts as financial institutions in Korea, which are experiencing financial
difficulties, are increasingly looking to limit their lending, particularly to
highly leveraged companies, and to increase their reserves and provisions for
non-performing assets. These developments will result in higher interest rates
on loans to AICL and have otherwise made it more difficult for AICL to obtain
new financing. Therefore, there can be no assurance that AICL will be able to
refinance its existing loans or obtain new loans, or continue to make required
interest and principal payments on such loans or otherwise comply with the terms
of its loan agreements. Any inability of AICL to obtain financing or generate
cash flow from operations sufficient to fund its capital expenditure, debt
service and repayment and other working capital and liquidity requirements could
have a material adverse effect on AICL's ability to continue to provide services
and otherwise fulfill its obligations to the Company. See "-- Risks Associated
with Leverage" and "-- Dependence on International Operations and Sales;
Concentration of Operations in the Philippines and Korea."
 
                                       13
<PAGE>   14
 
     As of December 31, 1997, AICL and its consolidated subsidiaries were
contingently liable under guarantees in respect of debt of AICL's
non-consolidated subsidiaries and affiliates in the Anam Group in the aggregate
amount of approximately W857 billion. As of such date, AICL had provided
guarantees for all of AUSA's debt of $319 million, the Non-Compliant Loans of
$176 million and the Company's obligations under a receivables sales
arrangement. The Company has met a significant portion of its financing needs
through financing arrangements obtained by AUSA for the benefit of the Company
based on guarantees provided by AICL. There can be no assurance that AUSA will
be able to obtain additional guarantees, if necessary, from AICL. Further, a
deterioration in AICL's financial condition could trigger defaults under AICL's
guarantees, causing acceleration of such loans. In addition, as an overseas
subsidiary of AICL, AUSA was formed with the approval of the Bank of Korea. If
the Bank of Korea were to withdraw such approval, or if AUSA otherwise ceased
operations for any reason, the Company and AICL would be required to meet their
financing needs through alternative arrangements. Although the Company believes
that after the Offerings alternative financing arrangements will be available,
there can be no assurance that the Company or AICL will be able to obtain
alternative financing on acceptable terms or at all. See "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources" and Note 11 of Notes to Combined
Financial Statements. In addition, if any relevant subsidiaries or affiliates of
AICL, certain of which may have greater exposure to domestic Korean economic
conditions than AICL, were to fail to make interest or principal payments or
otherwise default under their debt obligations guaranteed by AICL, AICL could be
required under its guarantees to repay such debt, which event could have a
material adverse effect on its financial condition and results of operations.
 
     Historically, AICL has undertaken capacity expansion programs and other
capital expenditures primarily on the basis of forecasts of the Company and
business plans prepared jointly with the Company. The Supply Agreements
generally provide for continued capital investment by AICL based on the
Company's forecasts and operational plans prepared jointly by the Company and
AICL reflecting such forecasts. However, as a result of the recent deterioration
of the Korean economy, there can be no assurance that AICL will be able to fund
future capacity expansions and other capital investments required to supply the
Company with necessary packaging and test services and wafer output on a timely
and cost-efficient basis.
 
     The Company and AICL have historically cooperated on the development of new
package designs and packaging and testing processes and technologies. The Supply
Agreements generally provide for continued cooperation between the Company and
AICL in research and development, as well as the cross-licensing of intellectual
property rights between the Company and AICL. If the Company's relationship with
AICL were terminated for any reason, the Company's research and development
capabilities and intellectual property position could be materially and
adversely affected.
 
     After the Offerings, the Company will continue to be controlled to a
significant degree by James Kim and members of his family, and Mr. Kim and other
members of his family will also continue to exercise significant influence over
the management of AICL and its affiliates. In addition, the Company and AICL
will continue to have certain contractual and other business relationships,
including under the Supply Agreements, and may engage in transactions from time
to time that are material to the Company. Although any such material agreements
and transactions would require approval of the Company's Board of Directors,
such transactions generally will not require any additional approval by a
separate committee comprised of the disinterested members of the Board of
Directors and conflicts of interest may arise in certain circumstances. There
can be no assurance that such conflicts will not from time to time be resolved
against the interests of the Company. The Company currently has four directors,
two of whom are disinterested. Under Delaware corporate law, each director owes
a duty of loyalty and care to the Company, which if breached can result in
personal liability for the directors. In addition, the Company may agree to
certain changes in its contractual and other business relationships with AICL,
including pricing, manufacturing allocation, capacity utilization and capacity
expansion, among others, which in the judgment of the Company's management will
result in reduced short-term profitability for the Company in favor of potential
long-term benefits to the Company and AICL. There can be no assurance that the
Company's business, financial condition or results of operations will not be
adversely affected by any such decision.
 
                                       14
<PAGE>   15
 
DEPENDENCE ON INTERNATIONAL OPERATIONS AND SALES; CONCENTRATION OF OPERATIONS IN
THE PHILIPPINES AND KOREA
 
     All of the production facilities currently used to fill the Company's
orders are located in the Philippines and Korea and many of the Company's
customers' operations are located in countries outside of the United States. A
substantial portion of the Company's revenues are derived from sales to
customers located outside of the United States. In 1996 and 1997, sales to such
customers accounted for 27% and 28%, respectively, of the Company's revenues.
The Company expects sales outside of the United States to continue to represent
a significant portion of its future revenues. As a result, the Company's
business will continue to be subject to certain risks generally associated with
doing business abroad, such as foreign governmental regulations, currency
fluctuations, political unrest, disruptions or delays in shipments, currency
controls and fluctuations, changes in local economic conditions and import and
export controls, as well as changes in tax laws, tariffs and freight rates. The
Company has structured its global operations to take advantage of lower tax
rates in certain countries and tax incentives extended to encourage investment.
The Company's tax returns through 1993 in the Philippines and through 1994 in
the U.S. have been examined by the Philippine and U.S. tax authorities,
respectively. The recorded provisions for subsequent open years are subject to
changes upon examination by tax authorities of tax returns for these years.
Changes in the mix of income from the Company's foreign subsidiaries, expiration
of tax holidays and changes in tax laws and regulations could result in
increased effective tax rates for the Company. See Notes 10 and 15 of Notes to
Combined Financial Statements.
 
  Philippines
 
     The Company's results of operations and growth will be influenced by the
political situation in the Philippines and by the general state of the
Philippine economy. Although the political and economic situation in the
Philippines has stabilized in recent years, it has historically been subject to
significant instability. Most recently, the devaluation of the Philippine peso
relative to the U.S. dollar beginning in July 1997 has led to instability in the
Philippine economy. Any future economic or political disruptions or instability
or low economic growth in the Philippines could have a material adverse effect
on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.
Because the functional currency of the Company's Philippine operations is the
U.S. dollar, the Company has recently benefitted from cost reductions relating
to peso denominated expenditures, primarily payroll costs. The Company believes
that such devaluation of the Philippine peso will eventually lead to inflation
in the Philippines, which could offset any savings achieved to date.
 
  Korea
 
     In 1996 and 1997, approximately 72% and 68%, respectively, of the Company's
revenues were derived from sales of services performed for the Company by AICL.
The operations of AICL are subject to certain risks. Relations between Korea and
the Democratic People's Republic of Korea ("North Korea") have been tense over
most of Korea's history. Incidents affecting relations between the two Koreas
continually occur. No assurance can be given that the level of tensions with
North Korea will not increase or change abruptly as a result of current or
future events, which could have a material adverse effect on AICL's, and as a
result the Company's, business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
     Since the beginning of 1997, Korea has experienced a significant increase
in the number and size of companies filing for corporate reorganization and
protection from their creditors. Such failures were caused by, among other
factors, excessive investments, high levels of indebtedness, weak export prices
and the Korean government's greater willingness to allow troubled corporations
to fail. As a result of such corporate failures, Korea's financial institutions
have experienced a sharp increase in non-performing loans. In addition, declines
in domestic stock prices have reduced the value of Korean banks' assets. These
developments have led international credit rating agencies to downgrade the
credit ratings of Korea, as well as various companies (including AICL) and
financial institutions in Korea.
 
     During the same period, the value of the won relative to the U.S. dollar
has depreciated significantly. The Market Average Exchange Rate as of April 27,
1998 was W1,367 to $1.00, as compared to the December 31, 1996 Market Average
Exchange Rate of W884 to $1.00. Such depreciation of the won relative to the
U.S. dollar has increased the cost of imported goods and services, and the value
in won of Korea's public and
 
                                       15
<PAGE>   16
 
private sector debt denominated in U.S. dollars and other foreign currencies has
also increased significantly. Korea's foreign currency reserves also have
declined significantly. Such developments have also led to sharply higher
domestic interest rates and reduced opportunities for refinancing or refunding
maturing debts as financial institutions in Korea, which are experiencing
financial difficulties, are increasingly looking to limit their lending, in
particular to highly leveraged companies, and to increase their reserves and
provisions for non-performing assets.
 
     In order to address the liquidity crisis and the deteriorating economic
situation in Korea, the Korean government concluded an agreement with the
International Monetary Fund on December 3, 1997 pursuant to which Korea is
eligible to receive loans and other financial support reported to amount to an
aggregate of approximately $58 billion (the "IMF Financial Aid Package").
Because there are conditions on the availability of loans and other financial
support under the IMF Financial Aid Package, there can be no assurance that such
conditions will be satisfied or that such loans and other financial support will
be available. In connection with the IMF Financial Aid Package, the Korean
government announced a comprehensive policy package (the "Reform Policy")
intended to address the structural weaknesses in the Korean economy and the
financial sector. While the Reform Policy is intended to alleviate the current
economic crisis in Korea and improve the Korean economy over time, the immediate
effects could include, among others, slower economic growth, a reduction in the
availability of credit to Korean companies, an increase in interest rates, an
increase in taxes, an increased rate of inflation due to the depreciation of the
won, an increase in the number of bankruptcies of Korean companies, labor unrest
and labor strikes resulting from a possible increase in unemployment, and
political unrest. These events could have a material adverse effect on the
Korean economy. Moreover, there can be no assurance that either the IMF
Financial Aid Package or the Reform Policy will be successful. In addition,
there can be no assurance that political pressure will not force the Korean
government to retreat from some or all of its announced Reform Policy or that
the Reform Policy will be implemented as currently contemplated.
 
     The Korean government has stated that as of December 31, 1997 the total
amount of Korea's private and governmental external liabilities was $154.4
billion under IMF standards. As of December 31, 1997, the total amount of
foreign currency reserves held by Korea was $20.4 billion, of which the usable
portion (the total less amounts on deposit with overseas branches of Korean
financial institutions and swap positions between the Korean central bank and
other central banks) was $8.9 billion. Pursuant to an exchange offer concluded
in April 1998, Korean financial institutions exchanged approximately $21.8
billion of their short-term foreign currency debt for longer-term floating rate
loans guaranteed by the Korean government. In addition, the Korean government
raised approximately $4 billion through an international offering of its debt
securities in April 1998. Korean financial institutions and the Korean corporate
and public sectors continue to carry substantial amounts of debt denominated in
currencies other than the won, including short-term debt, and there can be no
assurance that there will be sufficient foreign currency reserves to repay this
debt or that this debt can be extended or refinanced.
 
     Such recent and potential future developments relating to Korea, including
the continued deterioration of the Korean economy, could have a material adverse
effect on AICL's and the Company's business, financial condition and results of
operations. See "-- Dependence on Relationship with AICL; Potential Conflicts of
Interest," "Business -- Marketing and Sales" and "-- Facilities and
Manufacturing" and Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
CUSTOMER CONCENTRATION; ABSENCE OF BACKLOG
 
     Due to the concentration of market share in the semiconductor industry, the
Company has been largely dependent on a small group of customers for a
substantial portion of its business. In 1995, 1996 and 1997, 34.1%, 39.2% and
40.1%, respectively, of the Company's net revenues were derived from sales to
the Company's top five customers, with 13.3%, 23.5% and 23.4% of the Company's
net revenues, respectively, derived from sales to Intel Corporation ("Intel").
The ability of the Company to maintain close, satisfactory relationships with
such customers is important to the ongoing success and profitability of its
business. The Company expects that it will continue to be dependent upon a
relatively limited number of customers for a significant portion of its net
revenues in future periods. None of the Company's customers is presently
                                       16
<PAGE>   17
 
obligated to purchase any amount of packaging or test services or to provide the
Company with binding forecasts of product purchases for any period. In addition,
the Company's new wafer fabrication business will be significantly dependent
upon TI. The reduction, delay, or cancellation of orders from one of the
Company's significant customers, including Intel for packaging and test services
or TI for wafer fabrication services, could materially and adversely affect the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. Although the
Company has received forecasts from TI which indicate that TI will meet its
minimum purchase obligation during the second half of 1998, during the first
quarter of 1998 TI's orders were below such minimum purchase commitment due to
market conditions and issues encountered by TI in the transition of its products
to .18 micron technology. There can be no assurance that such customers will not
reduce, cancel or delay orders. See "-- Dependence on the Highly Cyclical
Semiconductor and Personal Computer Industries" and "-- Risks Associated with
New Wafer Fabrication Business."
 
     All of the Company's customers operate in the cyclical semiconductor
business and may vary order levels significantly from period to period. In
addition, there can be no assurance that such customers or any other customers
will continue to place orders with the Company in the future at the same levels
as in prior periods. From time to time, semiconductor companies have experienced
reduced prices for some products, as well as delays or cancellations in orders.
There can be no assurance that, should these circumstances occur in the future,
they will not adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations. The loss of one or more of the Company's customers, or
reduced orders by any of its key customers, could adversely affect the Company's
business, financial condition and results of operations. The Company's packaging
and test business does not typically operate with any material backlog, and the
Company expects that in the future the Company's packaging and test revenues in
any quarter will continue to be substantially dependent upon orders received in
that quarter. The Company's expense levels are based in part on its expectations
of future revenues and the Company may be unable to adjust costs in a timely
manner to compensate for any revenue shortfall. See "Business -- Marketing and
Sales."
 
EXPANSION OF MANUFACTURING CAPACITY; PROFITABILITY AFFECTED BY CAPACITY
UTILIZATION RATES
 
     The Company believes that its competitive position depends substantially on
its ability to expand its manufacturing capacity. Accordingly, although the
Company currently has available manufacturing capacity, the Company expects to
continue to make significant investments to expand such capacity, particularly
through the acquisition of capital equipment and the training of new personnel.
There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to utilize such capacity
or to continue to expand its manufacturing capacity in a timely manner, that the
cost of such expansion will not exceed management's current estimates or that
such capacity will not exceed the demand for the Company's services. In
addition, expansion of the Company's manufacturing capacity will continue to
significantly increase its fixed costs, and the Company expects to continue to
incur substantial additional depreciation and other expenses in connection with
the acquisition of new equipment and the construction of new facilities.
Increases or decreases in capacity utilization rates can have a significant
effect on gross margins since the unit cost of packaging and test services
generally decreases as fixed charges are allocated over a larger number of units
produced. Therefore, the Company's ability to maintain or enhance its gross
margins will continue to be dependent, in part, on its ability to maintain high
capacity utilization rates.
 
     Capacity utilization rates may be affected by a number of factors and
circumstances, including overall industry conditions, operating efficiencies,
the level of customer orders, mechanical failure, disruption of operations due
to expansion of operations or relocation of equipment, fire or natural
disasters, employee strikes or work stoppages or other circumstances. Although
the Company has been able to maintain a high rate of capacity utilization in
recent years as a result of its close association with its customers, its
knowledge of the semiconductor market conditions, and its continued improvements
in operating efficiencies and equipment maintenance, there can be no assurance
that this high utilization rate will be sustained in the future. The Company's
inability to generate the additional orders necessary to fully utilize its
capacity would have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations. For example, in 1996 the
Company's capacity utilization rates were negatively affected by an unexpected
downturn in the semiconductor industry. There can be no assurance that the
Company's utilization rates will not be adversely
 
                                       17
<PAGE>   18
 
affected by future declines in the semiconductor industry or for any other
reason. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and
Results of Operations" and "Business -- Manufacturing and Facilities."
 
LIQUIDITY AND FUTURE CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS
 
     The Company plans to continue to incur substantial costs to fund its
equipment and facilities expansion plans and its packaging technology
development. The Company believes that following the application of the net
proceeds from the sale of the Common Stock and the Convertible Notes in the
Offerings, its existing cash balances, cash flow from operations, available
equipment lease financing, bank borrowings and financing obtained through AUSA,
will be sufficient to meet its projected capital expenditures, working capital
and other cash requirements for at least the next twelve months. There can be no
assurance, however, that lower than expected revenues, increased expenses,
increased costs associated with the purchase or maintenance of capital
equipment, decisions to increase planned capacity or other events will not cause
the Company to seek more capital, or capital sooner than currently expected. The
timing and amount of the Company's actual capital requirements cannot be
precisely determined and will depend on a number of factors, including demand
for the Company's services, availability of capital equipment, fluctuations in
foreign currency exchange rates, changes in semiconductor industry conditions
and competitive factors. There can be no assurance that additional financing
will be available when needed or, if available, will be available on
satisfactory terms. Failure to obtain any such financing could have a material
adverse effect on the Company. In addition, if the Company obtains such
financing by selling equity securities of the Company, the Company's
stockholders may experience significant dilution. See "-- Risks Associated with
Leverage," "Dilution" and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources."
 
RAPID TECHNOLOGICAL CHANGE; PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT
 
     The semiconductor packaging and test industry is characterized by rapid
increases in the diversity and complexity of semiconductor packaging products.
As a result, the Company expects that it will need to offer, on an ongoing
basis, more advanced package designs in order to respond to competitive industry
conditions and customer requirements. The requirement to develop and maintain
advanced packaging capabilities and equipment could require significant research
and development and capital expenditures in future years. In addition, advances
in technology also typically lead to rapid and significant price erosion and
decreased margins for older package types and may lead to products currently
being offered by the Company becoming less competitive or inventories held by
the Company becoming obsolete. The failure by the Company to achieve advances in
package design or to obtain access to advanced package designs developed by
others could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, results
of operations and financial condition. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis
of Financial Condition and Results of Operations."
 
     The Company's success is also dependent upon the ability of it and AICL to
develop and implement new manufacturing process and package design technologies.
Semiconductor package design and process methodologies have become increasingly
subject to technological change, requiring large expenditures for research and
development. Converting to new package designs or process methodologies could
result in delays in producing new package types which could adversely affect the
Company's ability to meet customer orders.
 
MANUFACTURING RISKS; PRODUCTION YIELDS
 
     The semiconductor packaging process is complex and involves a number of
precise steps. Defective packaging can result from a number of factors,
including the level of contaminants in the manufacturing environment, human
error, equipment malfunction, use of defective raw materials, defective plating
services and inadequate sample testing. From time to time, the Company expects
to experience lower than anticipated production yields as a result of such
factors, particularly in connection with any expansion of its capacity or change
in its processing steps. In addition, the Company's yield on new products will
be lower during the period necessary for the Company to develop the requisite
expertise and experience in producing such products and using such processes.
The failure of the Company or AICL to maintain high quality production
                                       18
<PAGE>   19
 
standards or acceptable production yields, if significant and sustained, could
result in loss of customers, delays in shipments, increased costs, cancellation
of orders and product returns for rework, any of which could have a material
adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of
operations. See "Business -- Facilities and Manufacturing."
 
RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH NEW WAFER FABRICATION BUSINESS
 
     The Company recently began providing wafer fabrication services, with
delivery of the first products from AICL's new foundry in January 1998. Neither
the Company nor AICL has significant experience in providing wafer fabrication
services, and there can be no assurance that the Company will not experience
difficulties in marketing and selling these services or that AICL will not
encounter operational difficulties such as lower than expected yields or longer
than anticipated production ramp-up, unexpected costs and other problems in
providing these services. If the Company or AICL encounters these or similar
difficulties, the Company's and AICL's businesses, financial condition and
results of operations could be materially adversely affected. In addition, TI
has transferred certain of its CMOS processes to AICL and AICL is dependent upon
TI's assistance for developing other state-of-the-art wafer manufacturing
processes. If AICL's relationship with TI is disrupted for any reason, AICL's
ability to produce wafers would be adversely affected, thus negatively impacting
the Company's ability to fulfill its customers' orders for fabrication services,
which could materially and adversely affect the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations. In addition, AICL's technology agreements
with TI (the "TI Technology Agreements") only cover .25 micron and .18 micron
CMOS technology and TI is not under any obligation to transfer any
next-generation technology. If AICL is not able to obtain such technology on
commercially reasonable terms or at all, the Company's ability to market AICL's
wafer fabrication services could be materially and adversely affected which
could have a material adverse effect on the Company's and AICL's business,
results of operations and financial condition.
 
     The Company's right to the supply of wafers from AICL's foundry is subject
to an agreement (the "TI Manufacturing and Purchasing Agreement") among AICL,
the Company and TI, pursuant to which TI has agreed to purchase from the Company
at least 40% of the capacity of this foundry and under certain circumstances has
the right to purchase up to 70% of this capacity. As a result, the Company's
wafer fabrication business will be significantly dependent upon TI, which may
adversely affect the Company's ability to obtain additional customers. If the
Company is unable to sell substantially all of the output of AICL's wafer
foundry, its business, results of operations and financial condition could be
materially and adversely affected. Although the Company has received forecasts
from TI which indicate that TI will meet its minimum purchase obligation during
the second half of 1998, during the first quarter of 1998 TI's orders were below
such minimum purchase commitment and it is uncertain whether TI will meet its
purchase obligation in the second quarter of 1998 due to market conditions and
issues encountered by TI in the transition of its products to .18 micron
technology. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that TI will place orders
representing at least 40% of the capacity of this foundry during this period or
in the future. A failure by TI to comply with its minimum purchase obligations
or the cancellation of a significant wafer fabrication order by TI or any other
customer could have a material adverse effect on AICL's and the Company's
business, financial condition and results of operations. The TI Manufacturing
and Purchasing Agreement terminates on December 31, 2007, unless terminated
sooner. The TI Manufacturing and Purchasing Agreement may be terminated upon two
years' prior notice by either AICL or TI if AICL and TI are unable to
successfully negotiate prior to June 30, 2000 an amendment to the TI Technology
Agreements or a new agreement with respect to AICL's use of TI's next-generation
CMOS technology. During such two-year period, TI would be obligated to purchase
a minimum of only 20% of the capacity of AICL's wafer fabrication facility. In
addition, the TI Manufacturing and Purchasing Agreement may be terminated sooner
upon, among other events, mutual written consent, material breach of the
agreement by either party, the inability of either party to obtain any necessary
government approvals, the failure of AICL to protect TI's intellectual property
and a change of control, bankruptcy, liquidation or dissolution of AICL. See
"Business -- Competition."
 
                                       19
<PAGE>   20
 
DEPENDENCE ON RAW MATERIALS SUPPLIERS AND SUBCONTRACTORS
 
     The Company obtains the direct materials for the packaging and test
services of its factories and for the packaging and test services provided by
AICL to fill the Company's orders directly from vendors. To maintain competitive
manufacturing operations, the Company must obtain from its vendors, in a timely
manner, sufficient quantities of acceptable materials at expected prices. The
Company sources most of its raw materials, including critical materials such as
lead frames and laminate substrates, from a limited group of suppliers. The
Company purchases all of its materials on a purchase order basis and has no
long-term contracts with any of its suppliers. From time to time, vendors have
extended lead times or limited the supply of required materials to the Company
because of vendor capacity constraints and, consequently, the Company has
experienced difficulty in obtaining acceptable raw materials on a timely basis.
In addition, from time to time, the Company may reject materials that do not
meet its specifications, resulting in declines in output or yield. There can be
no assurance that the Company will be able to obtain sufficient quantities of
raw materials and other supplies of an acceptable quality. The Company's
business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially and
adversely affected if its ability to obtain sufficient quantities of raw
materials and other supplies in a timely manner were substantially diminished or
if there were significant increases in the costs of raw materials that the
Company could not pass on to its customers. See "Business -- Facilities and
Manufacturing."
 
INABILITY TO OBTAIN PACKAGING AND TEST EQUIPMENT IN A TIMELY FASHION
 
     In connection with its future expansion plans, the Company and AICL expect
to purchase a significant amount of new packaging and test equipment. From time
to time, increased demand for some of this equipment causes lead times to extend
beyond those normally met by the equipment vendors. The unavailability of such
equipment or the failure of such equipment, or other equipment acquired by the
Company or AICL, to operate in accordance with the Company's or AICL's
specifications or requirements, or delays in the delivery of such equipment
could delay implementation of the Company's or AICL's expansion plans and impair
the ability of the Company to meet customer orders or otherwise have a material
adverse effect on the Company's business, results of operations and financial
condition. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and
Results of Operations" and "Business -- Facilities and Manufacturing."
 
MANAGEMENT OF GROWTH
 
     The Company has experienced and may continue to experience growth in the
scope and complexity of its operations and in the number of its employees. For
example, the Company is expanding its scope of operations to include wafer
fabrication services and is hiring new personnel in connection with such
expansion. This growth is expected to continue to strain the Company's
managerial, financial, manufacturing and other resources. In addition, although
the Company believes its current controls are adequate, in order to manage its
growth, the Company must continue to implement additional operating and
financial controls and hire and train additional personnel. Although the Company
has been successful in hiring and properly training sufficient numbers of
qualified personnel and in effectively managing its growth in the past, there
can be no assurance that the Company will be able to do so in the future, and
its failure to do so could have a material adverse effect on the Company's
business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, any
failure to improve the Company's operational, financial and management systems
could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations. See "-- Risks Associated with New Wafer
Fabrication Business," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business -- Employees."
 
COMPETITION
 
     The independent semiconductor packaging and test industry is very
competitive, being comprised of approximately 50 companies with about 15 of
those companies having sales of $100 million per year or more. The Company faces
substantial competition from established packaging companies primarily located
in Asia, such as Advanced Semiconductor Engineering, Inc. (Taiwan), ASE Test
Limited (Taiwan and Malaysia),
                                       20
<PAGE>   21
 
ASAT, Ltd. (Hong Kong), Hana Microelectronics Public Co. Ltd. (Hong Kong and
Thailand), Astra International (Indonesia), Carsem Bhd. (Malaysia), ChipPAC
Incorporated (Korea), Siliconware Precision Industries Co., Ltd. (Taiwan), and
Shinko Electric Industries Co., Ltd. (Japan). Each of these companies has
significant manufacturing capacity, financial resources, research and
development operations, marketing and other capabilities, and have been
operating for some time. Such companies have also established relationships with
many large semiconductor companies which are current or potential customers of
the Company. The principal elements of competition in the independent
semiconductor packaging market include time to market, breadth of package
offering, technical competence, design services, quality, production yields,
responsiveness and customer service and price. On a larger scale, the Company
also competes with the internal manufacturing capabilities of many of its
largest customers. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to
compete successfully in the future against existing or potential competitors or
that the Company's operating results will not be adversely affected by increased
price competition.
 
     The independent wafer fabrication business is also highly competitive. The
Company expects its wafer fabrication services to compete primarily with
independent wafer foundries such as Chartered Semiconductor Manufacturing Ltd.,
Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Company Ltd. and United Microelectronics
Corporation, as well as with integrated device manufacturers such as LG Semicon
Co., Ltd., Hitachi, Ltd., Toshiba Corp. and Winbond Electronics Corporation,
which provide foundry services for other semiconductor companies. Each of these
companies has significant manufacturing capacity, financial resources, research
and development operations, marketing and other capabilities and have been
operating for some time. Many of these companies have also established
relationships with many large semiconductor companies which are current or
potential customers of the Company. The principal elements of competition in the
wafer foundry market include technology, delivery cycle times, price, product
performance, quality, production yield, responsiveness and flexibility,
reliability and the ability to design and incorporate product improvements.
There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to compete successfully
in the future against such companies. See "Business -- Competition."
 
DEPENDENCE ON KEY PERSONNEL AND AVAILABILITY OF SKILLED WORKFORCE
 
     The Company's success depends to a significant extent upon the continued
service of its key senior management and its technical personnel, each of whom
would be difficult to replace. Competition for qualified employees is intense,
and the loss of the services of any of its existing key personnel without
adequate replacement, or the inability to attract, retain and motivate qualified
new personnel could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations. In addition, in connection with
its expansion plans, the Company and AICL will be required to increase the
number of qualified engineers and other employees at their respective facilities
in the Philippines and Korea. Competition for such employees in the Philippines
and Korea is intense and the inability to attract new qualified personnel or to
retain such personnel could have a material adverse effect on the Company's
results of operations and financial condition. See "Management."
 
ENVIRONMENTAL REGULATIONS
 
     The semiconductor packaging process involves a significant amount of
chemicals and gases which are subject to extensive governmental regulations. For
example, liquid waste is produced at the stage at which silicon wafers are diced
into chips with the aid of diamond saws and cooled with running water. In
addition, excess materials on leads and moldings are removed from packaged
semiconductors in the trim and form process. The Company has installed equipment
to collect certain solvents used in connection with its manufacturing process
and has contracted with independent waste disposal companies to remove such
hazardous material.
 
     Federal, state and local regulations in the United States, as well as
environmental regulations in Korea and the Philippines, impose various controls
on the storage, handling, discharge and disposal of chemicals used in the
Company's and AICL's manufacturing process and on the facilities occupied by the
Company and AICL. The Company believes that its activities, as well as those of
AICL, conform to present environmental and land use regulations applicable to
their respective operations and current facilities. Increasing public
                                       21
<PAGE>   22
 
attention has, however, been focused on the environmental impact of
semiconductor manufacturing operations and the risk to neighbors of chemical
releases from such operations. There can be no assurance that applicable land
use and environmental regulations will not in the future impose the need for
additional capital equipment or other process requirements upon the Company or
AICL or restrict the Company's or AICL's ability to expand their respective
operations. The adoption of new ordinances or similar measures or any failure by
the Company or AICL to comply with applicable environmental and land use
regulations or to restrict the discharge of hazardous substances could subject
the Company or AICL to future liability or cause their respective manufacturing
operations to be curtailed or suspended.
 
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY
 
     The Company currently holds 24 United States patents, five of which are
jointly held with AICL, related to various IC packaging technologies, in
addition to other pending patents. These patents will expire at various dates
from 2012 through 2016. With respect to development work undertaken jointly with
AICL, the Company and AICL share intellectual property rights under the terms of
the Supply Agreements between the Company and AICL. Such Supply Agreements also
provide for the cross-licensing of intellectual property rights between the
Company and AICL. In addition, the Company enters into agreements with other
developers of packaging technology to license or otherwise obtain certain
process or package technologies.
 
     The Company expects to continue to file patent applications when
appropriate to protect its proprietary technologies; however, the Company
believes that its continued success depends primarily on factors such as the
technological skills and innovation of its personnel rather than on its patents.
The process of seeking patent protection can be expensive and time consuming.
There can be no assurance that patents will be issued from pending or future
applications or that, if patents are issued, they will not be challenged,
invalidated or circumvented, or that rights granted thereunder will provide
meaningful protection or other commercial advantage to the Company. Moreover,
there can be no assurance that any patent rights will be upheld in the future or
that the Company will be able to preserve any of its other intellectual property
rights.
 
     Although the Company is not currently a party to any material litigation,
the semiconductor industry is characterized by frequent claims regarding patent
and other intellectual property rights. As is typical in the semiconductor
industry, the Company may receive communications from third parties asserting
patents on certain of the Company's technologies. In the event any third party
were to make a valid claim against the Company or AICL, the Company or AICL
could be required to discontinue the use of certain processes or cease the
manufacture, use, import and sale of infringing products, to pay substantial
damages and to develop non-infringing technologies or to acquire licenses to the
alleged infringed technology. The Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations could be materially and adversely affected by such
developments. Litigation, which could result in substantial cost to and
diversion of resources of the Company, may also be necessary to enforce patents
or other intellectual property rights of the Company or to defend the Company
against claimed infringement of the rights of others. The failure to obtain
necessary licenses or the occurrence of litigation relating to patent
infringement or other intellectual property matters could have a material
adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of
operations. In addition, AICL has obtained intellectual property for wafer
manufacturing primarily from TI. The licenses granted to AICL by TI under the TI
Technology Agreements are very limited. Although TI has granted to AICL a
license under TI's trade secret rights to use TI's technology in connection with
AICL's provision of wafer fabrication services, TI has not granted AICL a
license under its patents, copyrights and mask works to manufacture
semiconductors for third parties. Although TI has agreed that TI will not assert
a claim for patent, copyright or mask work right infringement against AICL or
the Company in connection with AICL's manufacture of semiconductor products for
third parties, TI has reserved the right to bring such infringement claims
against AICL's or the Company's customers with respect to semiconductor products
purchased from AICL or the Company. As a result, AICL's and the Company's
customers could be subject to patent litigation by TI and others, and AICL and
the Company could in turn be subject to litigation by such customers and others,
in connection with the sale of wafers produced by AICL. Any such litigation
could materially and adversely affect AICL's ability to continue to manufacture
wafers and AICL's and the Company's business, financial condition and results of
operations.
 
                                       22
<PAGE>   23
 
SUBORDINATION OF CONVERTIBLE NOTES
 
     The Convertible Notes will be unsecured and subordinated in right of
payment in full to all existing and future Senior Debt (as defined) of the
Company. As a result of such subordination, in the event of bankruptcy,
liquidation or reorganization of the Company, or upon the acceleration of any
Senior Debt, the assets of the Company will be available to pay obligations on
the Convertible Notes only after all Senior Debt has been paid in full, and
there may not be sufficient assets remaining to pay amounts due on any or all of
the Convertible Notes then outstanding. The Convertible Notes are also
effectively subordinated to the liabilities, including trade payables, of the
Company's subsidiaries. The Indenture relating to the Convertible Notes does not
prohibit or limit the incurrence of additional indebtedness, including Senior
Debt, by the Company or its subsidiaries. The incurrence of additional
indebtedness by the Company or its subsidiaries could adversely affect the
Company's ability to pay its obligations on the Convertible Notes. As of
December 31, 1997 (after giving effect to the Reorganization), the Company had
approximately $32 million of outstanding indebtedness that would have
constituted Senior Debt, and the indebtedness and other liabilities of the
Company's subsidiaries (excluding intercompany liabilities and obligations of a
type not required to be reflected on the balance sheet of such subsidiaries in
accordance with GAAP) that would effectively have been senior to the Convertible
Notes were approximately $642 million. The incurrence of additional indebtedness
by the Company or its subsidiaries could adversely affect the Company's ability
to pay its obligations on the Convertible Notes. The Indenture relating to the
Convertible Notes will not limit the amount of additional indebtedness,
including Senior Debt, that the Company can create, incur, assume or guarantee,
nor will the Indenture limit the amount of indebtedness and other liabilities
that any subsidiary of the Company can create, incur, assume or guarantee. The
Company anticipates that from time to time it will incur additional indebtedness
and other liabilities, including Senior Debt, and that from time to time the
Company's subsidiaries will incur additional indebtedness and other liabilities.
 
     The Convertible Notes are obligations exclusively of the Company. However,
since the operations of the Company are primarily conducted through its
subsidiaries, the cash flow and the consequent ability of the Company to service
its debt, including the Convertible Notes, are primarily dependent upon the
earnings of its subsidiaries and the distribution of those earnings to, or upon
loans or other payments of funds by those subsidiaries to, the Company. The
payment of dividends and the making of loans and advances to the Company by its
subsidiaries may be subject to statutory or contractual restrictions, are
dependent upon the earnings of those subsidiaries and are subject to various
business considerations.
 
     The Indenture does not contain any financial performance covenants.
Consequently, the Company is not required under the Indenture to meet any
financial tests such as those that measure the Company's working capital,
interest coverage, fixed charge coverage or net worth in order to maintain
compliance with the terms of the Indenture. See "Description of Convertible
Notes -- Subordination."
 
LIMITATIONS ON REPURCHASE OF CONVERTIBLE NOTES
 
     Upon a Designated Event, which includes a Change of Control and a
Termination of Trading (each as defined), each holder of Convertible Notes will
have certain rights, at the holder's option, to require the Company to
repurchase all or a portion of such holder's Convertible Notes. If a Designated
Event were to occur, there can be no assurance that the Company would have
sufficient funds to pay the repurchase price for all Convertible Notes tendered
by the holders thereof. In addition, the terms of the Company's existing or
future credit or other agreements relating to indebtedness (including Senior
Debt) may prohibit the Company from purchasing any Convertible Notes and may
also provide that a Designated Event, as well as certain other change-of-control
events with respect to the Company, would constitute an event of default
thereunder. In the event a Designated Event occurs at a time when the Company is
prohibited from purchasing Convertible Notes, the Company could seek the consent
of its lenders to the purchase of Convertible Notes or could attempt to
refinance the borrowings that contain such prohibition. If the Company does not
obtain such a consent or repay such borrowings, the Company would remain
prohibited from purchasing Convertible Notes. In such case, the Company's
failure to purchase tendered Convertible Notes would constitute an Event of
Default under the Indenture, which may, in turn, constitute a further default
under the terms of other indebtedness that the Company has entered into or may
enter into from time to time. In such circumstances,
                                       23
<PAGE>   24
 
the subordination provisions in the Indenture would likely restrict payments to
the holders of Convertible Notes. See "Description of Convertible
Notes -- Repurchase at Option of Holders Upon a Designated Event."
 
NO PRIOR MARKET; LIQUIDITY; STOCK PRICE VOLATILITY; DILUTION
 
     Prior to the Offerings, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock or the Convertible Notes. Consequently, the initial public offering price
will be determined by negotiations among the Company and the representatives of
the Underwriters. Although the Underwriters have advised the Company that they
currently intend to make a market in the Common Stock and Convertible Notes,
they are not obligated to do so and may discontinue such market-making at any
time without notice. There can be no assurance that an active public market for
the Common Stock or the Convertible Notes will develop or be sustained after the
Offerings or that the market price of the Common Stock or the Convertible Notes
will not decline below the initial public offering price. The trading price of
the Common Stock and Convertible Notes could be subject to wide fluctuations in
response to quarter-to-quarter variations in operating results, announcements of
technological innovations or new products by the Company or its competitors,
general conditions in the semiconductor industry, changes in earnings estimates
or recommendations by analysts, or other events or factors. In addition, the
public stock markets have experienced extreme price and trading volume
volatility in recent months. This volatility has significantly affected the
market prices of securities of many high technology companies for reasons
frequently unrelated to the operating performance of the specific companies.
These broad market fluctuations may adversely affect the market price of the
Common Stock and Convertible Notes. Moreover, purchasers of Common Stock in the
Offerings will incur immediate, substantial book value dilution. See "Dilution"
and "Underwriting."
 
BENEFITS OF THE OFFERINGS TO EXISTING STOCKHOLDERS; CONTINUED CONTROL BY
EXISTING STOCKHOLDERS
 
     Immediately after the closing of the Offerings, based upon shares
outstanding as of the date hereof, James Kim and members of his family will, in
the aggregate, beneficially own 77,610,000 shares of Common Stock, which shares
represent all of the outstanding Common Stock not offered hereby and
approximately 68.9% of the total number of shares of Common Stock outstanding
following the Offerings. The Offerings will create a public market for the
resale of shares held by these existing stockholders. Such stockholders, acting
together, will be able to effectively control substantially all matters
requiring approval by the stockholders of the Company. Such matters could
include the election of a majority of the members of the Board of Directors,
proxy contests, mergers involving the Company, tender offers, open market
purchase programs or other purchases of Common Stock that could give
stockholders of the Company the opportunity to realize a premium over the then
prevailing market price for their shares of Common Stock. In addition, such
continued control could also have the effect of delaying, deferring or
preventing a change in control of the Company, may discourage bids for the
Common Stock at a premium over the market price and may adversely affect the
market price of the Common Stock. See "Principal and Selling Stockholders."
 
ANTI-TAKEOVER EFFECTS OF DELAWARE LAW AND CERTAIN CHARTER PROVISIONS
 
     The Company's Board of Directors has the authority to issue up to
10,000,000 shares of preferred stock $.001 par value ("Preferred Stock") and to
determine the price, rights, preferences and privileges of those shares without
any further vote or action by the Company's stockholders. The rights of the
holders of Common Stock will be subject to, and may be adversely affected by,
the rights of the holders of any Preferred Stock that may be issued in the
future. While the Company has no present intention to issue shares of Preferred
Stock, such issuance, while providing desirable flexibility in connection with
possible acquisitions and other corporate purposes, could have the effect of
making it more difficult for a third party to acquire a majority of the
outstanding voting stock of the Company. In addition, the Company is subject to
the anti-takeover provisions of Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation
Law, which prohibits the Company from engaging in a "business combination" with
an "interested stockholder" for a period of three years after the date of the
transaction in which the person became an interested stockholder, unless the
business combination is approved in a prescribed manner. The application of
Section 203 could have the effect of
 
                                       24
<PAGE>   25
 
delaying or preventing a change of control of the Company. The Company's
Certificate of Incorporation (the "Certificate of Incorporation") does not
permit cumulative voting. This provision, and other provisions of the
Certificate of Incorporation, the Company's bylaws (the "Bylaws") and Delaware
corporate law, may have the effect of deterring hostile takeovers or delaying or
preventing changes in control or management of the Company, including
transactions in which stockholders might otherwise receive a premium for their
shares over then current market prices.
 
SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
 
     Sales of substantial amounts of Common Stock in the public market after the
Offerings could adversely affect the prevailing market price of the Common
Stock. In addition to the 35,000,000 shares of Common Stock offered hereby
(assuming no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment options), upon the
closing of the Offerings, there will be 13,333,333 shares issuable upon
conversion of the Convertible Notes, all of which shares will be freely
tradeable. In addition, up to 7,000,000 shares of Common Stock may be borrowed
from James Kim and his wife Agnes Kim ("Mr. and Mrs. Kim") and resold in the
public market in connection with the Underwriters' market-making activities with
respect to the Convertible Notes. Excluding the shares described above, there
will be approximately 70,610,000 additional shares of Common Stock outstanding,
all of which are "restricted" shares (the "Restricted Shares") under the
Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"). Beginning April 29,
1999, all such Restricted Shares will first become eligible for sale in the
public market pursuant to Rule 144 promulgated under the Securities Act, subject
to certain volume and other resale restrictions pursuant to Rule 144. See
"Shares Eligible for Future Sale."
 
                                       25
<PAGE>   26
 
                                 REORGANIZATION
 
     In March 1970, Amkor Electronics, Inc. ("AEI") was incorporated in
Pennsylvania to design semiconductor packages and provide semiconductor
packaging services through a supply relationship with AICL. Since that time, Mr.
James Kim (the founder of AEI) and members of his family have acquired a
majority interest in a number of other companies which support or engage in
various aspects of the semiconductor packaging and test business (the "Amkor
Companies"). Prior to the reorganization described below, the Amkor Companies
consisted of:
 
     - AEI and its subsidiaries Amkor Receivables Corp., which purchases the
       Company's accounts receivable under an accounts receivable financing
       arrangement, and Amkor Wafer Fabrication Services SARL, which provides
       various technical support for CIL's wafer fabrication services customers
       in Europe and Asia;
 
     - T.L. Limited ("TLL") and its subsidiary C.I.L. Limited ("CIL"), which
       markets the Company's services to semiconductor companies in Europe and
       Asia;
 
     - Amkor/Anam EuroServices S.A.R.L. ("AAES"), which provides various
       technical and support services for CIL's packaging and test customers;
 
     - Amkor/Anam Advanced Packaging, Inc. ("AAAP"), Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc.
       ("AAP") and AAP's subsidiary Automated MicroElectronics Inc. ("AMI"),
       each of which provides manufacturing services; and
 
     - AK Industries, Inc. ("AKI") and its subsidiary, Amkor-Anam, Inc., which
       provides raw material purchasing and inventory management services.
 
     All of the Amkor Companies are substantially wholly owned beneficially by
Mr. and Mrs. Kim or entities beneficially owned by members of Mr. James Kim's
immediate family (the "Founding Stockholders"), except for 40% of AAP owned by
AICL and one-third of AEI and all of AKI which are owned by certain trusts
established for the benefit of other members of Mr. Kim's family (the "Kim
Family Trusts"). The Company (Amkor Technology, Inc.) was formed in September
1997 to consolidate the ownership of the Amkor Companies. Prior to the
reorganization described below, Amkor Technology, Inc. conducted no business and
held no assets or liabilities.
 
     Prior to the Offerings, the following transactions were effected to
consolidate the operations of the Amkor Companies under the Company (such
transactions are referred to collectively as the "Reorganization"):
 
     - AEI was merged into Amkor Technology, Inc.
 
     - Amkor International Holdings ("AIH"), a newly formed Cayman Islands
       holding company, became a wholly-owned subsidiary of Amkor Technology,
       Inc. holding the following entities:
          - First Amkor Cayman Islands, Ltd., a newly formed Cayman Islands
            holding company, and its subsidiaries AAAP, AAP and AMI;
          - TLL and its subsidiary CIL; and
          - AAES.
 
     - In addition, the Company acquired all of the stock of AKI from the Kim
       Family Trusts for $3 million.
 
     Except for the acquisition of AKI, which has been accounted for as a
purchase transaction, the accounting for the Reorganization is similar to the
accounting for a pooling of interests as it represents an exchange of equity
interests among companies under common control. All of the Amkor Companies are
wholly owned, directly or indirectly, by the Company (except for AAP, which is
40% owned by AICL). An aggregate of 82,610,000 shares of Common Stock have been
issued by the Company in connection with the Reorganization. The relative number
of shares of Common Stock issued by the Company in connection with each of the
transactions comprising the Reorganization was based upon relative amounts of
stockholders' equity of each of the Amkor Companies as of December 31, 1997.
Accordingly, the Company issued an aggregate of 14,620,140 shares of Common
Stock in connection with the merger of AEI into Amkor Technology, Inc.,
two-thirds of which shares (9,746,760 shares) were received by Mr. and Mrs. Kim
and one-
                                       26
<PAGE>   27
 
third of which shares (4,873,380 shares) were received by the Kim Family Trusts.
The Company then issued an aggregate of 67,989,851 shares of Common Stock,
representing approximately 82% of its shares immediately after the
Reorganization, in exchange for all of the outstanding shares of AIH and its
subsidiaries. Of such shares, 27,528,234 shares and 36,376,617 shares were
gifted to Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts, respectively, such that
Mr. and Mrs. James Kim and the Kim Family Trusts own 45.1% and 49.9%,
respectively, of the Common Stock outstanding after the Reorganization.
Following the Reorganization, the Founding Stockholders beneficially own a
majority of the outstanding shares of Common Stock. Following the Offerings, the
Founding Stockholders and the Kim Family Trusts will beneficially own 77,610,000
shares of Common Stock, representing approximately 68.9% of the outstanding
shares of Common Stock. See "Certain Transactions" and "Principal and Selling
Stockholder."
 
     The Company has entered into an agreement with AICL pursuant to which the
Company will purchase, immediately following the Offerings, AICL's 40% interest
in AAP for approximately $34 million. See "Use of Proceeds."
 
     The Offerings are conditioned upon, among other things, the consummation of
the Reorganization.
 
TERMINATION OF S CORPORATION STATUS AND DISTRIBUTIONS
 
     Prior to the consummation of the Reorganization, AEI had elected to be
treated for U.S. federal and certain state tax purposes as an S Corporation
under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable state tax laws. As a
result, AEI did not recognize federal corporate income taxes. Instead, up until
the termination of AEI's S Corporation status on April 28, 1998 (the
"Termination Date"), Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts had been
obligated to pay U.S. federal and certain state income taxes on their allocable
portion of the income of AEI. The Company, Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family
Trusts have entered into tax indemnification agreements providing that the
Company will be indemnified by such stockholders, with respect to their
proportionate share of any U.S. federal or state corporate income taxes
attributable to the failure of AEI to qualify as an S Corporation for any period
or in any jurisdiction for which S Corporation status was claimed through the
Termination Date. The tax indemnification agreements also provide that under
certain circumstances the Company will indemnify Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim
Family Trusts if such stockholders are required to pay additional taxes or other
amounts attributable to taxable years on or before the Termination Date as to
which AEI filed or files tax returns claiming status as an S Corporation. AEI
has made various distributions to such stockholders which have enabled them to
pay their income taxes on their allocable portions of the income of AEI. Such
distributions totaled approximately $19.8 million, $13.0 million and $5.0
million in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. The Company declared additional
distributions to such stockholders prior to the consummation of the
Reorganization in an amount equal to $27.7 million, as adjusted for net income
(loss) recognized by AEI and Amkor Technology, Inc. following December 31, 1997
and prior to the consummation of the Reorganization and less a distribution of
$8.1 million to such stockholders in April 1998, which distributions represented
AEI's cumulative net income in all periods prior to the Termination Date less
the aggregate amount of distributions previously made to such stockholders.
These final distributions are intended to provide such stockholders with the
balance of AEI's net income for which they have already recognized taxable
income. Through December 31, 1997, the amount of such undistributed net earnings
was $27.7 million. See Notes 1, 10 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial
Statements.
 
                                       27
<PAGE>   28
 
                             RELATIONSHIP WITH AICL
 
     AICL is a Korean company engaged primarily in providing semiconductor
packaging and test services to the Company, which in turn sells such services to
its customers. AICL also currently markets its services directly in Korea. In
addition, AICL manufactures and sells electric wiring devices and watches. AICL
operates four semiconductor packaging and test facilities in Korea, and has
recently qualified a new deep submicron CMOS wafer foundry in Korea which is
currently capable of producing 15,000 8" wafers per month. In March 1998, AICL
changed its name to Anam Semiconductor, Inc.
 
     AICL was founded in 1956 by Mr. H. S. Kim, who currently serves as the
honorary Chairman and a Representative Director of AICL. AICL is a member of the
Anam Group, consisting principally of companies in Korea in the electronics
industries. The businesses of AICL and the other companies in the Anam Group are
influenced to a significant degree by the family of H. S. Kim, which, together
with the Company, collectively owned approximately 40.7% of the outstanding
common stock of AICL as of December 31, 1997. A significant portion of the
shares owned by the Kim family are leveraged and as a result of this, or for
other reasons, the family's ownership could be substantially reduced. James Kim,
the founder of the Company and currently its Chairman and Chief Executive
Officer, is the eldest son of H. S. Kim. Since January 1992, in addition to his
other responsibilities, James Kim has been serving as acting Chairman of the
Anam Group and a director of AICL. Mr. In-Kil Hwang, the President and a
Representative Director of AICL, is the brother-in-law of James Kim. In
addition, four other members of Mr. Kim's family are on the 13 member Board of
Directors of AICL. After the Offerings, James Kim and members of his family will
beneficially own approximately 68.9% of the outstanding Common Stock of the
Company, and Mr. Kim and other members of his family will continue to exercise
significant control over the Company. See "Risk Factors -- Benefits of the
Offerings to Existing Stockholders; Continued Control by Existing Stockholders"
and "Principal and Selling Stockholders."
 
     The businesses of the Company and AICL have been interdependent for many
years. In 1996 and 1997, approximately 72% and 68%, respectively, of the
Company's revenues were derived from sales of services performed for the Company
by AICL. In addition, substantially all of the revenues of AICL in 1996 and 1997
were derived from services sold by the Company. The Company expects the
proportion of its revenues derived from sales of services performed for the
Company by AICL and the proportion of AICL's revenues from services sold by the
Company to increase as the Company begins selling the wafer fabrication output
of AICL's new wafer foundry and with the Company's assumption from AICL in
January 1998 of substantially all of the marketing rights for the Japanese
market. In the event the ability of AICL to supply the Company were disrupted
for any reason, the Company's facilities in the Philippines would be able to
fill only a small portion of the resulting shortfall in capacity. In addition,
there are currently no significant third party suppliers of packaging and test
services from which the Company could fill its orders. As a result, the
Company's business, financial condition and operating results will continue to
be significantly dependent on the ability of AICL to effectively provide
contracted services on a cost-efficient and timely basis. The Company expects
that the businesses of the Company and AICL will continue to remain highly
interdependent by virtue of their supply relationship, family ties between their
respective shareholders and management, financial relationships, coordination of
product and operation plans, joint research and development activities and
shared intellectual property rights. The termination of the Company's
relationship with AICL for any reason, or any material adverse change in AICL's
business resulting from underutilization of its capacity, the level of its debt
and its guarantees of affiliate debt, labor disruptions, fluctuations in foreign
exchange rates, changes in governmental policies, economic or political
conditions in Korea or any other change, could have a material adverse effect on
the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
     The Company has recently entered into the Supply Agreements with AICL.
Under the Supply Agreements, AICL has granted to the Company a first right to
substantially all of the packaging and test services of AICL and the exclusive
right to all of the wafer output of its new wafer foundry. The Company expects
to continue to purchase substantially all of AICL's packaging and test services,
and to purchase all of AICL's wafer output, under the Supply Agreements. Under
the Supply Agreements, pricing arrangements relating to packaging and test
services provided by AICL to the Company are subject to quarterly review and
adjustment, and such arrangements relating to the wafer output provided by AICL
to the Company are
                                       28
<PAGE>   29
 
subject to annual review and adjustment, in each case on the basis of factors
such as changes in the semiconductor market, forecasted demand, product mix and
capacity utilization and fluctuations in exchange rates, as well as the mutual
long-term strategic interests of the Company and AICL. There can be no assurance
that any new pricing arrangements resulting from such review and adjustment will
be favorable to the Company. Pursuant to long-standing arrangements between AICL
and the Company's operating subsidiaries, sales from AICL to the Company will
continue to be made through AUSA, a wholly-owned financing subsidiary of AICL.
Under the Supply Agreements, the Company will continue to reimburse AUSA for the
financing costs incurred by it in connection with trade financing provided to
the Company. The Supply Agreements also provide that Amkor-Anam, Inc., a
subsidiary of the Company, will continue to provide raw material procurement and
related services to AICL on a fee basis. The Supply Agreements have a five-year
term, and may be terminated by any party thereto upon five years' written notice
at any time after the expiration of such initial five-year term. There can be no
assurance that AICL will not terminate either Supply Agreement upon the
expiration of such initial term or that if it does terminate a Supply Agreement,
that the Company will be able to obtain a new agreement with AICL on terms that
are favorable to the Company or at all.
 
     AICL's ability to continue to provide services to the Company will depend
on AICL's financial condition and performance. AICL currently has a significant
amount of debt relative to its equity, which debt the Company expects will
continue to increase in the foreseeable future. The Company is advised that
AICL, as a public company in Korea, has published its most recent consolidated
financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 1997. These
consolidated financial statements are prepared on the basis of Korean GAAP,
which differs significantly from U.S. GAAP. U.S. GAAP financial statements are
not available. The independent auditors' report regarding AICL, included
elsewhere in this Prospectus, includes an explanatory paragraph regarding change
in accounting principles, the impact of the Korean economic situation on AICL
and its ability to continue as a going concern.
 
                                       29
<PAGE>   30
 
     The following is a summary of 1996 and 1997 consolidated financial
information pertaining to AICL prepared in accordance with Korean GAAP which
differs from U.S. GAAP. See Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             1996             1997
                                                          -----------    --------------
                                                                  (IN MILLIONS)
<S>                                                       <C>            <C>
INCOME STATEMENT DATA:
  Sales.................................................  W 1,338,718     W 1,786,457
  Cost of sales.........................................    1,096,117       1,507,271
                                                          -----------     -----------
  Gross profit..........................................      242,601         279,186
  Selling and administrative expenses...................       77,754         103,158
                                                          -----------     -----------
  Operating income......................................      164,847         176,028
  Non-operating income:
     Interest and dividend income.......................       38,569          47,592
     Foreign exchange gains.............................       10,420         122,507
     Other..............................................        9,268          11,196
                                                          -----------     -----------
                                                               58,257         181,295
                                                          -----------     -----------
  Non-operating expenses:
     Interest expenses..................................      138,657         160,658
     Amortization of deferred charges...................        2,861          33,891
     Foreign exchange losses............................       39,792         339,204
     Loss from forward contract.........................           --          94,644
     Other..............................................        9,962          20,639
                                                          -----------     -----------
                                                              191,272         649,036
                                                          -----------     -----------
  Ordinary income (loss)................................       31,832        (291,713)
  Extraordinary gains...................................          447             774
  Extraordinary losses..................................       11,072           1,812
                                                          -----------     -----------
  Net income (loss) before income taxes.................       21,207        (292,751)
  Income taxes..........................................       17,363           7,922
                                                          -----------     -----------
  Net income (loss) after income taxes..................        3,844        (300,673)
  Minority interests in losses (earnings) of
     consolidated subsidiaries, net.....................       (8,569)          1,206
  Amortization of consolidation adjustments, net........       (5,326)         (3,009)
  Equity in earnings (losses) of unconsolidated
     equity-method subsidiaries and investees, net......          666         (46,253)
                                                          -----------     -----------
  Net loss..............................................   W   (9,385)     W (348,729)
                                                          ===========     ===========
</TABLE>
 
                                       30
<PAGE>   31
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             1996             1997
                                                          -----------    --------------
                                                                  (IN MILLIONS)
<S>                                                       <C>            <C>
SUMMARY BALANCE SHEET DATA:
  Cash and bank deposits................................   W  324,139      W  215,024
  Accounts and notes receivable, net....................      170,724         189,522
  Inventories...........................................      214,494         260,302
  Other current assets..................................      145,302         241,965
                                                          -----------     -----------
     Total current assets...............................      854,659         906,813
                                                          -----------     -----------
  Property, plant and equipment, net....................      994,931       2,159,466
  Investments...........................................       83,715         121,880
  Long-term accounts receivable.........................      198,251         203,739
  Long-term loans.......................................          747         258,322
  Other long-term assets................................       92,985         285,810
                                                          -----------     -----------
     Total long-term assets.............................    1,370,629       3,029,217
                                                          -----------     -----------
          Total assets..................................   W2,225,288      W3,936,030
                                                          ===========     ===========
  Short-term borrowings.................................    1,050,405       1,720,916
  Current maturities of long-term debt..................       85,252         120,913
  Other current liabilities.............................      190,989         282,653
                                                          -----------     -----------
     Total current liabilities..........................    1,326,646       2,124,482
                                                          -----------     -----------
  Long-term debt, net of current maturities.............      475,045         736,784
  Long-term capital lease obligations...................      106,068         861,813
  Other long-term liabilities...........................       67,672         111,017
                                                          -----------     -----------
          Total long-term liabilities...................      648,785       1,709,614
                                                          -----------     -----------
          Total liabilities.............................    1,975,431       3,834,096
                                                          -----------     -----------
  Minority interests....................................       21,600          25,160
  Stockholders' equity..................................      228,257          76,774
                                                          -----------     -----------
          Total liabilities and stockholders' equity....   W2,225,288      W3,936,030
                                                          ===========     ===========
</TABLE>
 
     A significant amount of the current and long-term liabilities of AICL are
denominated in U.S. dollars and other foreign currencies. At December 31, 1997,
the amount of U.S. dollar and other foreign currency denominated short-term
borrowings, current maturities of long-term debt, long-term debt (net of current
maturities) and long-term capital lease obligations were W1,222 billion, W59
billion, W159 billion and W834 billion, respectively. Due in part to the
significant depreciation of the won (for example, from a Market Average Exchange
Rate of W884 to $1.00 on December 31, 1996 to W1,415 to $1.00 on December 31,
1997 and W1,367 to $1.00 on April 27, 1998) resulting from the recent economic
crisis in Korea, AICL's liabilities in won terms and its leverage calculated in
won have significantly increased in 1997. The effect of this depreciation on
AICL, however, has been mitigated by the fact that substantial amounts of AICL's
revenues are denominated in U.S. dollars. The increase in AICL's liabilities was
also attributable in part to additional financing obtained in connection with
the constitution of its new wafer foundry. See "-- Risks Associated with New
Wafer Fabrication Business" and Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial
Statements.
 
     The recent economic crisis in Korea has also led to sharply higher domestic
interest rates in Korea and reduced opportunities for refinancing or refunding
maturing debts as financial institutions in Korea, which are experiencing
financial difficulties, are increasingly looking to limit their lending,
particularly to highly leveraged companies, and to increase their reserves and
provisions for non-performing assets. These developments will result in higher
interest rates on loans to AICL and have otherwise made it more difficult for
AICL to obtain new financing. Therefore, there can be no assurance that AICL
will be able to refinance its existing loans or obtain new loans, or continue to
make required interest and principal payments on such loans or otherwise comply
with the terms of its loan agreements. Any inability of AICL to obtain financing
or generate cash flow from operations sufficient to fund its capital
expenditure, debt service and repayment and other working capital and liquidity
requirements could have a material adverse effect on AICL's ability to continue
to provide services and otherwise fulfill its obligations to the Company. See
"Risk Factors -- Risks
                                       31
<PAGE>   32
 
Associated With Leverage" and " -- Dependence On International Operations and
Sales; Concentration of Operations in the Philippines and Korea."
 
     As of December 31, 1997, AICL and its consolidated subsidiaries were
contingently liable under guarantees in respect of debt of AICL's
non-consolidated subsidiaries and affiliates in the Anam Group in the aggregate
amount of approximately W857 billion. As of such date, AICL had provided
guarantees for all of AUSA's debt of $319 million, the Non-Compliant Loans of
$176 million and the Company's obligations under a receivables sales
arrangement. The Company has met a significant portion of its financing needs
through financing arrangements obtained by AUSA for the benefit of the Company,
based on guarantees provided by AICL. There can be no assurance that AUSA will
be able to obtain additional guarantees, if necessary, from AICL. Further, a
deterioration in AICL's financial condition could trigger defaults under AICL's
guarantees, causing acceleration of such loans. In addition, as an overseas
subsidiary of AICL, AUSA was formed with the approval of the Bank of Korea. If
the Bank of Korea were to withdraw such approval, or if AUSA otherwise ceased
operations for any reason, the Company and AICL would be required to meet their
financing needs through alternative arrangements. Although the Company believes
that after the Offerings alternative financing arrangements will be available,
there can be no assurance that the Company or AICL will be able to obtain
alternative financing on acceptable terms or at all. See "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources" and Note 11 of Notes to Combined
Fianacial Statements. In addition, if any relevant subsidiaries or affiliates of
AICL, certain of which may have greater exposure to domestic Korean economic
conditions than AICL, were to fail to make interest or principal payments or
otherwise default under their debt obligations guaranteed by AICL, AICL could be
required under its guarantees to repay such debt, which event could have a
material adverse effect on its financial condition and results of operations.
 
     Historically, AICL has undertaken capacity expansion programs and other
capital expenditures primarily on the basis of forecasts of the Company and
business plans prepared jointly with the Company. The Supply Agreements
generally provide for continued capital investment by AICL based on the
Company's forecasts and operational plans prepared jointly by the Company and
AICL reflecting such forecasts. However, as a result of the recent deterioration
of the Korean economy, there can be no assurance that AICL will be able to fund
future capacity expansions and other capital investments required to supply the
Company with necessary packaging and test services and wafer output on a timely
and cost-efficient basis.
 
     The Company and AICL have historically cooperated on the development of new
package designs and packaging and testing processes and technologies. The Supply
Agreements generally provide for continued cooperation between the Company and
AICL in research and development, as well as the cross-licensing of intellectual
property rights between the Company and AICL. If the Company's relationship with
AICL were terminated for any reason, the Company's research and development
capabilities and intellectual property position could be materially and
adversely affected.
 
     After the Offerings, the Company will continue to be controlled to a
significant degree by James Kim and members of his family, and Mr. Kim and other
members of his family will continue to exercise significant influence over the
management of AICL and its affiliates. In addition, the Company and AICL will
continue to have certain contractual and other business relationships, including
under the Supply Agreements, and may engage in transactions from time to time
that are material to the Company. Although any such material agreements and
transactions would require approval of the Company's Board of Directors, such
transactions generally will not require any additional approval by a separate
committee comprised of the disinterested members of the Board of Directors and
conflicts of interest may arise in certain circumstances. There can be no
assurance that such conflicts will not from time to time be resolved against the
interests of the Company. The Company currently has four directors, two of whom
are disinterested. Under Delaware corporate law, each director owes a duty of
loyalty and care to the Company, which if breached can result in personal
liability for the directors. In addition, the Company may agree to certain
changes in its contractual and other business relationships with AICL, including
pricing, manufacturing allocation, capacity utilization and capacity expansion,
among others, which in the judgment of the Company's management will result in
reduced short-term profitability for the Company in favor of potential long-term
benefits to the Company and AICL. There can be no assurance that the Company's
business, financial condition or results of operations will not be adversely
affected by any such decision.
                                       32
<PAGE>   33
 
                                USE OF PROCEEDS
 
     The net proceeds to the Company from the sale of the 30,000,000 shares of
Common Stock and the $180,000,000 principal amount of the Convertible Notes
offered by the Company hereby are estimated to be approximately $479,350,000
(approximately $559,757,500 if the Underwriters' over-allotment options are
exercised in full), after deducting the underwriting discounts and estimated
offering expenses. The Company will not receive any proceeds from the sale of
the shares of Common Stock offered hereby by the Selling Stockholder.
 
     Approximately $154 million of the net proceeds to the Company from the
Offerings will be used to repay the Non-Compliant Loans, which, following
planned repayments of portions thereof prior to the Offerings, will have
outstanding balances of $43 million, $50 million and $61 million. These loans
are due May 1998, October 2000 and April 2001, respectively, and accrue interest
annually at rates equal to 7.16%, 6.78% and 6.68%, respectively, at December 31,
1997, which rates represent LIBOR plus a spread. The $43 million loan was
incurred in August 1997 in order to redeem $40 million of Floating Rate Notes
issued by AAP and to repay certain short-term debt. The Company is not in
compliance with certain covenants under the above-described loans and, as a
result, the Company's obligation to repay these loans may be accelerated by the
lenders at any time. These loan covenants include restrictions on the ability of
one of the Company's subsidiaries to enter into transactions with affiliates,
requirements that the subsidiary maintain certain debt-to-equity ratios and
requirements that the subsidiary comply with certain notice requirements. As a
result of such non-compliance, these loans have been classified as current
liabilities in the Company's financial statements included herein, and the
report of the Company's independent public accountants with respect to such
financial statements contains a paragraph stating that there is substantial
doubt as to the ability of the Company to continue as a going concern. Repayment
of such loans from the proceeds of the Offerings will eliminate these events of
non-compliance.
 
     Approximately $63 million of the net proceeds to the Company from the
Offerings will be used to repay numerous short-term bank loans incurred
primarily to finance capital expenditures for the Company's P1 factory in the
Philippines and for working capital. All of these loans are due within 12 months
of December 31, 1997 and bear interest at rates ranging from 8.0% to 12.2%. In
addition, approximately $8 million of the net proceeds will be used to repay two
term loans of approximately $3 million and $5 million. These loans are due
September 1999 and January 2001, respectively, and accrue interest annually at
rates equal to 9.09% and 11.88%, respectively, at December 31, 1997, which rates
represent LIBOR plus a spread.
 
     An additional approximately $34 million of the net proceeds to the Company
will be used to purchase AICL's 40% interest in AAP. Approximately $88 million
of the net proceeds will be used to repay all of the amounts that will remain
due to AUSA following planned repayments of portions thereof prior to the
Offerings. The remaining $132 million of such net proceeds ($213 million if the
Underwriters' over-allotment options are exercised in full) will be used for
capital expenditures and working capital. Pending such uses, the net proceeds to
the Company of the Offerings will be invested in investment grade,
interest-bearing securities.
 
                                DIVIDEND POLICY
 
     The Company currently anticipates that, following the completion of the
Offerings, all future earnings will be retained for use in the Company's
business and that the Company will not pay any cash dividends on its Common
Stock in the foreseeable future. The payment of any future dividends will be at
the discretion of the Company's Board of Directors and will depend upon, among
other things, future earnings, operations, capital requirements, the general
financial condition of the Company and general business conditions. As an S
Corporation, AEI made substantial cash distributions to its stockholders to pay
income taxes on their allocable portions of AEI's net income. See
"Reorganization."
 
                                       33
<PAGE>   34
 
                                 CAPITALIZATION
 
     The following table sets forth as of December 31, 1997 (i) the actual
capitalization of the Company derived from the Combined Financial Statements
after giving effect to the Reorganization, (ii) the pro forma capitalization of
the Company reflecting the termination of AEI's S Corporation status which
occurred in connection with the Reorganization, and (iii) the pro forma
capitalization of the Company as adjusted principally to reflect the sale by the
Company, pursuant to the Offerings, of 30,000,000 shares of Common Stock and
$180,000,000 of the Convertible Notes, and the receipt and application by the
Company of the estimated net proceeds to it therefrom (after deducting the
underwriting discounts and estimated offering expenses), as well as debt
repayments by the Company after December 31, 1997 and prior to the Offerings.
The capitalization information set forth in the table below is qualified by the
more detailed Combined Financial Statements and Notes thereto included elsewhere
in this Prospectus and should be read in conjunction with such Combined
Financial Statements and the Notes thereto.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            DECEMBER 31, 1997
                                                ------------------------------------------
                                                                              PRO FORMA
                                                 ACTUAL     PRO FORMA(1)    AS ADJUSTED(2)
                                                --------    ------------    --------------
                                                              (IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                             <C>         <C>             <C>
Short term borrowings and current portion of
  long-term debt..............................  $325,968      $325,968         $ 56,868
                                                --------      --------         --------
Long-term debt:
  5 3/4% Convertible Subordinated Notes due
     2003.....................................        --            --          180,000
  Due to AUSA (non-current)(3)................   149,776       149,776               --
  Other long-term debt........................    38,283        38,283           35,283
                                                --------      --------         --------
     Total long-term debt.....................   188,059       188,059          215,283
                                                --------      --------         --------
Stockholders' equity:
  Common Stock, $.001 par value; 500,000,000
     shares authorized; 82,610,000 shares
     issued and outstanding, actual and pro
     forma; 112,610,000 shares issued and
     outstanding, pro forma as adjusted(4)....        46            46               76
  Additional paid-in capital..................    20,871        20,871          327,806
  Retained earnings...........................    70,621        40,821           40,821
  Cumulative translation adjustment...........      (663)         (663)            (663)
                                                --------      --------         --------
     Total stockholders' equity...............    90,875        61,075          368,040
                                                --------      --------         --------
          Total capitalization................  $278,934      $249,134         $640,191
                                                ========      ========         ========
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Pro forma balance sheet data reflects (i) the termination of AEI's S
    Corporation status which resulted in the recording of a deferred tax
    liability of $2.1 million and (ii) a distribution by the Company of
    undistributed earnings of AEI through December 31, 1997 of $27.7 million to
    stockholders of AEI prior to the Reorganization. The amount actually
    distributed by the Company to such stockholders of AEI will reflect the
    amount of undistributed net income (loss) recognized by AEI and Amkor
    Technology, Inc. following December 31, 1997 and prior to the
    Reorganization. See "Reorganization -- Termination of S Corporation Status
    and Distributions" and Notes 1, 16 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial
    Statements.
 
(2) As adjusted to give effect to the application of the estimated net proceeds
    to the Company of the Offerings, including the purchase from AICL of its 40%
    interest in AAP for approximately $34 million and the related elimination of
    minority interest and recording of goodwill. The acquisition of the minority
    interest will result in additional amortization of approximately $2.5
    million per year. Also reflects repayments made after December 31, 1997 and
    prior to the Offerings of $47.3 million of short-term borrowings and current
    portion of long-term debt and $47.6 million of amounts due to AUSA (non-
    current), as well as the assumption by an affiliate of the Company of $13.9
    million of amounts due to AUSA (non-current) in February 1998. See
    "Reorganization," "Use of Proceeds" and Notes 1, 6 and 16 of Notes to
    Combined Financial Statements.
 
                                       34
<PAGE>   35
 
(3) See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results
    of Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources."
 
(4) Excludes 3,145,900 shares of Common Stock issuable upon exercise of options
    to be granted immediately prior to the Offerings under the Company's 1998
    Stock Plan, 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees and 1998 Director
    Option Plan. Also excludes an aggregate of 13,333,333 shares reserved for
    issuance upon conversion of the Convertible Notes and an additional
    3,404,100 shares reserved for issuance under the Company's 1998 Stock Plan,
    1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees, 1998 Director Option Plan and
    1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. See "Management" and "Description of
    Capital Stock" and Notes 1 and 16 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
                                       35
<PAGE>   36
 
                                    DILUTION
 
     The pro forma net tangible book value of the Company as of December 31,
1997 was approximately $58 million or $.71 per share of Common Stock, after
giving effect to the distribution of accumulated previously taxed earnings of
$27.7 million, the recording of deferred tax liabilities of $2.1 million and the
Reorganization. Pro forma net tangible book value per share represents the
Company's total pro forma tangible assets less total liabilities as reflected in
the Combined Financial Statements, divided by the number of outstanding shares
of Common Stock. After giving effect to the sale by the Company of 30,000,000
shares of Common Stock and $180,000,000 of Convertible Notes offered hereby
(assuming no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment options) and the use
by the Company of the estimated net proceeds therefrom (after deducting the
underwriting discounts and estimated offering expenses payable by the Company),
as described in "Use of Proceeds," the Company's net tangible book value at
December 31, 1997 would have been $341 million or $3.03 per share of Common
Stock. This represents an immediate increase in net tangible book value of $2.32
per share to existing stockholders and an immediate dilution in net tangible
book value of $7.97 per share to new public stockholders. The following table
illustrates this per share dilution:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                      <C>         <C>
Initial public offering price per share................              $  11.00
                                                                     --------
     Net tangible book value per share before the
       Offerings.......................................  $    .71
                                                         --------
     Increase in net tangible book value per share
       attributable to new public stockholders.........      2.32
                                                         --------
Net tangible book value per share after the
  Offerings............................................                  3.03
                                                                     --------
Dilution per share to new public stockholders..........              $   7.97
                                                                     ========
</TABLE>
 
     The following table summarizes, as of December 31, 1997 (after giving
effect to the Reorganization), the number of shares of Common Stock purchased
from the Company, the total consideration paid and the average price per share
paid by the existing stockholders and by new public stockholders purchasing
shares in the Offerings (before deducting the estimated underwriting discounts
and offering expenses payable by the Company).
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                      SHARES PURCHASED         TOTAL CONSIDERATION         AVERAGE
                                   ----------------------    -----------------------        PRICE
                                     NUMBER       PERCENT       AMOUNT       PERCENT      PER SHARE
                                   -----------    -------    ------------    -------    -------------
<S>                                <C>            <C>        <C>             <C>        <C>
Existing stockholders(1).........   82,610,000      73.4%    $ 20,917,000       6.0%      $    .25
New public stockholders(1).......   30,000,000      26.6      330,000,000      94.0       $  11.00
                                   -----------     -----     ------------     -----
          Total..................  112,610,000     100.0%    $350,917,000     100.0%
                                   ===========     =====     ============     =====
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
 
(1) Sales by the Selling Stockholder will reduce the number of shares of Common
    Stock held by existing stockholders to 77,610,000 shares or 68.9% of the
    total number of shares of Common Stock outstanding after the Offerings
    (65.8% assuming the Underwriters' over-allotment options are exercised in
    full), and will increase the number of shares of Common Stock held by new
    public stockholders to 35,000,000 shares or 31.1% of the total number of
    shares of Common Stock outstanding after the Offerings (40,250,000 shares or
    34.2% assuming the Underwriters' over-allotment options are exercised in
    full). See "Principal and Selling Stockholders."
 
                                       36
<PAGE>   37
 
                        SELECTED COMBINED FINANCIAL DATA
 
     The selected combined financial data presented below for, and as of the end
of, each of the years in the five-year period ended December 31, 1997 are
derived from the combined financial statements of Amkor. The combined financial
statements as of December 31, 1996 and 1997 and for each of the years in the
three-year period ended December 31, 1997 have been audited by Arthur Andersen
LLP, independent public accountants, and their report thereon, together with
such combined financial statements, are included elsewhere in this Prospectus.
Reference is made to said report which includes an explanatory paragraph with
respect to the ability of the Company to continue as a going concern as
discussed in Note 1 of the Notes to the Combined Financial Statements. Reference
is made to said reports which include an explanatory paragraph with respect to
the ability of the Company to continue as a going concern as discussed in Note 1
of Notes to the Combined Financial Statements. The selected combined financial
data presented below as of and for the year ended December 31, 1994 are derived
from audited financial statements which are not presented herein. The selected
combined financial data presented below as of and for the year ended December
31, 1993 are derived from unaudited combined financial statements. In the
opinion of management, the unaudited combined financial statements have been
prepared on the same basis as the audited combined financial statements and
contain all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments,
necessary for a fair presentation of the Company's results of operations for
such period and financial condition at such date. The selected combined
financial data set forth below is qualified in its entirety by, and should be
read in conjunction with, "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations" and the Combined Financial Statements and
Notes thereto.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                              -------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                1993        1994        1995         1996          1997
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
                                                                     (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AND RATIO DATA)
<S>                                                           <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>           <C>
INCOME STATEMENT DATA:
  Net revenues..............................................  $ 442,101   $ 572,918   $ 932,382   $ 1,171,001   $ 1,455,761
  Cost of revenues..........................................    371,323     514,648     783,335     1,022,078     1,242,669
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
         Gross profit.......................................     70,778      58,270     149,047       148,923       213,092
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
  Operating expenses:
    Selling, general and administrative.....................     42,649      41,337      55,459        66,625       103,726
    Research and development................................      1,755       3,090       8,733        10,930         8,525
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
         Total operating expenses...........................     44,404      44,427      64,192        77,555       112,251
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
  Operating income..........................................     26,374      13,843      84,855        71,368       100,841
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
  Other (income) expense:
    Interest expense, net...................................      5,116       5,752       9,797        22,245        32,241
    Foreign currency (gain) loss............................      2,809      (4,865)      1,512         2,961          (835)
    Other (income) expense, net.............................     (1,725)       (877)      6,523         3,150         8,429
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
         Total other expense................................      6,200          10      17,832        28,356        39,835
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
  Income before income taxes, equity in income (loss) of
    AICL and minority interest..............................     20,174      13,833      67,023        43,012        61,006
  Provision for income taxes................................      2,445       2,977       6,384         7,876         7,078
  Equity in income (loss) of AICL...........................      1,776       1,762       2,808        (1,266)      (17,291)
  Minority interest.........................................      2,269       1,044       1,515           948        (6,644)
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
  Net income................................................  $  17,236   $  11,574   $  61,932   $    32,922   $    43,281
                                                              =========   =========   =========   ===========   ===========
PRO FORMA DATA (UNAUDITED):
  Historical income before income taxes, equity in income
    (loss) of AICL and minority interest....................  $  20,174   $  13,833   $  67,023   $    43,012   $    61,006
  Pro forma provision for income taxes(1)...................      5,345       3,177      16,784        10,776        10,691
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
  Pro forma income before equity in income (loss) of AICL
    and minority interest(1)................................     14,829      10,656      50,239        32,236        50,315
  Historical equity in income (loss) of AICL................      1,776       1,762       2,808        (1,266)      (17,291)
  Historical minority interest..............................      2,269       1,044       1,515           948        (6,644)
                                                              ---------   ---------   ---------   -----------   -----------
  Pro forma net income (1)..................................  $  14,336   $  11,374   $  51,532   $    30,022   $    39,668
                                                              =========   =========   =========   ===========   ===========
  Basic and diluted pro forma net income per common
    share(1)................................................  $     .17   $     .14   $     .62   $       .36   $       .48
                                                              =========   =========   =========   ===========   ===========
  Shares used in computing pro forma net income per common
    share...................................................     82,610      82,610      82,610        82,610        82,610
                                                              =========   =========   =========   ===========   ===========
OTHER DATA:
  EBITDA(2).................................................  $  37,437   $  34,197   $ 103,434   $   123,082   $   175,111
                                                              =========   =========   =========   ===========   ===========
  Ratio of earnings to fixed charges(3):
    Actual..................................................       3.7x        2.0x        4.6x          2.4x          2.5x
    Supplemental pro forma..................................                                                           3.2x
</TABLE>
 
                                       37
<PAGE>   38
 
- ---------------
(1) Prior to the Reorganization, AEI, a predecessor of the Company, elected to
    be taxed as an S Corporation under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and
    comparable state tax laws. Accordingly, AEI did not recognize any provision
    for federal income tax expense during the periods presented. The pro forma
    provision for income taxes reflects the additional U.S. federal income taxes
    which would have been recorded if AEI had not been an S Corporation during
    these periods. See "Reorganization" and Note 1 of Notes to Combined
    Financial Statements.
 
(2) EBITDA is defined as earnings before interest income, interest expense,
    taxes on income, depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is presented here to
    provide additional information about the Company's ability to meet its
    future debt service, capital expenditure, and working capital requirements
    and should not be construed as a substitute for or a better indicator of
    results of operations or liquidity than net income or cash flow from
    operating activities computed in accordance with generally accepted
    accounting principles.
 
(3) For purposes of computing the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings
    consist of income before income taxes less undistributed earnings in less
    than 50%-owned subsidiaries, plus fixed charges. Fixed charges consist of
    interest expense incurred and one-third of rental expense which amount is
    deemed by the Company to be representative of the interest factor of rental
    payments under operating leases. The supplemental pro forma ratio of
    earnings to fixed charges reflects the effect on the ratio of earnings to
    fixed charges if the Offerings had been completed and the estimated net
    proceeds to the Company applied as described in "Use of Proceeds" at the
    beginning of the period presented.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           DECEMBER 31,                             DECEMBER 31, 1997
                              ---------------------------------------   -----------------------------------------
                                1993       1994      1995      1996      ACTUAL     PRO FORMA(1)   AS ADJUSTED(2)
                              --------   --------   -------   -------   ---------   ------------   --------------
                                                                (IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                           <C>        <C>        <C>       <C>       <C>         <C>            <C>
BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Cash and cash equivalents...  $  8,929   $114,930   $91,151   $49,664   $  90,917    $  63,217        $100,791
Working capital (deficit)...   (13,073)   134,798   111,192    36,785    (196,870)    (224,570)         82,104
Total assets................   191,754    426,522   626,379   804,864     855,592      827,892         897,599
Short-term borrowings and
  current portion of
  long-term debt............    76,051     52,526    85,120   191,813     325,968      325,968          56,868
  5 3/4% Convertible
  Subordinated Notes due
    2003....................        --         --        --        --          --           --         180,000
Due to AUSA (non-current)...    18,823    211,693   219,037   234,894     149,776      149,776              --
Other long-term debt........    29,917     62,215   107,385   167,444      38,283       38,283          35,283
Stockholders' equity........     8,070      9,617    45,289    45,812      90,875       61,075         368,040
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Pro forma balance sheet data reflects (i) the termination of AEI's S
    Corporation status which resulted in the recording of a deferred tax
    liability of $2.1 million and (ii) a distribution by the Company of
    undistributed earnings of AEI through December 31, 1997 of $27.7 million to
    stockholders of AEI prior to the Reorganization. The amount actually
    distributed by the Company to such stockholders of AEI will reflect the
    amount of undistributed net income (loss) recognized by AEI and Amkor
    Technology, Inc. following December 31, 1997 and prior to the
    Reorganization. See "Reorganization -- Termination of S Corporation Status
    and Distributions" and Notes 1, 16 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial
    Statements.
 
(2) As adjusted to give effect to the application of the estimated net proceeds
    to the Company of the Offerings, including the purchase from AICL of its 40%
    interest in AAP for approximately $34 million and the related elimination of
    minority interest and recording of goodwill. The acquisition of the minority
    interest will result in additional amortization of approximately $2.5
    million per year. Also reflects repayments made after December 31, 1997 and
    prior to the Offerings of $47.1 million of short-term borrowings and current
    portion of long-term debt and $47.6 million of amounts due to AUSA
    (non-current), as well as the assumption by an affiliate of the Company of
    $13.9 million of amounts due to AUSA (non-current) in February 1998. See
    "Reorganization," "Use of Proceeds" and Notes 1, 6 and 16 of Notes to
    Combined Financial Statements.
 
                                       38
<PAGE>   39
 
                      MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
                OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
     The following discussion contains forward-looking statements within the
meaning of the federal securities laws, including statements regarding the
anticipated growth in the market for the Company's products, the Company's
anticipated capital expenditures and financing needs, the Company's expected
capacity utilization rates, the belief of the Company as to its future operating
performance and other statements that are not historical facts. Because such
statements include risks and uncertainties, actual results may differ materially
from those anticipated in such forward-looking statements as a result of certain
factors, including those set forth in the following discussion as well as in
"Risk Factors" and "Business." The following discussion provides information and
analysis of the Company's results of operations from 1995 through 1997 and its
liquidity and capital resources and should be read in conjunction with the
Combined Financial Statements and Notes thereto and the selected combined
financial data included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The operating results for
interim periods are not necessarily indicative of results for any subsequent
period.
 
OVERVIEW
 
     Background. The Company is the world's largest independent provider of
semiconductor packaging and test services. The Company believes that it is also
one of the leading developers of advanced semiconductor packaging and test
technology in the industry. The Company offers a complete and integrated set of
packaging and test services including IC package design, leadframe and substrate
design, IC package assembly, final testing, burn-in, reliability testing, and
thermal and electrical characterization. The Company recently began offering
wafer fabrication services. The Company provides packaging and test services
through its three factories in the Philippines (P1, P2 and P3) as well as the
four factories of AICL in Korea, and wafer fabrication services through AICL's
new wafer foundry, pursuant to the Supply Agreements between the Company and
AICL. As of December 31, 1997, the Company had in excess of 150 customers,
including many of the largest semiconductor companies in the world.
 
     The Company was formed in September 1997 to consolidate the operations of
the Amkor Companies, including AEI which was incorporated in 1970. These
companies were under common management and in the same business prior to the
Company's formation. As a result of the Reorganization, the financial statements
included in this Prospectus are presented on a combined basis. See
"Reorganization" and "Certain Transactions" and Notes 1 and 16 of Notes to
Combined Financial Statements. Prior to the Reorganization, AEI elected to be
taxed as an S Corporation under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable
state tax laws. Accordingly, AEI did not recognize any provision for federal
income tax expense during the periods presented in the Combined Financial
Statements. The Combined Financial Statements include a pro forma provision for
income taxes which reflects the U.S. federal income taxes which would have been
recorded by the Company if AEI had not been an S Corporation during these
periods. See Notes 1, 10 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
     General.  From 1995 to 1997, the Company's revenues increased from
approximately $932.4 million to $1.456 billion. This increase occurred primarily
as a result of increases in unit volumes, together with the shift in the
Company's product mix from traditional leadframe products to advanced leadframe
and laminate products, which were offset in part by decreasing average selling
prices. See "Business -- Products." In order to meet customer demand, the
Company has invested significant resources to expand its capacity in the
Philippines. In 1996 and the first six months of 1997, the Company incurred and
expensed $15.5 million and $16.6 million, respectively, of pre-operating and
start-up costs and initial operating losses in connection with its newest
factory, P3, in the Philippines. This facility operated at substantially less
than full capacity during these periods while customers were completing
qualification procedures for BGA packages to be produced at the facility. The
Company significantly increased utilization of P3 during the last six months of
1997 and expects to operate the facility with positive gross margins during
1998. See "Risk Factors -- Expansion of Manufacturing Capacity; Profitability
Affected by Capacity Utilization Rates" and "Business -- Facilities and
Manufacturing."
 
                                       39
<PAGE>   40
 
     The Company's results of operations are generally affected by the
capital-intensive nature of its business. In 1995, 1996 and 1997, the Company
invested $123.6 million, $185.1 million and $179.0 million, respectively, in
property, plant and equipment. Increases or decreases in capacity utilization
rates can have a significant effect on gross margins since the unit cost of
packaging and test services generally decrease as fixed charges, such as
depreciation expense for the equipment, are allocated over a larger number of
units produced. In addition, the Company's gross margin is significantly
affected by fluctuations in service charges paid to AICL pursuant to the Supply
Agreements. Pricing arrangements relating to packaging and test services
provided by AICL to the Company are subject to quarterly review and adjustment,
and pricing arrangements relating to wafer fabrication services provided by AICL
are subject to annual review and adjustment, in each case on the basis of
factors such as changes in the semiconductor market, forecasted demand, product
mix and capacity utilization and fluctuations in exchange rates, as well as the
mutual long-term strategic interest of the Company and AICL. The Company's
results of operations are also affected by declines over time in the average
selling prices for particular products. At times in the past the Company has
been able to offset, at least in part, the effect of such decline on its margins
by successfully developing and marketing new products with higher margins, such
as advanced leadframe and laminate products, and by taking advantage of
economies of scale and higher productivity resulting from volume production.
However, there can be no assurance that the Company will be successful at
offsetting any such declines in the future. See "Risk Factors -- Expansion of
Manufacturing Capacity; Profitability Affected by Capacity Utilization Rates"
and "-- Competition."
 
     Due to the concentration of market share in the semiconductor industry, the
Company has been largely dependent upon a small group of customers for a
substantial portion of its business. In 1995, 1996 and 1997, 34.1%, 39.2% and
40.1%, respectively, of the Company's net revenues were derived from sales to
the Company's top five customers, with 13.3%, 23.5% and 23.4%, respectively,
derived from sales to Intel. See "Risk Factors -- Customer Concentration;
Absence of Backlog."
 
     Relationship with AICL. In 1996 and 1997, approximately 72% and 68%,
respectively, of the Company's revenues were derived from sales of services
performed for the Company by AICL. In addition, substantially all of the
revenues of AICL in 1996 and 1997 were derived from services sold by the
Company. Historically, AICL has directly sold packaging and test services in
Japan and Korea. The Company assumed substantially all of the marketing rights
for services in Japan in January 1998. Also, the Company recently began offering
wafer fabrication services through AICL's new deep submicron CMOS foundry which
is capable of producing up to 15,000 8" wafers per month. See "Risk
Factors -- Risks Associated with New Wafer Fabrication Business." The Company
expects the proportion of its net revenues derived from sales of services
performed for the Company by AICL and the percentage of AICL's revenues from
services sold by the Company to increase as the Company begins selling the wafer
fabrication output of AICL's new wafer foundry and with the Company's assumption
from AICL of substantially all of the marketing rights for Japan. The Company
has a first right to substantially all of the packaging and test service
capacity of AICL and the exclusive right to all of the wafer output of AICL's
new wafer foundry.
 
     The Supply Agreements between the Company and AICL generally provide, among
other things, for periodic price reviews and adjustments and coordination of
research and development efforts regarding package design and packaging and
testing processes and technologies. The Supply Agreements have a five year
initial term and thereafter may be terminated upon five years' notice. There can
be no assurance that AICL will not terminate either Supply Agreement upon the
expiration of such initial term, or that if it does terminate a Supply
Agreement, that the Company will be able to enter into a new agreement with AICL
on terms favorable to the Company or at all. See "Relationship with AICL."
 
     The Company expects that the businesses of the Company and AICL will
continue to remain highly interdependent by virtue of their supply relationship,
overlaps and family ties between their respective shareholders and management,
financial relationships, coordination of product and operation plans, joint
research and development activities and shared intellectual property rights. As
a result, the Company's business, financial condition and operating results will
continue to be significantly dependent on AICL, including without limitation
AICL's ability to effectively provide the contracted services on a
cost-efficient and timely basis as well as AICL's financial condition and
results of operations. The Company will continue to be controlled to a
significant degree by James Kim and members of his family, and Mr. Kim and other
                                       40
<PAGE>   41
 
members of his family will also continue to exercise significant influence over
the management of AICL and its affiliates. In addition, the Company and AICL
will continue to have certain contractual and other business relationships and
may engage in transactions from time to time that are material to the Company.
Although any such material agreements and transactions would require approval of
the Company's Board of Directors, such transactions will generally not require
any additional approval by a separate committee comprised of the disinterested
members of the Board of Directors and conflicts of interest may arise in certain
circumstances. There can be no assurance that such conflicts will not from time
to time be resolved against the interests of the Company. The Company currently
has four directors, two of whom are disinterested. Under Delaware corporate law,
each director owes a duty of loyalty and care to the Company, which if breached
can result in personal liability for the directors. In addition, the Company may
agree to certain changes in its contractual and other business relationships
with AICL, including pricing, manufacturing allocation, capacity utilization and
capacity expansion, among others, which in the judgment of the Company's
management will result in reduced short-term profitability for the Company in
favor of potential long-term benefits to the Company and AICL. There can be no
assurance that the Company's business, financial condition or results of
operations will not be adversely affected by any such decision. See
"-- Liquidity and Capital Resources" and "Risk Factors -- Dependence on
Relationship with AICL; Potential Conflicts of Interest."
 
RECENT DEVELOPMENTS
 
     For the three months ended March 31, 1998, the Company recognized net
revenues of $371.7 million, gross profit of $61.7 million and pro forma net
income (after giving effect to the termination of AEI's S Corporation status) of
$9.6 million or $0.12 per share.
 
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
     The following table sets forth certain operating data as a percentage of
net revenues for the periods indicated:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                      YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                      -----------------------
                                                      1995     1996     1997
                                                      -----    -----    -----
<S>                                                   <C>      <C>      <C>
Net revenues........................................  100.0%   100.0%   100.0%
Cost of revenues....................................   84.0     87.3     85.4
                                                      -----    -----    -----
  Gross profit......................................   16.0     12.7     14.6
Operating expenses:
  Selling, general and administrative ..............    6.0      5.7      7.1
  Research and development..........................    0.9      0.9      0.6
                                                      -----    -----    -----
     Total operating expenses.......................    6.9      6.6      7.7
                                                      -----    -----    -----
Operating income....................................    9.1      6.1      6.9
                                                      -----    -----    -----
Other (income) expense:
  Interest expense, net.............................    1.0      1.9      2.2
  Foreign currency (gain) loss......................    0.2      0.2     (0.1)
  Other expense, net................................    0.7      0.3      0.6
                                                      -----    -----    -----
     Total other expense............................    1.9      2.4      2.7
                                                      -----    -----    -----
Income before income taxes, equity in income (loss)
  of AICL and minority interest.....................    7.2      3.7      4.2
Provision for income taxes..........................    0.7      0.7      0.5
Equity in income (loss) of AICL.....................    0.3     (0.1)    (1.2)
Minority interest...................................    0.2      0.1     (0.5)
                                                      -----    -----    -----
Net income..........................................    6.6      2.8      3.0
Pro forma provision for income taxes ...............    1.1      0.2      0.3
                                                      -----    -----    -----
Pro forma net income................................    5.5%     2.6%     2.7%
                                                      =====    =====    =====
</TABLE>
 
     YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 COMPARED TO YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996
 
     Net Revenues. The Company's net revenues consist of fees for the packaging
and testing of ICs which are consigned by customers to the Company's or AICL's
factories. Net revenues for 1997 increased 24.3% to
 
                                       41
<PAGE>   42
 
$1,455.8 million from $1,171.0 million for 1996 primarily due to an increase in
unit volumes of semiconductors packaged and tested by the Company, offset in
part by declines in average selling prices for many of the Company's leadframe
products. In addition, the opening of P3, the Company's newest factory, and K4,
AICL's newest factory, in September 1996 enabled the Company to begin to expand
sales of BGA packages in 1997.
 
     Gross Profit. Gross profit increased 43.1% to $213.1 million in 1997 from
$148.9 million in 1996, resulting in a gross margin of 14.6% for 1997 as
compared to 12.7% for 1996. Cost of revenues consists principally of packaging
and test service charges from AICL, costs of direct material for both the
Philippine factories and AICL and labor and other costs at the Philippine
factories. Gross margin increased primarily due to improved operating results at
P1 and P2 during the second half of 1997, which more than offset initial
operating losses and start-up costs incurred in connection with P3 during the
first half of 1997. Product mix changes toward more profitable product lines and
decreased labor costs from the devaluation of the Philippine peso were the
primary factors resulting in improved margins at the P1 and P2 factories.
 
     Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. Selling, general and
administrative expenses increased 55.7% to $103.7 million, or 7.1% of net
revenues, in 1997 from $66.6 million, or 5.7% of net revenues, in 1996 primarily
due to increases in personnel in marketing and support to sustain the Company's
growth. The number of employees in the Company's marketing and sales support
groups increased during 1997 by approximately 21% over 1996. Such increase
resulted in an overall increase in personnel-related costs including salaries,
benefits and payroll taxes. The Company also incurred increased costs for office
rental, depreciation and other occupancy-related expenses. The Company does not
expect this level of growth in employees to continue in 1998. In addition to the
increased costs from its marketing and sales support groups, the Company
incurred approximately $8.0 million and $3.6 million in general and
administrative expenses in connection with its P3 operations and wafer
fabrication services group, respectively, during 1997. No similar costs were
incurred in 1996 as these groups represented start-up operations in 1997.
 
     Research and Development Expenses. Research and development expenses
decreased 22.0% to $8.5 million, or 0.6% of net revenues, in 1997, from $10.9
million, or 0.9% of net revenues, in 1996. The decrease in research and
development costs principally reflected the termination in late 1996 of the
Company's efforts to develop its own laminate substrate manufacturing
capability.
 
     Other (Income) Expense. Other (income) expense consists of interest
expense, net, foreign currency (gain) loss and other (income) expense, net.
Other expense increased 40.5% to $39.8 million in 1997 from $28.4 million in
1996 primarily as a result of increased interest expense and increased other
expenses. Interest expense for 1997 increased to $38.6 million from $27.7
million in 1996 as the Company significantly increased its borrowing to finance
capacity expansion. See "-- Liquidity and Capital Resources." Interest expense
in each of the periods was offset in part by interest income of $6.4 million and
$5.5 million, respectively. Other expenses increased primarily due to $2.4
million in costs relating to the Company's trade receivables securitization
transactions. See "-- Liquidity and Capital Resources" and Note 2 of Notes to
Combined Financial Statements.
 
     Income Taxes. The Company's effective tax rate (after giving effect to the
pro forma adjustment for income taxes) for 1997 was 18% as compared to 25% for
1996. The decrease in the Company's effective tax rate in 1997 compared to 1996
was primarily attributable to income not taxed due to a tax holiday and foreign
exchange effects described below. The Company's subsidiary that owns P3 operates
under a tax holiday from Philippine income taxes until the end of 2002. To the
extent P3 is profitable, the Company's effective tax rate related to its
Philippine operations during the tax holiday will be less than the Philippine
statutory rate of 35%. Additionally, the Company recognized deferred tax
benefits for unrealized foreign exchange losses in 1997 which are recognized in
the Philippines for tax reporting purposes and relate to unrecognized net
foreign exchange losses on U.S. dollar denominated monetary assets and
liabilities. See Note 10 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. These losses
are not recognized for financial reporting purposes as the U.S. dollar is the
functional currency. These losses will be realized for Philippine tax reporting
purposes upon settlement of the related asset or liability. The benefit derived
from unrealized foreign exchange losses was partially offset by an increase in
the valuation allowance as the Company concluded that it was more likely than
not that their tax benefits could be
 
                                       42
<PAGE>   43
 
realized in the Philippines within the three year loss carryforward period. The
Company has structured its global operations to take advantage of lower tax
rates in certain countries and tax incentives extended to encourage investment.
The recorded provisions for income taxes are subject to changes upon examination
of the Company's tax returns by tax authorities in the United States, the
Philippines and elsewhere. Changes in the mix of income from the Company's
foreign subsidiaries, expiration of tax holidays and changes in tax laws and
regulations could result in increased effective tax rates for the Company.
 
     Equity in Income (Loss) of AICL. Equity in income (loss) of AICL represents
the Company's ownership interest in AICL during the periods presented. In 1997,
the Company recognized a loss of $17.3 million resulting principally from the
impairment of value in its investment in AICL. In February 1998, the Company
disposed of its investment in AICL's common stock. See "Certain Transactions"
and Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
     Minority Interest. Minority interest represents AICL's ownership interest
in the consolidated net income of AAP. During 1997, as a result of a settlement
of an intercompany loan, which otherwise had no effect on the combined pretax
income of the Company, AAP reported a net loss as a separate entity.
Accordingly, the Company recorded a minority interest benefit in its combined
financial statements relating to the minority interest in the net loss.
Following the Offerings, the Company intends to purchase AICL's 40% interest in
AAP and, as a result, the Company will own substantially all of the common stock
of AAP. See "Use of Proceeds." The acquisition of the minority interest will
result in the elimination of the minority interest liability and additional
amortization of approximately $2.5 million per year.
 
     YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996 COMPARED TO YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
 
     Net Revenues. Net revenues in 1996 increased 25.6% to $1.17 billion from
$932.4 million in 1995. The increase was primarily due to an increase in units
sold together with an increase in sales of newer products, such as advanced
leadframe and laminate packages. This increase in sales of newer products offset
declines in average selling prices for many of the Company's other products.
 
     Gross Profit. Gross profit in 1996 and 1995 was approximately $149 million
representing a decrease in gross margin to 12.7% in 1996 from 16.0% in 1995. The
decrease in gross margin was primarily attributable to increases in cost of
revenues due to $15.5 million in pre-operating and start-up costs associated
with P3, as well as increased packaging and test service charges paid to AICL.
 
     Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. Selling, general and
administrative expenses increased 20.1% to $66.6 million, or 5.7% of net
revenues, in 1996 from $55.5 million, or 6.0% of net revenues, in 1995 as a
result of the addition of personnel and infrastructure to service increases in
customer demand. In addition, the Company continued its investments in new
information systems in order to enhance operating efficiencies and improve
customer service and support.
 
     Research and Development Expenses. Research and development expenses
increased 25.2% to $10.9 million, or 0.9% of net revenues, in 1996 from $8.7
million, or 0.9% of net revenues, in 1995 as a result of increased staffing and
funding for the Company's efforts to develop laminate substrate manufacturing
capabilities, prior to termination of such efforts in late 1996.
 
     Other (Income) Expense. Other expense increased 59.0% to $28.4 million in
1996 from $17.8 million in 1995 primarily as a result of increases in interest
expense, net, offset in part by a decrease in other expense, net. Interest
expense, net in 1996 increased to $22.2 million from $9.8 million in 1995 as the
Company significantly increased its borrowing to finance capacity expansion. See
"-- Liquidity and Capital Resources." As a result of this increase in debt, the
Company's interest expense increased to $27.7 million in 1996 from $17.3 million
in 1995.
 
     Income Taxes. The Company's effective tax rate (after giving effect to the
pro forma provision for income taxes) for 1996 and 1995 was 25%. These rates
were different from the United States statutory rate primarily due to the impact
of lower tax rates, including tax holidays, in certain of the countries in which
the Company's subsidiaries are located. See Note 10 of Notes to Combined
Financial Statements.
 
                                       43
<PAGE>   44
 
QUARTERLY RESULTS
 
     The following table sets forth certain unaudited combined financial
information, including as a percentage of net revenues, for the eight fiscal
quarters ended December 31, 1997. The Company disposed of its investment in AICL
common stock in February 1998. Also, the Company has entered into an agreement
with AICL pursuant to which the Company will purchase, immediately following the
Offerings, AICL's 40% interest in AAP. After the Offerings, there will be no
equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest related to AAP.
Consequently, this information is not presented below. The amounts of equity in
income (loss) of AICL and minority interest have historically varied
significantly by quarter depending on the income (loss) of AICL and AAP. See
"Reorganization" and Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. The
Company believes that all necessary adjustments, consisting only of normal
recurring adjustments, have been included in the amounts stated below to present
fairly the selected quarterly information when read in conjunction with the
Combined Financial Statements and the Notes thereto included elsewhere herein.
The Company's results of operations have varied and may continue to vary
significantly from quarter to quarter and are not necessarily indicative of the
results of any future period. In addition, in light of the Company's recent
growth, the Company believes that period-to-period comparisons should not be
relied upon as an indication of future performance.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             QUARTER ENDED
                                        ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                        MAR. 31,   JUNE 30,   SEPT. 30,   DEC. 31,   MAR. 31,   JUNE 30,   SEPT. 30,   DEC. 31,
                                          1996       1996       1996        1996       1997       1997       1997        1997
                                        --------   --------   ---------   --------   --------   --------   ---------   --------
                                                                            (IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                     <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>
Net revenues..........................  $270,327   $272,262   $285,784    $342,628   $313,019   $350,471   $380,130    $412,141
Cost of revenues......................   230,387    231,959    250,898     308,834    287,449    299,093    314,246     341,881
                                        --------   --------   --------    --------   --------   --------   --------    --------
  Gross profit........................    39,940     40,303     34,886      33,794     25,570     51,378     65,884      70,260
Operating expenses:
  Selling, general and
    administrative....................    13,752     15,948     16,716      20,209     20,608     26,657     26,829      29,632
  Research and development............     2,100      2,757      3,071       3,002      1,485      2,030      2,236       2,774
                                        --------   --------   --------    --------   --------   --------   --------    --------
    Total operating expenses..........    15,852     18,705     19,787      23,211     22,093     28,687     29,065      32,406
                                        --------   --------   --------    --------   --------   --------   --------    --------
Operating income......................    24,088     21,598     15,099      10,583      3,477     22,691     36,819      37,854
Total other expense, net..............     3,316      6,052      9,853       9,135      8,165      9,577     11,242      10,851
                                        --------   --------   --------    --------   --------   --------   --------    --------
Income before income taxes, equity in
  income (loss) of AICL and minority
  interest............................    20,772     15,546      5,246       1,448     (4,688)    13,114     25,577      27,003
Provision for income taxes............     3,803      2,847        961         265     (1,497)     4,186        842       3,547
                                        --------   --------   --------    --------   --------   --------   --------    --------
Income before equity in income (loss)
  of AICL and minority interest.......  $ 16,969   $ 12,699   $  4,285    $  1,183   $ (3,191)  $  8,928   $ 24,735    $ 23,456
                                        ========   ========   ========    ========   ========   ========   ========    ========
</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       QUARTER ENDED
                                        ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                         MAR. 31,     JUNE 30,     SEPT. 30,     DEC. 31,     MAR. 31,     JUNE 30,
                                           1996         1996         1996          1996         1997         1997
                                        ----------   ----------   -----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
<S>                                     <C>          <C>          <C>           <C>          <C>          <C>
Net revenues..........................    100.0%       100.0%        100.0%       100.0%       100.0%       100.0%
Cost of revenues......................     85.2         85.2          87.8         90.1         91.8         85.3
                                          -----        -----         -----        -----        -----        -----
  Gross profit........................     14.8         14.8          12.2          9.9          8.2         14.7
                                          -----        -----         -----        -----        -----        -----
Operating expenses:
  Selling, general and
    administrative....................      5.1          5.9           5.8          5.9          6.6          7.6
  Research and development............      0.8          1.0           1.1          0.9          0.5          0.6
                                          -----        -----         -----        -----        -----        -----
    Total operating expenses..........      5.9          6.9           6.9          6.8          7.1          8.2
                                          -----        -----         -----        -----        -----        -----
Operating income......................      8.9          7.9           5.3          3.1          1.1          6.5
Total other expense, net..............      1.2          2.2           3.5          2.7          2.6          2.8
                                          -----        -----         -----        -----        -----        -----
Income before income taxes, equity in
  income (loss) of AICL and minority
  interest............................      7.7          5.7           1.8          0.4         (1.5)         3.7
Provision for income taxes............      1.4          1.0           0.3          0.1         (0.5)         1.2
                                          -----        -----         -----        -----        -----        -----
Income before equity in income (loss)
  of AICL and minority interest.......      6.3%         4.7%          1.5%         0.3%        (1.0)%        2.5%
                                          =====        =====         =====        =====        =====        =====
 
<CAPTION>
                                             QUARTER ENDED
                                        ------------------------
                                         SEPT. 30,     DEC. 31,
                                           1997          1997
                                        -----------   ----------
<S>                                     <C>           <C>
Net revenues..........................     100.0%       100.0%
Cost of revenues......................      82.7         83.0
                                           -----        -----
  Gross profit........................      17.3         17.0
                                           -----        -----
Operating expenses:
  Selling, general and
    administrative....................       7.1          7.2
  Research and development............       0.5          0.6
                                           -----        -----
    Total operating expenses..........       7.6          7.8
                                           -----        -----
Operating income......................       9.7          9.2
Total other expense, net..............       3.0          2.6
                                           -----        -----
Income before income taxes, equity in
  income (loss) of AICL and minority
  interest............................       6.7          6.6
Provision for income taxes............       0.2          0.9
                                           -----        -----
Income before equity in income (loss)
  of AICL and minority interest.......       6.5%         5.7%
                                           =====        =====
</TABLE>
 
                                       44
<PAGE>   45
 
     The Company's revenues, gross profit and operating profit are generally
lower in the first quarter of the year as compared to the fourth quarter of the
preceding year primarily due to the combined effect of holidays in the United
States, the Philippines and Korea. Semiconductor companies in the United States
generally reduce their production during the holidays at the end of December
which results in a significant decrease in orders for packaging and testing
services during the first two weeks of January. In addition, the Company
typically closes its factories in the Philippines for holidays in January, and
AICL closes its factories in Korea for holidays in February. As a result of
these factors, the Company's net revenues are significantly reduced during the
months of January and February. The Company currently anticipates that its
operating results for the first quarter of 1998 will follow its historical
seasonality, with revenues, gross profit and operating profit declining as
compared to the fourth quarter of 1997.
 
     Beginning in the third quarter of 1996, intense competition in the
semiconductor industry worldwide led to decreases in the average selling prices
of many of the Company's leadframe packages. These decreases were partially
offset by increases in sales of advanced leadframe and laminate packages, which
carry higher prices and gross margins. In addition, the Company's cost of
revenues as a percentage of revenues increased significantly during the three
quarters ended March 31, 1997 primarily as a result of initial operating losses
and start-up costs associated with P3. Cost of revenues was also affected in the
two quarters ended June 30, 1997, as the Company recognized a $2.2 million
write-off for custom laminate raw materials which were purchased to meet
customer orders which were subsequently cancelled. The combined effect of these
factors was to decrease the levels of profitability in the third and fourth
quarters of 1996 and the first quarter of 1997.
 
     Selling, general and administrative expenses increased during the second,
third and fourth quarters of 1997 primarily due to increased staffing levels at
the Company's marketing and sales support groups, as well as at its P3 factory
and wafer fabrication services group, which resulted in increased
employee-related costs. See "-- Results of Operations -- Year Ended December 31,
1997 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 1996 -- Selling, General and
Administrative Expenses."
 
     Income tax rates in the third quarter of 1997 were lower compared to prior
periods as the Company recognized deferred tax benefits for unrealized foreign
exchange losses during the quarter, which are recognized for Philippine tax
reporting purposes but are not recognized for financial reporting purposes since
the U.S. dollar is the functional currency. Although similar circumstances
during the fourth quarter of 1997 resulted in the recognition of additional
deferred tax assets, their effect on the overall tax rates were mitigated by a
valuation allowance also recorded during the fourth quarter of approximately $22
million. See "-- Results of Operations -- Year End December 31, 1997 Compared to
Year Ended December 31, 1996 -- Income Taxes." As the majority of these tax
assets relate to fluctuations in the value of the Philippine peso, management is
unable to determine the impact to the effective tax rates which may occur as a
result of future exchange rate fluctuations.
 
     The Company's quarterly operating results may vary significantly due to a
variety of factors including, among others, the cyclical nature of both the
semiconductor industry and the markets addressed by end-users of semiconductors,
the short-term nature of its customers' commitments, timing and volume of orders
relative to the Company's production capacity, changes in capacity utilization,
evolutions in the life cycles of customers' products, rescheduling and
cancellation of large orders, rapid erosion of packaging selling prices,
availability of manufacturing capacity, allocation of production capacity
between the Company's facilities and AICL's facilities, fluctuations in
packaging and test service charges paid to AICL, changes in costs, availability
and delivery times of labor, raw materials and components, effectiveness in
managing production processes, fluctuations in manufacturing yields, changes in
product mix, product obsolescence, timing of expenditures in anticipation of
future orders, availability of financing for expansion, changes in interest
expense, the ability to develop and implement new technologies, competitive
factors, changes in effective tax rates, the loss of key personnel or the
shortage of available skilled workers, international political or economic
events, currency and interest rate fluctuations, environmental events, and
intellectual property transactions and disputes. Unfavorable changes in any of
the above factors may adversely affect the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations. In addition, the Company increases its
level of operating expenses and investment in manufacturing capacity in
anticipation of future growth in revenues. To the extent the Company's revenues
do not grow as anticipated, the Company's financial condition and operating
results may be materially adversely affected. See "Risk Factors -- Fluctuations
in Operating Results; Declines in Average Selling Price."
                                       45
<PAGE>   46
 
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
 
     At December 31, 1997, the Company had cash and cash equivalents of $90.9
million and a working capital deficit of $196.9 million ($63.2 and $224.6
million, respectively, on a pro forma basis, after giving effect to the
termination of AEI's S Corporation status and the distribution of undistributed
earnings through December 31, 1997). The Company's working capital deficit
resulted primarily from the significant amount of its short-term debt, primarily
incurred in connection with the expansion of its Philippine operations, together
with approximately $105 million of term loans which have been reclassified as
current liabilities as a result of the non-compliance by the Company with
certain covenants thereunder. The Company's non-compliance with certain
covenants with respect to the Non-Compliant Loans, the aggregate outstanding
amount of which was $176 million as of December 31, 1997, triggered
cross-defaults with respect to an additional $10 million of the Company's loans.
These loan covenants include restrictions on the ability of one of the Company's
subsidiaries to enter into transactions with affiliates, requirements that the
subsidiary maintain certain debt-to-equity ratios and requirements that the
subsidiary comply with certain notice requirements. The Company's obligation to
repay these loans (including the cross-defaulted loans) may be accelerated by
the lenders at any time. As a result of such non-compliance, the report of the
Company's independent public accountants with respect to the Company's financial
statements included herein contains a paragraph stating that there is
substantial doubt as to the ability of the Company to continue as a going
concern. The Company will eliminate such non-compliance and cross-defaults by
repaying such loans using part of the net proceeds to the Company from the
Offerings as well as working capital. See "Use of Proceeds" and "Risk
Factors -- Risks Associated with Leverage."
 
     The Company will use the net proceeds received from the Offerings primarily
to repay an aggregate of approximately $313 million of short-term and long-term
debt, including the Non-Compliant Loans (which, following repayments of portions
thereof prior to the Offerings, have an aggregate outstanding balance of $154
million), $63 million of short-term loans, $8 million of term loans and $88
million of amounts due to AUSA. In addition, the Company will use approximately
$34 million of such net proceeds to repurchase AICL's 40% interest in AAP. See
"Use of Proceeds." Following the expected application of the estimated net
proceeds of the Offerings to the Company together with repayments of debt prior
to the Offerings, the Company will have $57 million of short-term borrowing and
current portion of long-term debt, $215 million of long-term debt and no amounts
then due to AUSA. In addition, the remaining $132 million of such net proceeds
will be available for capital expenditures and working capital.
 
     The Company has been investing significant amounts of capital to increase
its packaging and test services capacity, including the construction of P3, the
addition of capacity in the Company's other Philippine facilities and the
construction of a new manufacturing facility in the United States. Advanced
packaging processes are being developed at the U.S. facility and full scale
operations are expected to begin in 1999. In 1995, 1996, and 1997, the Company
made capital expenditures of $123.6 million, $185.1 million and $179.0 million,
respectively. Because the Company and AICL have added a significant amount of
packaging and test capacity in recent years, the Company intends to decrease its
level of capital expenditures in 1998. The Company currently intends to spend
approximately $60 million in capital expenditures in 1998, including for the new
factory in the U.S. and moderate capacity expansion at the Company's existing
facilities in the Philippines to meet expected demand. The Company believes that
expenditure levels could increase substantially in 1999 to provide the Company
with adequate capacity.
 
     The Company believes that following the application of the net proceeds
from the Offerings, its existing cash balances, cash flow from operations,
available equipment lease financing, bank borrowings and financing obtained
through AUSA will be sufficient to meet its anticipated cash requirements
including working capital and capital expenditures, for at least the next 12
months. In addition, the Company intends to seek out strategic long-term
financing arrangements to fund part of its capital expansion plans in 1998.
There can be no assurance, however, that lower than expected revenues, increased
expenses, increased costs associated with the purchase or maintenance of capital
equipment, decisions to increase planned capacity or other events will not cause
the Company to seek more capital, or to seek capital sooner than currently
expected. The timing and amount of the Company's actual capital requirements
cannot be precisely determined and will depend on a number of factors, including
demand for the Company's services, availability of capital equipment, fluctua-
                                       46
<PAGE>   47
 
tions in foreign currency exchange rates, changes in semiconductor industry
conditions and competitive factors. There can be no assurance that such
additional financing will be available when needed or, if available, will be
available on satisfactory terms. Failure to obtain any such financing could have
a material adverse effect on the Company. In addition, if the Company obtains
such financing by selling equity securities of the Company, the Company's
stockholders may experience significant dilution.
 
     The Company historically has met a significant portion of its cash
requirements for working capital and capital expenditures from a combination of
cash from operating activities, short-term and long-term bank loans and
financing obtained for the benefit of the Company by AUSA, a wholly-owned
financing subsidiary of AICL, as well as financing from a trade receivables
securitization agreement. Cash provided by operating activities in 1995, 1996
and 1997 was $53.3 million, $8.6 million, and $250.1 million, respectively. Cash
provided (used) by financing activities was $71.2 million, $148.0 million and
$(16.0) million for 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively.
 
     At December 31, 1997, the Company's debt consisted of $326.0 million of
borrowings classified as current liabilities, $38.3 million of long-term debt
and capital lease obligations and $149.8 million of amounts due to AUSA. Prior
to the Offerings, the Company repaid approximately $47.1 million of its
short-term debt and $47.6 million of amounts due to AUSA. In addition, $13.9
million of amounts due to AUSA was assumed by AK Investments, Inc., an affiliate
of the Company, in February 1998. As of December 31, 1997, the Company had
extended guarantees in respect of bank debt of affiliates in the amount of $31
million and in respect of vendor obligations of an affiliate in the amount of
$24.7 million, which amount may vary over time. At December 31, 1997, the
Company had $223.9 million in borrowing facilities with a number of domestic and
foreign banks, of which $36.2 million remained unused. Certain of these
agreements require compliance with certain financial covenants and restrictions,
and are collateralized by assets of the Company. These facilities are typically
revolving lines of credit and working capital facilities for one-year renewable
periods and generally bear interest at rates ranging from 7.2% to 13%. Long-term
debt and capital lease obligations outstanding at December 31, 1997 have various
expiration dates through April 2004, and accrue interest at rates ranging from
6.7% to 12.5%. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
     The Company has met a significant portion of its financing needs through
financing arrangements obtained by AUSA, AICL's wholly-owned financing
subsidiary. A majority of the amount due to AUSA represents outstanding amounts
under financing obtained by AUSA for the benefit of the Company, with the
balance representing payables to AUSA for packaging and service charges paid to
AICL. Based on guarantees provided by AICL, AUSA obtains for the benefit of the
Company a continuous series of short-term financing arrangements which generally
are less than six months in duration, and typically are less than two months in
duration. Because of the short term nature of these loans, the flows of cash to
and from AUSA under this arrangement are significant. At December 31, 1997, the
Company had fully utilized $149.8 million of the credit facilities available to
the Company through AUSA. These credit facilities are with U.S. branches of a
number of banks located in Korea and have interest rates ranging from
approximately 6.9% to prime plus 8.5% (17% at December 31, 1997). Because of the
recent deterioration of the Korean economy, Korean banks have begun to raise
interest rates applicable to their lending. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on
International Operations and Sales; Concentration of Operations in the
Philippines and Korea -- Korea." As its credit lines have been renewed, AUSA has
experienced a significant increase in interest rates, and there can be no
assurance that such increases will not continue. The Company reimburses AUSA for
certain of the interest charges incurred by AUSA under these credit facilities.
As an overseas subsidiary of AICL, AUSA was formed with the approval of the Bank
of Korea. If the Bank of Korea were to withdraw such approval, or if AUSA
otherwise ceased operations for any reason, the Company and AICL would be
required to meet their financing needs through alternative arrangements.
Although the Company believes that after the Offerings alternative financing
arrangements will be available, there can be no assurance that the Company or
AICL will be able to obtain alternative financing on acceptable terms or at all.
AUSA has received commitments from its banks indicating that they intend to
renew the facilities when they expire through at least April 1, 1999. AUSA has
extended similar terms to the Company with respect to amounts due to AUSA by the
Company. Accordingly, amounts due to AUSA are classified as non-current
liabilities on the Company's balance sheet at December 31, 1997. See Notes 2 and
6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
                                       47
<PAGE>   48
 
     At December 31, 1997, all of AUSA's debt of $319 million, the Non-Compliant
Loans of $176 million and the Company's obligations under the Receivables Sale
(as defined below) were guaranteed by AICL. AICL currently has a significant
amount of debt relative to its equity and is contingently liable under
guarantees in respect of debt of its subsidiaries and affiliates, including
AUSA. As of December 31, 1997, AICL and its consolidated subsidiaries had
guarantees outstanding in respect of debt of its non-consolidated subsidiaries
and affiliates in the Anam Group in the aggregate amount of approximately W857
billion, including the guarantees of the Company's loans. As a result of its
relationship with AICL, the Company's business, financial condition and
operating results are significantly dependent on AICL. There can be no assurance
that AUSA will be able to obtain additional guarantees, if necessary, from AICL.
In addition, a deterioration in AICL's financial condition could trigger
defaults under AICL's guarantees, causing acceleration of such loans. See
"-- Overview -- Relationship with AICL," "Risk Factors -- Dependence on
Relationship with AICL; Potential Conflicts of Interest" and "Relationship with
AICL."
 
     In July 1997, the Company entered into a trade receivables securitization
agreement with a commercial financial institution. Under the terms of the
agreement, the financial institution has committed to purchase, with limited
recourse, all right, title and interest in eligible receivables, as defined in
the agreement, up to $100 million (the "Receivables Sale"). Funds received
pursuant to the agreement reflect a discount of LIBOR plus 0.375% from accounts
receivable sold. The Company applied approximately $83.4 million of the initial
Receivables Sale proceeds together with approximately $17 million of working
capital to reduce the Company's indebtedness to AUSA, which amounts were
advanced by AUSA to entities controlled by members of James Kim's family. See
Note 2 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
     Prior to the consummation of the Reorganization, AEI was treated for U.S.
federal and certain state tax purposes as an S Corporation under the Internal
Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable state tax laws. As a result, AEI did not
recognize U.S. federal corporate income taxes. Instead, up until the Termination
Date, Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts had been obligated to pay U.S.
federal and certain state income taxes on their allocable portion of the income
of AEI. The Company, Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts have entered
into tax indemnification agreements providing that the Company will be
indemnified by such stockholders, with respect to their proportionate share of
any U.S. federal or state corporate income taxes attributable to the failure of
AEI to qualify as an S Corporation for any period or in any jurisdiction for
which S Corporation status was claimed through the Termination Date. The tax
indemnification agreements also provide that under certain circumstances the
Company will indemnify Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts if such
stockholders are required to pay additional taxes or other amounts attributable
to taxable years on or before the Termination Date as to which AEI filed or
files tax returns claiming status as an S Corporation. AEI has made various
distributions to Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts which have enabled
them to pay their income taxes on their allocable portions of the income of AEI.
Such distributions totaled approximately $19.8 million, $13.0 million and $5.0
million in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. The Company declared additional
distributions to such stockholders prior to the consummation of the
Reorganization in an amount equal to $27.7 million, as adjusted for net income
(loss) recognized by AEI and Amkor Technology, Inc. following December 31, 1997
and prior to the consummation of the Reorganization and less a distribution of
$8.1 million to such stockholders in March 1998, which distributions represented
AEI's cumulative net income in all periods prior to the Termination Date less
the aggregate amount of distributions previously made to such stockholders.
These final distributions are intended to provide such stockholders with the
balance of AEI's net income for which they have already recognized taxable
income. Through December 31, 1997, the amount of such undistributed net earnings
was $27.7 million. See "Reorganization" and Notes 1, 10 and 17 of Notes to
Combined Financial Statements.
 
FOREIGN CURRENCY TRANSLATION GAINS AND LOSSES
 
     The Company's subsidiaries in the Philippines maintain their accounting
records in U.S. dollars. This is due to the fact that all sales, the majority of
all bank debt and all significant material and fixed asset purchases of such
subsidiaries are denominated in U.S. dollars. As a result, the Philippine
subsidiaries' exposure to changes in the Philippine peso/U.S. dollar exchange
rate relates primarily to certain receivables and advances and other assets
offset by payroll, pension and local liabilities. To minimize its foreign
exchange risk, the Company selectively hedges its net foreign currency exposure
through short-term (generally not more than 30 to 60 days) forward exchange
contracts. To date, the Company's hedging activity has been immaterial.
 
                                       48
<PAGE>   49
 
                                    BUSINESS
 
     The following discussion contains forward-looking statements within the
meaning of the U.S. federal securities laws, including statements regarding the
anticipated growth in the market for the Company's products, the Company's
anticipated capital expenditures and financing needs, the Company's expected
capacity utilization rates, the belief of the Company as to its future operating
performance and other statements that are not historical facts. Because such
statements include risks and uncertainties, actual results may differ materially
from those anticipated in such forward-looking statements as a result of certain
factors, including those set forth herein, in "Risk Factors" and "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations."
 
     Amkor is the world's largest independent provider of semiconductor
packaging and test services. The Company believes that it is also one of the
leading developers of advanced semiconductor packaging and test technology in
the industry. The Company offers a complete and integrated set of packaging and
test services including IC package design, leadframe and substrate design, IC
package assembly, final testing, burn-in, reliability testing, and thermal and
electrical characterization. As of December 31, 1997, the Company had in excess
of 150 customers, including many of the largest semiconductor companies in the
world. Such customers include, among others, Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.,
International Business Machines Corp., Intel, Lucent Technologies, Inc.,
Motorola, Inc., National Semiconductor Corp., Philips Electronics N.V.,
SGS-THOMSON Microelectronics N.V., Siemens AG and TI.
 
     The Company recently began offering wafer fabrication services through
AICL's new deep submicron CMOS foundry. This foundry is currently capable of
producing up to 15,000 8" wafers per month. Through a strategic relationship
with TI, the Company and AICL have qualified .25 micron CMOS process technology,
and TI has agreed to provide to AICL .18 micron CMOS process technology during
1998. This foundry will primarily manufacture digital signal processors
("DSPs"), application specific integrated circuits ("ASICs") and other logic
devices. By leveraging the Company's leading position in semiconductor packaging
and test services, the new wafer fabrication services have enabled the Company
to become one of the first providers of a fully integrated, turnkey
semiconductor fabrication, packaging and test service solution.
 
     The Company provides packaging and test services through its three
factories in the Philippines as well as the four factories of AICL in Korea
pursuant to a Supply Agreement between the Company and AICL, under which AICL
provides packaging and test services to the Company. In 1996 and 1997, AICL
provided packaging and test services representing approximately 72% and 68%,
respectively, of the Company's net revenues.
 
INDUSTRY BACKGROUND
 
  Manufacturing Process
 
     The production of a semiconductor is a complex process that requires
increasingly sophisticated engineering and manufacturing expertise. The
production process can be broadly divided into three primary stages: (i) wafer
fabrication, (ii) assembly of die into finished devices (referred to as
"packaging") and (iii) testing of finished devices and other back-end processes.
 
                                       49
<PAGE>   50
 
                             [ORGANIZATIONAL CHART]
 
     The wafer fabrication process begins with the generation of a mask that
defines the circuit patterns for the transistors and interconnect layers that
will be formed on the raw silicon wafer. The transistors and other circuit
elements are formed by repeating a series of process steps wherein a
photosensitive material is first deposited on the wafer, the material is exposed
to light through the mask in a photolithography process, and finally, the
unwanted material is etched away, leaving only the desired circuit pattern on
the wafer. By stacking up the various patterns, the individual elements of the
semiconductor are defined. The final step in the wafer fabrication process is to
electrically test each individual chip in a wafer probe process in order to
identify the good chip for packaging.
 
     The fabricated wafers are then transferred to packaging facilities.
Semiconductor packaging serves to protect the chip, facilitate integration into
electronic systems, and enable the dissipation of heat from the devices. In the
packaging process, the wafer is diced into its individual die which are then
separated from the wafer and attached to a substrate via an epoxy adhesive.
Leads on the substrate are then connected by extremely fine gold wires to the
input/output ("I/O") terminals on the chips through the use of automated
machines known as "wire bonders". Each die is then encapsulated in a plastic
molding compound, thus forming the package, which then goes through several
additional finishing steps to prepare it for testing.
 
     Following packaging, each packaged device is then tested utilizing a
sophisticated test platform and program which tests the many different operating
specifications of the IC, including functionality, voltage, current and timing.
The completed devices are either shipped back to the customer or shipped
directly to their final destination.
 
  Trends Toward Outsourcing
 
     Historically, semiconductor companies manufactured semiconductors primarily
in their own factories. Independent packagers of semiconductors were used solely
to handle the overflow volume requirements of semiconductor companies.
Outsourcing of final testing and wafer fabrication was virtually non-existent in
the
 
                                       50
<PAGE>   51
 
early days of the industry. Over the past fifteen years, however, the need for
independent semiconductor packaging and test services has grown dramatically for
several reasons.
 
     First, semiconductor companies are facing ever-increasing demands for
miniaturization, higher lead counts and improved thermal and electrical
performance in IC packages. As a result of this trend, semiconductor packaging
is now viewed as an enabling technology requiring sophisticated expertise and
technological innovation. Independent providers of packaging and test services
have developed substantial expertise in packaging and test technology and new
package innovation. Semiconductor companies, having found it difficult to keep
pace using their internal resources, have come to rely increasingly on the
independent packaging and test services providers as a key source for new
technology development and innovation.
 
     Second, semiconductor companies are increasingly seeking to shorten their
time to market for new products. Having the right packaging technology and
capacity in place is a critical factor in reducing time to market. As packaging
solutions are identified for a specific product, semiconductor companies
frequently do not have the equipment or expertise to implement such solutions in
the volumes required, nor sufficient time to develop these capabilities before
introducing a new product into the market. For this reason, semiconductor
companies are increasingly leveraging the resources and capabilities of
independent packaging and test companies to deliver their new products to market
more quickly.
 
     Third, the packaging and testing of ICs has evolved into an increasingly
complex process that requires substantial investment in specialized equipment
and facilities. For example, the investment in facilities and equipment
necessary for a processing line capable of packaging 100 million ball grid array
("BGA") packages per year can be as much as $200 million. As a result of the
substantial cost of this manufacturing equipment, the equipment must be utilized
at a high capacity level for an extended period of time in order to be cost
effective. With semiconductor companies facing increasingly shorter product life
cycles, faster new product introductions and the need to continuously update or
replace packaging equipment to accommodate new products, it has become
increasingly difficult for semiconductor companies to sustain such high levels
of capacity utilization. Independent providers of packaging and test services,
on the other hand, can use existing equipment at high utilization levels over a
longer period of time for a broad range of customers, effectively extending the
life of the equipment.
 
     Fourth, as the cost to build a new wafer fabrication facility has increased
to over $1 billion, semiconductor companies have been forced to concentrate
their capital resources on core wafer manufacturing activities. As a result,
semiconductor companies are increasingly seeking to use independent packaging
and test providers who have the ability to invest the capital to develop new
packaging and test capacity. The Company believes that as the cost to construct
new wafer fabrication facilities continues to increase, semiconductor
manufacturers will increasingly seek to outsource packaging and test services.
 
     Fifth, there has been a recent growth of "fabless" semiconductor companies
whose core competency and focus is entirely on the semiconductor design process.
According to industry estimates, sales by fabless semiconductor companies have
grown from $3.2 billion in 1993 to $6.8 billion in 1996, representing 3.7% and
4.8%, respectively, of the worldwide market for semiconductors. The significant
growth in the number of fabless semiconductor companies has been driven in large
part by the ability of such companies to effectively outsource virtually every
significant step of the semiconductor manufacturing process. This development
has allowed fabless semiconductor companies to introduce new semiconductors very
quickly without committing significant amounts of capital and other resources.
The Company believes that increases in the number of fabless semiconductor
companies will continue to be a significant driver of growth in the independent
semiconductor manufacturing industry.
 
     These trends, combined with the growth in the number of ICs being produced
and sold, are driving increasing demand for independent packaging and test
services. According to industry estimates, independent packaging revenues are
expected to grow at a compound annual rate of approximately 16% over a period of
five years from $5.6 billion in 1997 to $11.6 billion in 2002. Today, nearly all
of the world's major semiconductor companies use independent packaging and test
service providers for at least a portion, if not all, of their packaging and
test needs.
 
                                       51
<PAGE>   52
 
     Many of the same forces that have driven the growth of independent
packaging and test have also been driving increasing demand for independent
wafer fabrication services. Moreover, because the cost of new wafer fabrication
facilities has been rising steadily, many semiconductor companies are seeking to
leverage their capital resources by outsourcing some or all of their wafer
fabrication needs. This is particularly true for newer, smaller geometry
technologies that are necessary for producing the newest, leading edge ICs,
because they cannot be produced in many semiconductor companies' existing wafer
fabrication facilities. As the demand for ICs with smaller geometries increases,
the Company believes semiconductor companies will increasingly utilize
independent wafer manufacturers.
 
  The Need for Turnkey Solutions
 
     The growing demand for independent wafer fabrication, packaging, and test
services has generally been served by separate wafer fabrication, packaging or
test companies. This creates inefficiencies for semiconductor companies which
must manage the delays, complex logistics and uncertainty inherent in utilizing
a different service provider for each step of the semiconductor manufacturing
process. Only a very few, if any, independent service providers have the
capability of providing a combination of wafer fabrication, packaging and test
services.
 
THE AMKOR SOLUTION
 
     Amkor is the largest independent provider of semiconductor packaging and
test services in the world. With its leading edge process technology and package
design expertise, the Company is able to provide its customers with a broad
range of new packaging solutions that enable faster, smaller and more powerful
ICs. Due to its size and industry-leading position, the Company is capable of
implementing and utilizing the capital equipment necessary for both new and
mature packages, thereby affording its customers an attractive alternative in
their capital allocation decisions. In addition, with AICL's new wafer
fabrication capabilities, the Company is able to offer a fully integrated,
turnkey semiconductor manufacturing solution.
 
STRATEGY
 
     Principal elements of the Company's strategy include:
 
     Maintain Product Technology Leadership. The Company believes that it is one
of the world's leading designers and developers of new semiconductor packaging
technology. The Company has designed and developed such leading edge leadframe
and laminate products as its PowerQuad(R), SuperBGA(R), fleXBGA(TM) and
ChipArray(TM) BGA packages. The Company is focusing additional design and
development efforts on new generations of the BGA packaging format and on "flip
chip" die attach technologies where the I/O pads on the chip are attached
directly to the package's substrate rather than with wire-bonded connections.
The Company employs a staff of leading semiconductor packaging technologists and
undertakes significant research and development activities in its Chandler,
Arizona and Philippines locations, as well as through joint development
activities with AICL's development staff in Korea. The Company intends to
continue to maintain its leading packaging technology position.
 
     Maintain Advanced Manufacturing Capabilities. The Company believes that its
tradition of manufacturing excellence has been a key factor in its success in
attracting and retaining customers, and it is committed to maintaining that high
level of excellence. Key to this effort is the Company's commitment to
continuous advancement of its process technology. The Company's development
teams work with its customers, suppliers, and others to develop new processing
technologies as well as pursue continuous improvements in the Company's existing
processing capabilities. These efforts have directly resulted in reduced time to
market, increased quality, and lower manufacturing costs.
 
     Leverage Scale and Scope of the Company's Packaging and Test
Capabilities. The Company believes that its scale of operations and its breadth
of product offerings provide it with several competitive advantages. First, the
Company believes that its size and position in the industry allow it certain
advantages in procuring key materials and manufacturing equipment. Second, the
Company is able to capitalize on the substantial economies of scale that result
from high utilization rates of its capital equipment, thereby lowering the
                                       52
<PAGE>   53
 
Company's per unit manufacturing costs and facilitating cost-effective solutions
for its customers. The Company's scale also allows it to offer an
industry-leading breadth of product offerings and to be a single source for many
of its customers' packaging requirements. The Company offers over 450 different
package formats and sizes with a variety of processing and materials options.
The Company added 175 and 139 new packaging options, respectively, in 1996 and
1997. The Company is committed to continued expansion of both its size of
operations and its scope of product and service offerings.
 
     Establish Industry Packaging Standards. The Company believes that by
bringing new package designs to market early, its designs are more likely to
become industry standards, which in turn will allow the Company to obtain higher
margins than its competitors for such new designs. The Company also seeks to
capture substantial market share and to spur the industry-wide adoption of its
new packages by investing aggressively in expanding its manufacturing capacity
for these packages. As a result, it is one of the leading providers of advanced
packaging solutions such as thin package formats and BGA packages. The Company
believes these package types will comprise some of the highest growth and more
profitable segments of the packaging market in coming years.
 
     Enhance Customer and Supplier Relationships. As the world's largest
independent provider of semiconductor packaging and test services, the Company
has developed long-standing strategic relationships with leading semiconductor
and electronics companies, its suppliers, and other developers of new
semiconductor technologies. The Company believes that these relationships have
allowed it to stay ahead of the constantly advancing demand curve for
independent packaging services. The Company has repeatedly developed
leading-edge packaging technologies that have met the requirements of newer IC
devices and that have been quickly accepted in the marketplace. The Company's
alliances with certain of its key equipment and material suppliers have enabled
the Company to achieve packaging and manufacturing process innovation and cost
reduction. Developing and maintaining these relationships within the industry
will continue to be an integral part of the Company's overall strategic
direction.
 
     Focus on Customer Service and Support. The Company believes that its focus
on customer service and support has been crucial in attracting and retaining
leading semiconductor companies as its customers. The Company has a firmly
established customer-oriented culture. To provide a dedicated customer support
infrastructure and to stay abreast of customers' expectations, the Company has
strategically established technical and sales teams near major customer
facilities and in acknowledged technology centers. In addition, the Company has
implemented direct electronic links with its customers to enhance communication
and facilitate real-time engineering data and order information flow.
 
     Provide an Integrated, Turnkey Solution. The Company seeks to provide a
complete turnkey solution comprising wafer fabrication, packaging and test
services. The Company recently began providing wafer fabrication services
through AICL's new deep submicron CMOS foundry. With the addition of wafer
fabrication, the Company is able to provide all stages of IC production for its
customers from the fabrication of wafers through the shipment of finished ICs.
The Company believes this integration will enable customers to improve the cost
and performance of their ICs and achieve faster time to market for both new
product introductions and production lead times.
 
                                       53
<PAGE>   54
 
PRODUCTS
 
  Packaging
 
     The Company offers a broad range of package formats designed to provide
customers with a full array of packaging solutions for both commodity and
advanced products. The Company's products are divided into three product
families: traditional leadframe, advanced leadframe, and laminate products as
shown in the following tables.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
TRADITIONAL LEADFRAME PRODUCTS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------
PACKAGE TYPE                               NUMBER OF LEADS  APPLICATIONS
- ------------------------------------------ ---------------  --------------------------------------
<S>                                        <C>              <C>
PDIP (Plastic Dual In-line Packages)            8-48        General purpose plastic IC package for
SPDIP (Shrink DIP)                              28-64       consumer electronic products such as
                                                            games, telephones, TV, audio equipment
                                                            and computer peripherals.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Hermetic                                       Custom       A line of mature, ceramic predominant
                                                            packages used especially for
                                                            high-reliability applications
                                                            (military, space and commercial
                                                            aviation).
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PLCC (Plastic Leaded Chip Carrier)              20-84       Used for logic, gate arrays, DAC,
                                                            processors and chip sets used in
                                                            larger form-factor items (copiers,
                                                            printers, scanners, desktop PCs,
                                                            electronic games and monitors).
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SOIC (Small Outline Integrated Circuit)         8-44        Designed for needs of lower lead
                                                            devices. End uses include consumer
                                                            audio/video and entertainment
                                                            products, pagers, cordless telephones,
                                                            fax machines, copiers, printers, PC
                                                            peripherals and automotive parts.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MQFP (Metric Quad Flat Package)                44-304       Adapted to meet the increasing
                                                            challenges of advanced
                                                            processors/controllers, DSPs, ASICs,
                                                            video-DAC, PC chip sets, gate arrays,
                                                            logic devices, multimedia and other
                                                            technologies for consumer, commercial,
                                                            office, automotive, PC and industrial
                                                            products.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PowerQuad(R)                                   100-304      Higher performance thermally enhanced
                                                            QFP package. Used for DSPs,
                                                            programmable logic devices,
                                                            microprocessors and micro-controllers,
                                                            high-speed and field programmable gate
                                                            array logic devices, ASIC and other
                                                            technologies requiring more thermal
                                                            performance than offered by standard
                                                            QFP packages.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PowerSOP(TM)                                    8-36        Higher performance thermally enhanced
                                                            SOIC package. Used for wireless RF
                                                            telecom devices, automotive,
                                                            industrial, disk drive, pagers, and
                                                            other technologies requiring more
                                                            thermal performance than offered by
                                                            standard SOIC packages.
</TABLE>
 
================================================================================
 
                                       54
<PAGE>   55
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ------------------------------------------
ADVANCED LEADFRAME PRODUCTS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------
PACKAGE TYPE                               NUMBER OF LEADS  APPLICATIONS
- ------------------------------------------ ---------------  --------------------------------------
<S>                                        <C>              <C>
TQFP (Thin Quad Flat Package)                  32-256       Designed for lightweight, portable
                                                            electronics requiring broad
                                                            performance characteristics, including
                                                            notebook computers, desktop PCs,
                                                            audio/video and telecommunications
                                                            products, cordless/RF devices, office
                                                            equipment, disk drives and
                                                            communication boards (e.g., Ethernet
                                                            and ISDN).
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
TSOP (Thin Small Outline Package)               32-48       Primary application is for SRAM, DRAM,
                                                            FLASH and FSRAM memory devices. End
                                                            uses include PC cards, PCMCIA
                                                            form-factor products, cameras
                                                            (still/video) and notebook computers.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
TSSOP (Thin Shrink Small Outline Package)       8-80        Designed for gate drivers,
                                                            controllers, logic, analog, memory
                                                            (SRAM, DRAM, EPROM, E2PROM),
                                                            comparators and optoelectronics.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SSOP (Shrink Small Outline Package)             8-64        Designed to enable end-products such
                                                            as pagers, portable audio/video
                                                            products, disk drives, and wireless
                                                            applications to be reduced in size and
                                                            weight.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>
 
                                       55
<PAGE>   56
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ------------------------------------------
LAMINATE PRODUCTS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------
PACKAGE TYPE                               NUMBER OF BALLS  APPLICATIONS
- ------------------------------------------ ---------------  --------------------------------------
<S>                                        <C>              <C>
PBGA (Plastic Ball Grid Array)                 119-544      Semiconductors for end users which
                                                            require the enhanced performance
                                                            provided by the integrated design of
                                                            PBGA, including microprocessors/
                                                            controllers, ASICs, gate arrays,
                                                            memory, DSPs and PC chip sets.
                                                            Designed for applications where
                                                            improved portability, form-factor and
                                                            high-performance are necessary,
                                                            including wireless products, cellular,
                                                            GPS, notebook computers, video cameras
                                                            and disk drives.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SuperBGA(R)                                    64-600       Designed for high-speed, high-power
                                                            semiconductors such as ASICs,
                                                            microprocessors, gate arrays, and
                                                            DSPs. Applications include wireless
                                                            products, notebook computers, PDAs,
                                                            video GUI and CPU/BUS boards.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
fleXBGA(TM)                                    133-412      Higher performance, lower profile
                                                            package than PBGA due to size
                                                            reduction made possible by denser
                                                            substrate. Ideal for high performance
                                                            disk drives, cellular phones, pagers,
                                                            wireless communications, DSPs and
                                                            micro-controller applications.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MicroBGA(TM)                                    8-200       Especially suited for memory devices
                                                            such as FLASH, SRAM, DRAM and FSRAM
                                                            technologies, microprocessors/
                                                            controllers and high value ASICs
                                                            requiring a low height, weight and
                                                            size packaging. End uses include
                                                            cellular and other telecommunications
                                                            products, disk drives,
                                                            notebooks/sub-notebooks, PDAs,
                                                            wireless and consumer systems and
                                                            memory boards.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ChipArray(TM)                                  36-128       Designed for semiconductors such as
                                                            memory, analog, ASICs and PLDs
                                                            requiring a smaller package than
                                                            conventional PBGAs. Applications
                                                            include cellular and other
                                                            telecommunications, notebooks/sub-
                                                            notebooks, PDAs, wireless systems and
                                                            GPS.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FlipChip                                         N/A        An enabling interconnect technology
                                                            which can be utilized in advanced IC
                                                            packages such as PBGA, chip scale and
                                                            flex circuit solutions to support
                                                            improved electrical requirements and
                                                            very high semiconductor density in
                                                            very small systems.
</TABLE>
 
================================================================================
 
                                       56
<PAGE>   57
 
     Traditional Leadframe Products. Traditional leadframe products are the most
widely recognized package types and are characterized by a chip encapsulated in
a plastic mold compound with metal leads surrounding the perimeter. This package
type has evolved from packages designed to be plugged into the circuit board by
inserting the leads into holes on the circuit board to the more modern
surface-mount design, in which the leads are soldered to the surface of the
circuit board. Specific package customization and evolutionary improvements are
continually being engineered to enable improved electrical performance and
multi-chip capability, as well as smaller printed circuit board footprints. The
Company offers a wide range of lead counts and body sizes within this product
group to satisfy customer die size variations. In addition, the Company offers
power versions of the SOP, PLCC, and MQFP package types which are specially
designed to handle today's high power ICs that need with enhanced heat
dissipation characteristics.
 
     Advanced Leadframe Products. The Company's customers are seeking
increasingly thinner packages, which has led the Company to develop newer, more
advanced leadframe products. The Company's advanced leadframe products are
similar in design to its traditional leadframe products. However, the advanced
leadframe products generally are thinner and smaller, have more leads, and have
advanced thermal and electrical characteristics which are necessary for many of
today's more advanced semiconductor applications. The TSOP, TSSOP and SSOP
packages are significantly smaller than the Company's traditional SOIC products,
while the TQFP package is a smaller version of the MQFP package. The Company
also offers power versions of these package types. The Company plans to continue
to develop increasingly smaller versions of these products to keep pace with
continually shrinking die sizes and increasing demands for miniaturization.
 
     Laminate Products. The laminate product family represents the newest and
fastest growth area for the Company and consists of products employing the BGA
format which utilize a laminate (plastic or tape) substrate rather than a
leadframe substrate. BGA technology was first introduced in the industry as a
solution to problems associated with the increasingly high lead counts required
for advanced semiconductors. As the number of leads surrounding the IC
increased, packagers attempted to maintain the size of the package by increasing
the proximity of the leads to one another. As a result, however, these high lead
count packages experienced significant electrical shorting problems and required
the development of increasingly sophisticated and expensive techniques for
producing circuit boards to accommodate the density of the leads. The BGA
methodology solved this problem by effectively creating leads on the bottom of
the package in the form of small bumps or balls. These balls can be evenly
distributed across the entire bottom surface of the package, allowing greater
distance between the individual leads. The Company's first product in this
family was the plastic BGA. The Company has subsequently designed additional BGA
type packages which include features that enable low cost, high volume
manufacturing methods as well as higher performance packages. These new laminate
products include: SuperBGA(R), which includes a copper heat-sink for heat
dissipation and is designed for very low profile, high power applications;
ChipArray(TM), which allows the package to be as small as 1.5 mm larger than the
chip itself; and MicroBGA(TM), which is designed to be approximately the same
size as the chip and uses a tape substrate rather than a plastic laminate. The
Company is currently designing newer versions of BGA packages to enable further
significant reductions in package size.
 
  Test and Related Services
 
     The Company also provides its customers with semiconductor test services.
The Company has the capability to test digital logic, analog and mixed signal
products. The combination of the Company's test operations together with AICL's
Korean test operations comprises one of the largest independent test operations
in the world. Providing test services requires a high level of communication and
integration between the Company and its customers. In order to enable
semiconductor companies to improve their time to market and to reduce costs,
there has been an increasing trend to put packaging and test operations in the
same location. The Company has capitalized on this trend by supplying its own
testers or by supplementing customer-supplied testers with handlers and other
related equipment.
 
     Although test services accounted for only 3.5% of the Company's total 1997
revenue and 13% of the total units shipped, the Company expects test services to
grow significantly during the next several years as customers seek to reduce the
time to market for their products by using contractors with test services at the
 
                                       57
<PAGE>   58
 
packaging site. In addition to final test services, the Company provides a full
range of other related services, such as burn-in test services, "dry pack"
services, "tape and reel" packing, and wafer "probing" or "sorting."
 
     The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, the amount of
the Company's net revenues and the percentage of total net revenues by product
type:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                            1994               1995               1996               1997
                                      ----------------   ----------------   ----------------   -----------------
                                      REVENUES     %     REVENUES     %     REVENUES     %     REVENUES      %
                                      --------   -----   --------   -----   --------   -----   --------    -----
                                                                (DOLLARS IN MILLIONS)
<S>                                   <C>        <C>     <C>        <C>     <C>        <C>     <C>         <C>
Traditional Leadframe..............   $   487     85.1%  $   699     75.0%  $   792     67.6%  $   801      55.0%
Advanced Leadframe.................        53      9.2       157     16.8       220     18.8       312      21.5
Laminate...........................         3      0.5        15      1.6        90      7.7       248      17.0
Testing and Other..................        30      5.2        61      6.6        69      5.9        95       6.5
                                      -------    -----   -------    -----   -------    -----   -------     -----
    Total..........................   $   573    100.0%  $   932    100.0%  $ 1,171    100.0%  $ 1,456     100.0%
                                      =======    =====   =======    =====   =======    =====   =======     =====
</TABLE>
 
  Wafer Fabrication
 
     The Company recently began offering wafer fabrication services through
AICL's new deep submicron CMOS foundry. This foundry is currently capable of
producing up to 15,000 8" wafers per month. Through a strategic relationship
with TI, the Company and AICL have qualified .25 micron CMOS process technology,
and TI has agreed to provide to AICL .18 micron CMOS process technology during
1998. The Company's right to the supply of wafers from the foundry is subject to
the TI Manufacturing and Purchasing Agreement, pursuant to which TI has agreed
to purchase at least 40% of the capacity of the foundry and under certain
circumstances has the right to purchase 70% of the capacity of the foundry.
Although the Company has received forecasts from TI which indicate that TI will
meet its minimum purchase obligation during the second half of 1998, during the
first quarter of 1998 TI's orders were below such minimum purchase commitment
and it is uncertain whether TI will meet its purchase obligations in the second
quarter due to market conditions and issues encountered by TI in the transition
of its products to .18 micron technology. There can be no assurance that TI will
place orders representing at least 40% of the capacity of this foundry during
this period or in the future. A failure by TI to comply with its minimum
purchase obligations or the cancellation of a significant wafer fabrication
order by TI or any other customer could have a material adverse effect on AICL's
and the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See
"Risk Factors -- Risks Associated with New Wafer Fabrication Business" and
" -- Intellectual Property."
 
     The new foundry's capability is targeted to meet the needs of customers for
DSPs, ASICs and other logic devices. As technological capability and the needs
for CMOS designs in this area change, the Company anticipates the need to add
embedded memory and special analog functionality to its core CMOS technology.
The Company plans to continue to focus its semiconductor technology development
efforts to serve the needs of the high performance digital logic market.
 
     With the addition of the wafer fabrication capability, the Company is able
to offer fully integrated turnkey semiconductor manufacturing services to its
customers. This complete turnkey solution will enable the Company to work with
its customers' IC designers to optimize the integration of IC design with wafer
fabrication, package design, and packaging and test processes. The Company
believes this integration will enable customers to improve the cost and
performance of their ICs and achieve faster time to market in terms of both new
product introductions and production lead times.
 
                                       58
<PAGE>   59
 
CUSTOMERS
 
     The Company currently has more than 150 customers, including many of the
largest semiconductor companies in the world. Set forth below is a list of the
Company's top 50 customers in 1997:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                              <C>                                 <C>
Actel Corporation                Integrated Circuit Systems, Inc.    Plessey Semiconductors
Altera Corporation               Integrated Device Technology, Inc.  Philips Electronics N.V.
Adaptec, Inc.                    Intel Corporation                   Robert Bosch GmbH
Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.     Lattice Semiconductor               Rockwell Corp.
Alcatel Mietec                     Corporation                       S3 Incorporated
American Micro Systems, Inc.     Level One Communications, Inc.      SGS-THOMSON
Analog Devices, Inc.             LSI Logic Corporation               Microelectronics N.V.
Atmel Corporation                Lucent Technologies Inc.            Siemens AG
Cirrus Logic                     Macronix International Co., Ltd.    SMC Corporation
Cypress Semiconductor Corp.      Matra Harris Semiconductors         Silicon Storage
Dallas Semiconductor             Maxim Integrated Circuits           Technology, Inc.
Delco Electronics Corporation    Microchip Technology Inc.           Symbios Logic
Digital Equipment Corp.          Microlinear                         TEMIC Semiconductors
Harris Corporation               Motorola, Inc.                      Texas Instruments
Hewlett-Packard Company          National Semiconductor                Incorporated
International Business Machines    Corporation                       VLSI Technology, Inc.
  Corporation                    NeoMagic Corporation                VTC Inc.
IC Works Inc.                    Northern Telecom                    Waferscale Integration, Inc.
                                                                     Xilinx, Inc.
</TABLE>
 
The Company's five largest customers collectively accounted for approximately
34.1%, 39.2%, and 40.1% of the Company's total revenues in 1995, 1996 and 1997,
respectively. The Company anticipates that this customer concentration will
continue at least for the foreseeable future. See "Risk Factors -- Customer
Concentration; Absence of Backlog."
 
MARKETING AND SALES
 
     The Company sells to and supports its customers through an international
network of offices located in close proximity to its largest customers and
concentration of customers, including offices in the United States (Austin,
Texas; Boise, Idaho; Chandler, Arizona; Dallas, Texas; Santa Clara, California
and West Chester, Pennsylvania), France, Singapore, Taiwan, and the Philippines.
A substantial majority of the Company's sales have historically been derived
from U.S.-based customers. See Note 15 of Notes to Combined Financial
Statements. The Company assigns each of its customers a sales and customer
support team consisting of an account manager, a technical program manager, and
one or more customer support representatives. The largest multinational
customers are typically supported from multiple offices. The Company's worldwide
force of account managers, customer service representatives and technical
product managers exceeds 200 personnel. In addition, an extended staff of
product management, process and reliability engineering, marketing and
advertising, information systems, and factory personnel supports the direct
account teams. Together, these direct and extended teams deliver an array of
services to the Company's customers including providing information and expert
advice on packaging solutions and trends, managing the start-up of specific
packaging and test programs, providing a continuous flow of information to the
customers regarding products and programs in process, and researching and
helping to resolve technical and logistical issues.
 
FACILITIES AND MANUFACTURING
 
  Facilities
 
     The Company provides packaging and test services through its factories in
the Philippines as well as its test facility in the U.S. A new packaging factory
is currently being equipped at the Company's Chandler, Arizona site with
expected start-up in 1999. In addition, the Company provides packaging and test
services
 
                                       59
<PAGE>   60
 
through AICL's four factories in Korea, which provide such services to the
Company pursuant to a Supply Agreement. In 1996 and 1997, AICL provided
packaging and test services which accounted for approximately 72% and 68%,
respectively, of the Company's revenues. In addition to providing world-class
manufacturing services, these factories provide purchasing, engineering, and
customer service support. The Company recently began offering wafer fabrication
services through AICL's new state-of-the-art .25 micron wafer foundry in Korea
pursuant to a Supply Agreement. The size, location, and manufacturing services
provided by each of the Company's and AICL's primary facilities is set forth in
the table below. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on Relationship With AICL;
Potential Conflicts of Interest," "-- Expansion of Manufacturing Capacity;
Profitability Affected by Capacity Utilization Rates," "-- Risks Associated with
New Wafer Fabrication Business" and "-- Inability to Obtain Packaging and Test
Equipment in a Timely Fashion."
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           APPROXIMATE
                                                           PLANT SIZE
      FACILITY                      LOCATION              (SQUARE FEET)           MANUFACTURING SERVICES
      --------                      --------              -------------           ----------------------
<S>                    <C>                                <C>             <C>
Company Facilities
P1                     Muntilupa, Philippines                579,000      Packaging and test services; packaging
                                                                          and process development
P2                     Muntilupa, Philippines                115,000      Packaging services
P3                     Province of Laguna, Philippines       249,000      Packaging and test services
AATS                   Santa Clara, California                 3,000      Final testing services; test program
                                                                          development; central shipping and
                                                                          logistics
A1 (1999)              Chandler, Arizona                     106,000      Packaging services for laminate
                                                                          products; package and process
                                                                          development
 
AICL Facilities
K1                     Seoul, Korea                          646,000      Packaging services, package and
                                                                          process development
K2                     Buchon, Korea                         264,000      Packaging services
K3                     Bupyung, Korea                        404,000      Packaging and test services
K4                     Kwangju, Korea                        597,000      Packaging services
 
Wafer Foundry          Buchon, Korea                         480,000      Wafer fabrication services
</TABLE>
 
     The Company's operational headquarters is located in Chandler, Arizona
while its administrative headquarters is located in West Chester, Pennsylvania.
In addition to an executive staff, the Chandler, Arizona campus houses sales and
customer service for the southwest region, product management, a technical
design center, planning, marketing and research and development. The West
Chester location houses finance and accounting, legal, personnel administration,
information systems, and serves as a satellite sales office for the Company's
eastern sales region.
 
  Raw Materials and Equipment
 
     The Company's packaging operations depend upon obtaining adequate supplies
of raw materials on a timely basis. The principal raw materials used in the
Company's packaging process are leadframes or laminate substrates, along with
gold wire and molding compound. The Company purchases raw materials based on the
stated demand requirements of its customers and its customers are generally
responsible for any unused materials that result from an overstatement of
demand. The Company works closely with its primary raw material suppliers to
insure the availability and timeliness of raw material supplies. In addition,
the Company negotiates worldwide pricing agreements with its major suppliers to
take advantage of the scale of its operations. The Company is not dependent on
any one supplier for a substantial portion of its raw material requirements.
 
     The Company's packaging operations and expansion plans also depend on
obtaining adequate supplies of manufacturing equipment on a timely basis. To
that end, the Company works closely with its major equipment suppliers to insure
that equipment deliveries are on time and the equipment meets the Company's
stringent performance specifications. In addition, an affiliate of AICL
manufactures semiconductor packaging equipment exclusively for the Company and
AICL at locations in close proximity to the Company's and AICL's
 
                                       60
<PAGE>   61
 
packaging facilities in the Philippines and Korea, respectively. See "Risk
Factors -- Dependence on Raw Materials Suppliers and Subcontractors."
 
  Total Quality Management
 
     The Company believes that total quality management is a vital component of
its manufacturing strategy. To that end, the Company has established a
comprehensive Quality Operating System designed to promote continuous
improvement and maximize manufacturing yields at high volume production while
maintaining the highest quality standards. Each of the Company's and AICL's
factories is ISO9002 and QS-9000 certified. ISO9002 is a worldwide manufacturing
quality certification program administered by an independent standards
organization. QS9000 is similarly an independently administered manufacturing
quality certification used by United States automotive manufacturers. The
Company believes that many of its customers prefer to purchase from suppliers
who are ISO9002 and QS9000 certified.
 
COMPETITION
 
     The independent semiconductor packaging and test industry is very
competitive, being comprised of approximately 50 companies, with about 15 of
those companies having sales of $100 million per year or more. The Company faces
substantial competition from established packaging companies primarily located
in Asia, such as Advanced Semiconductor Engineering, Inc. (Taiwan), ASE Test
Limited (Taiwan and Malaysia), ASAT Ltd. (Hong Kong), Hana Microelectronics
Public Co. Ltd. (Hong Kong and Thailand), Astra International (Indonesia),
Carsem Bhd. (Malaysia), ChipPAC Incorporated (Korea), Siliconware Precision
Industries Co., Ltd. (Taiwan), and Shinko Electric Industries Co., Ltd. (Japan).
Each of these companies has significant manufacturing capacity, financial
resources, research and development operations, marketing and other
capabilities, and have been operating for some time. Such companies have also
established relationships with many large semiconductor companies which are
current or potential customers of the Company. The principal elements of
competition in the independent semiconductor packaging market include time to
market, breadth of package offering, technical competence, design services,
quality, production yields, customer service, and price. The Company believes it
generally competes favorably with respect to these factors. On a larger scale,
the Company also competes with the internal manufacturing capabilities of many
of its largest customers.
 
     The independent wafer fabrication business is also highly competitive. The
Company expects its wafer fabrication services to compete primarily with
independent wafer foundries such as Chartered Semiconductor Manufacturing, Ltd.,
Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Company, Ltd. and United Microelectronics
Corporation, as well as with device manufacturers such as LG Semicon Co., Ltd.,
Hitachi, Ltd., Toshiba Corp. and Winbond Electronics Corporation, which provide
foundry services for other semiconductor companies. Each of these companies has
significant manufacturing capacity, financial resources, research and
development operations, marketing and other capabilities and have been operating
for some time. Many of these companies have also established relationships with
many large semiconductor companies which are current or potential customers of
the Company. The principal elements of competition in the wafer foundry market
include technology, delivery cycle times, price, product performance, quality,
production yield, responsiveness and flexibility, reliability and the ability to
design and incorporate product improvements. See "Risk Factors -- Competition."
 
RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
 
     The Company's research and development efforts are focused on developing
new package designs and process capabilities, and on improving the efficiency
and capabilities of its existing production processes and materials. The Company
believes that technology development is one of the key success factors in the
packaging market and believes that it has a distinct advantage in this area. In
addition to its internal development work, and its co-development work with
AICL, the Company also works closely with its packaging equipment and raw
material suppliers in developing advanced processing capabilities and materials
for use in the Company's production process. Currently, the Company is focusing
on development programs that extend the capability and applicability of the BGA
packaging format. These include high performance
                                       61
<PAGE>   62
 
BGAs for microprocessors and other high-end devices, and a chip size package for
memory. In addition, the Company is aggressively developing a flip-chip die
attach and connect process for its laminate packages that has the potential to
reduce packaging size and cost and improve package performance significantly.
The flip-chip packaging process involves attaching the die I/O terminals
directly to the lead circuits on the substrate without the use of gold wires. In
addition to providing a smaller package size, this process is expected to result
in significant improvements in packaging yields by eliminating the delicate wire
bonds from the package.
 
     As of December 31, 1997, the Company employed approximately 95 persons in
research and development activities. In addition, other management and
operational personnel are involved in research and development activities. In
1995, 1996 and 1997, the Company's research and development expenses were
approximately $8.7 million, $10.9 million and $8.5 million, respectively. The
Company expects to continue to invest significant resources in research and
development.
 
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY
 
     The Company currently holds 24 U.S. patents, five of which are jointly held
with AICL, related to various IC packaging technologies, in addition to other
pending patents. These patents will expire at various dates from 2012 through
2016. With respect to development work undertaken jointly with AICL, the Company
and AICL share intellectual property rights under the terms of the Supply
Agreements between the Company and AICL. The Supply Agreements also provide for
the cross-licensing of intellectual property rights between the Company and
AICL. In addition, the Company enters into agreements with other developers of
packaging technology to license or otherwise obtain certain process or packaging
technologies.
 
     The Company expects to continue to file patent applications when
appropriate to protect its proprietary technologies; however, the Company
believes that its continued success depends primarily on factors such as the
technological skills and innovation of its personnel rather than on its patents.
The process of seeking patent protection can be expensive and time consuming.
There can be no assurance that patents will be issued from pending or future
applications or that, if patents are issued, they will not be challenged,
invalidated or circumvented, or that rights granted thereunder will provide
meaningful protection or other commercial advantage to the Company. Moreover,
there can be no assurance that any patent rights will be upheld in the future or
that the Company will be able to preserve any of its other intellectual property
rights.
 
     Although the Company is not currently a party to any material litigation,
the semiconductor industry is characterized by frequent claims regarding patent
and other intellectual property rights. As is typical in the semiconductor
industry, the Company may receive communications from third parties asserting
patents on certain of the Company's technologies. In the event any third party
were to make a valid claim against the Company or AICL, the Company or AICL
could be required to discontinue the use of certain processes or cease the
manufacture, use, import and sale of infringing products to pay substantial
damages and to develop non-infringing technologies or to acquire licenses to the
alleged infringed technology. The Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations could be materially and adversely affected by such
developments. Litigation, which could result in substantial cost to and
diversion of resources of the Company, may also be necessary to enforce patents
or other intellectual property rights of the Company or to defend the Company
against claimed infringement of the rights of others. The failure to obtain
necessary licenses or the occurrence of litigation relating to patent
infringement or other intellectual property matters could have a material
adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of
operations. In addition, AICL has obtained intellectual property for wafer
manufacturing primarily from TI. The licenses granted to AICL by TI under the TI
Technology Agreements are very limited. Although TI has granted to AICL a
license under TI's trade secret rights to use TI's technology in connection with
AICL's provision of wafer fabrication services, TI has not granted AICL a
license under its patents, copyrights and mask works to manufacture
semiconductors for third parties. Although TI has agreed that TI will not assert
a claim for patent, copyright or mask work right infringement against AICL or
the Company in connection with AICL's manufacture of semiconductor products for
third parties, TI has reserved the right to bring such infringement claims
against AICL's or the Company's customers with respect to semiconductor products
purchased from AICL or the Company. As a result, AICL's and the Company's
customers could be subject to patent litigation by TI and others, and AICL and
the Company could in turn be subject to litigation by such customers and
                                       62
<PAGE>   63
 
others, in connection with the sale of wafers produced by AICL. Any such
litigation could materially and adversely affect AICL's ability to continue to
manufacture wafers and AICL's and the Company's business, financial condition
and results of operations.
 
ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS
 
     The semiconductor packaging process involves a significant amount of
chemicals and gases which are subject to extensive governmental regulations. For
example, liquid waste is produced at the stage at which silicon wafers are diced
into chips with the aid of diamond saws and cooled with running water. In
addition, excess materials on leads and moldings are removed from packaged
semiconductors in the trim and form process. The Company has installed equipment
to collect certain solvents used in connection with its manufacturing process
and has contracted with independent waste disposal companies to remove such
hazardous material.
 
     Federal, state and local regulations in the United States, as well as
environmental regulations in Korea and the Philippines, impose various controls
on the storage, handling, discharge and disposal of chemicals used in the
Company's and AICL's manufacturing processes and on the facilities occupied by
the Company and AICL. The Company believes that its activities, as well as those
of AICL, conform to present environmental and land use regulations applicable to
their respective operations and current facilities. Increasing public attention
has, however, been focused on the environmental impact of semiconductor
manufacturing operations and the risk to neighbors of chemical releases from
such operations. There can be no assurance that applicable land use and
environmental regulations will not in the future impose the need for additional
capital equipment or other process requirements upon the Company or AICL or
restrict the Company's or AICL's ability to expand their respective operations.
The adoption of new ordinances or similar measures or any failure by the Company
or AICL to comply with applicable environment and land use regulations or to
restrict the discharge of hazardous substances could subject the Company or AICL
to future liability or cause their respective manufacturing operations to be
curtailed or suspended.
 
EMPLOYEES
 
     As of December 31, 1997, the Company had approximately 9,100 full-time
employees, 7,450 of whom were engaged in manufacturing, 1,150 in manufacturing
support, 95 in research and development, 210 in marketing and sales, and 195 in
finance, business management, and administration. The Company's employees are
not represented by any collective bargaining agreement, and the Company has
never experienced a work stoppage. The Company believes that its relations with
its employees are good. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on Key Personnel and
Availability of Skilled Workforce."
 
                                       63
<PAGE>   64
 
                                   MANAGEMENT
 
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND DIRECTORS
 
     The executive officers and directors of the Company and their ages as of
December 31, 1997 are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                   NAME                     AGE                         POSITION
                   ----                     ---                         --------
<S>                                         <C>   <C>
James J. Kim..............................  61    Chief Executive Officer and Chairman
John N. Boruch............................  55    President and Director
Frank J. Marcucci.........................  62    Chief Financial Officer
Eric R. Larson............................  42    Vice President
Michael D. O'Brien........................  65    Vice President
Thomas D. George(1)(2)....................  57    Director
Gregory K. Hinckley(1)(2).................  51    Director
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
 
(1) Member of Compensation Committee.
 
(2) Member of Audit Committee.
 
     James J. Kim. James Kim has served as the Company's Chief Executive Officer
since September 1997. Mr. Kim founded AEI in 1968 and has served as its Chairman
since 1970. He has also served as the Chairman of the Anam group of companies
and a director of AICL since 1992. Mr. Kim is a director of CFM Technologies,
Inc. Mr. Kim earned B.S. and M.A. degrees in Economics from the University of
Pennsylvania. Mr. Kim is Chairman of The Electronics Boutique, Inc., an
electronics retail chain, and Forte Systems, Inc., an information technology,
consulting and outsourcing company.
 
     John N. Boruch. John Boruch has served as President and a director of the
Company since September 1997. Mr. Boruch has served as President of AEI since
February 1992. From 1991 to 1992 he served as AEI Corporate Vice President in
charge of Sales. Mr. Boruch earned a B.A. in Economics from Cornell University.
Mr. Boruch joined the Company in 1984.
 
     Frank J. Marcucci. Frank Marcucci has served as the Chief Financial Officer
of the Company since September 1997. Mr. Marcucci has served as the Chief
Financial Officer of AEI since joining AEI in 1980. Mr. Marcucci earned a B.S.
in Business Administration from Duquesne University and an MBA from the
University of Pittsburgh. Mr. Marcucci is a Certified Public Accountant.
 
     Eric R. Larson. Eric Larson has served as Vice President of the Wafer
Fabrication business of the Company since September 1997. Mr. Larson has served
as President of Amkor/Anam Semiconductor, a division of AEI, since December
1996. From 1979 to 1996 he worked for the Hewlett-Packard Company ("HP") in
various management capacities, most recently as Worldwide Marketing Manager for
disk products. In addition, Mr. Larson was the worldwide Manager of Sales and
Marketing of the IC Business Division of HP from July 1985 to May 1993. Mr.
Larson earned a B.A. in Political Science from Colorado State University and an
MBA from the University of Denver.
 
     Michael D. O'Brien. Michael O'Brien has served as the Vice President of
Packaging and Testing Operations of the Company since September 1997. Mr.
O'Brien has served as Corporate Vice President of AEI since 1990. Mr. O'Brien
earned a B.S. from Texas A&M University. Mr. O'Brien joined the Company in 1988.
 
     Thomas D. George. Mr. George has been a director of the Company since
November 1997. Mr. George was Executive Vice President, and President and
General Manager, Semiconductor Products Sector ("SPS") of Motorola from April
1993 to May 1997. Prior to that, he held several positions with Motorola,
including Executive Vice President and Assistant General Manager, SPS from
November 1992 to April 1993 and Senior Vice President and Assistant General
Manager, SPS from July 1986 to November 1992. Mr. George is currently retired.
 
                                       64
<PAGE>   65
 
     Gregory K. Hinckley. Mr. Hinckley has been a director of the Company since
November 1997. Mr. Hinckley serves as Executive Vice President, Chief Operating
Officer and Chief Financial Officer of Mentor Graphics Corporation since January
1997. From November 1995 until December 1996 he held the position of Senior Vice
President with VLSI, a manufacturer of complex ASICs. From August 1992 until
December 1996, Mr. Hinckley held the position of Vice President, Finance and
Chief Financial Officer with VLSI. From December 1991 until August 1992, he was
an independent consultant. Mr. Hinckley is a director of OEC Medical Systems,
Inc., a manufacturer of medical imaging equipment.
 
DIRECTOR COMPENSATION
 
     Directors who are also employees or officers of the Company do not receive
compensation for their services as directors. Non-employee directors are
eligible to receive an annual retainer of $15,000 plus per meeting fees of
$1,000 per board meeting and $1,000 per committee meeting attended. Directors
are reimbursed for travel and related expenses incurred by them in attending
board and committee meetings.
 
     1998 Director Option Plan. The Company's 1998 Director Option Plan (the
"Director Plan") was adopted by the Board of Directors in January 1998 and was
approved by the Company's stockholders in April 1998. The Director Plan will
become effective immediately prior to the Offerings. A total of 300,000 shares
of Common Stock have been reserved for issuance under the Director Plan. The
option grants under the Director Plan are automatic and non-discretionary. The
Director Plan provides for an initial grant of options to purchase 15,000 shares
of Common Stock to each new nonemployee director of the Company (an "Outside
Director") upon the later of the effective date of the Director Plan or the date
which such individual first becomes an Outside Director. In addition, each
Outside Director will automatically be granted subsequent options to purchase
5,000 shares of Common Stock on each date on which such Outside Director is
re-elected by the stockholders of the Company, provided that as of such date
such Outside Director has served on the Board of Directors for at least six
months. The exercise price of the options is 100% of the fair market value of
the Common Stock on the grant date, except that with respect to initial grants
to directors on the effective date of the Director Plan the exercise price will
be equal 94% of the initial public offering price per share of Common Stock in
the Offerings. The term of each option is ten years. Each option granted to an
Outside Director vests as to 33 1/3% of the optioned stock one year after the
date of grant, and as to an additional 33 1/3% of the optioned stock on each
anniversary of the date of grant, provided that the optionee continues to serve
as an Outside Director on such date so that 100% of the optioned stock may be
exercisable three years after the date of grant. In the event of the sale of all
or substantially all the Company's assets or the merger of the company with or
into another corporation, all outstanding options under the Director Plan may
either be assumed or an equivalent option may be substituted by the surviving
entity. Following such assumption or substitution, if the director is terminated
other than upon a voluntary resignation, such assumed or substituted options
will vest and become exercisable in full. If no assumption or substitution
occurs, each such option will vest and become exercisable in full. The Director
Plan will terminate in January 2008 unless sooner terminated by the Board of
Directors.
 
BOARD COMMITTEES
 
     The Board of Directors has a Compensation Committee and an Audit Committee.
The Compensation Committee is comprised of Messrs. George and Hinckley. The
functions of the Compensation Committee are to review and approve annual
salaries, bonuses, and grants of stock options pursuant to the Company's 1998
Stock Plan and to review and approve the terms and conditions of all employee
benefit plans or changes thereto. The Audit Committee is comprised of Messrs.
George and Hinckley. The functions of the Audit Committee are to recommend
annually to the Board of Directors the appointment of the independent auditors
of the Company, discuss and review in advance the scope and the fees of the
annual audit and review the results thereof with the independent auditors,
review and approve non-audit services of the independent auditors, review
compliance with existing major accounting and financial reporting policies of
the Company, review the adequacy of the financial organization of the Company,
and review management's procedures and policies relating to the adequacy of the
Company's internal accounting controls and compliance with applicable laws
relating to accounting practices.
 
                                       65
<PAGE>   66
 
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
 
     Summary Compensation. The following table sets forth compensation earned
during the fiscal year ended December 31, 1997, by the Company's Chief Executive
Officer and the four other most highly compensated executive officers whose
total salary and bonus during such year exceeded $100,000 (collectively, the
"Named Executive Officers").
 
                           SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           ANNUAL COMPENSATION(1)
                                                           ----------------------     ALL OTHER
             NAME AND PRINCIPAL POSITIONS                   SALARY        BONUS      COMPENSATION
             ----------------------------                  ---------    ---------    ------------
<S>                                                        <C>          <C>          <C>
James J. Kim, Chief Executive Officer and
  Chairman(2)..........................................    $500,000     $500,000       $  6,000
John N. Boruch, President(3)...........................     415,000      375,000          6,000
Frank J. Marcucci, Chief Financial Officer(4)..........     254,000      100,000        245,000
Eric R. Larson, Vice President.........................     220,000           --             --
Michael D. O'Brien, Vice President.....................     249,000      100,000             --
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
 
(1)  At the time of the Offerings, Messrs. Boruch, Marcucci, Larson and O'Brien
     will receive option grants of 300,000 shares, 100,000 shares, 85,000 shares
     and 85,000 shares, respectively, of Common Stock under the Company's 1998
     Stock Plan, in each case with an exercise price per share equal to the
     initial public offering price per share.
 
(2)  All other compensation for Mr. Kim represents the amount of insurance
     premium paid by the Company on Mr. Kim's behalf for a life insurance
     policy. Effective January 1, 1998, Mr. Kim is compensated at an annual
     salary of $750,000 and he may earn an annual bonus of up to $500,000 if the
     Company achieves its annual operating plan, as approved by the Company's
     Board of Directors.
 
(3)  All other compensation for Mr. Boruch represents the amount of insurance
     premium paid by the Company on Mr. Boruch's behalf for a life insurance
     policy.
 
(4)  All other compensation for Mr. Marcucci represents the amount of insurance
     premium paid by the Company on Mr. Marcucci's behalf for a life insurance
     policy together with a bonus paid to Mr. Marcucci to cover the income taxes
     owed by Mr. Marcucci as a result of the payment of such insurance premium.
 
STOCK PLANS
 
     1998 Stock Plan. The Company's 1998 Stock Plan (the "1998 Plan") provides
for the grant to employees of incentive stock options within the meaning of
Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 (the "Code"), and for the grant
to employees, directors and consultants of nonstatutory stock options and stock
purchase rights. The 1998 Plan was adopted by the Board of Directors in January
1998 and was approved by the Company's stockholders in April 1998. Unless
terminated sooner, the 1998 Plan will terminate automatically in January 2008.
The maximum aggregate number of shares which may be optioned and sold under the
1998 Plan is 5,000,000, plus an annual increase to be added on each anniversary
date of the adoption of the 1998 Plan equal to the lesser of (i) the number of
shares of Common Stock needed to restore the maximum aggregate number of shares
of Common Stock which may be optioned and sold under the 1998 to 5,000,000, or
(ii) a lesser amount determined by the Board of Directors.
 
     The 1998 Plan may be administered by the Board of Directors or a committee
appointed by the Board of Directors (the "Committee"), which Committee shall, in
the case of options intended to qualify as "performance-based compensation"
within the meaning of Section 162(m) of the Code, consist of two or more
"outside directors" within the meaning of Section 162(m) of the Code. The Board
of Directors or the Committee, as applicable, has the power to determine the
terms of options granted, including the exercise price and the fair market
value, to reduce the exercise price of any option to the then current fair
market price if the fair market value of the Common Stock covered by such option
shall have declined since the date the option was granted, the number of shares
subject to the option or stock purchase right, and the exercisability thereof
and the form of consideration payable upon such exercise. In addition, the Board
of Directors has the
 
                                       66
<PAGE>   67
 
authority to amend, suspend or terminate the 1998 Plan, provided that no such
action may affect any share of Common Stock previously issued and sold or any
option previously granted under the 1998 Plan.
 
     Unless determined otherwise by the administrators, options and stock
purchase rights granted under the 1998 Plan are not transferable by the
optionee, and each option and stock purchase right is generally exercisable
during the lifetime of the optionee only by such optionee. Options granted under
the 1998 Plan must generally be exercised within three months following
termination of an optionee's status as an employee, director or consultant of
the Company, within twelve months after an optionee's termination by disability,
and within twelve months after an optionee's termination by death, but in no
event later than the expiration of the option. In the case of stock purchase
rights, unless the administrator determines otherwise, a restricted stock
purchase agreement shall grant the Company a repurchase option exercisable upon
the voluntary or involuntary termination of the purchaser's employment with the
Company for any reason (including death or disability). The purchase price for
shares repurchased pursuant to a restricted stock purchase agreement shall be
the original price paid by the purchaser and may be paid by cancellation of any
indebtedness of the purchaser to the Company. The repurchase option shall lapse
at a rate determined by the administrator. The exercise price of all incentive
stock options granted under the 1998 Plan must be at least equal to the fair
market value of the shares on the date of grant. The exercise price of
nonstatutory stock options granted under the 1998 Plan is determined by the
Committee, but with respect to nonstatutory stock options intended to qualify as
"performance-based compensation" within the meaning of Section 162(m) of the
Code, the exercise price must be at least equal to the fair market value of the
Common Stock on the date of grant. With respect to any employee who owns stock
possessing more than ten percent of the voting power of all classes of the
Company's, or any parent or subsidiary of the Company's outstanding capital
stock, the exercise price of any incentive stock option granted to such person
must equal at least 110% of the fair market value of the Common Stock on the
date of grant and the term of such incentive stock option must not exceed five
years. The term of all other options granted under the 1998 Plan may not exceed
ten years.
 
     The 1998 Plan provides that in the event of a merger of the Company with or
into another corporation, or a sale of substantially all of the Company's
assets, each outstanding option and stock purchase right will be assumed or
substituted for by the successor corporation. In the event the successor
corporation refuses to assume or substitute for the option or stock purchase
right, the optionee shall have the right to exercise all of the optioned stock,
including shares as to which it would not otherwise be exercisable.
 
     1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees. The 1998 Stock Option Plan for
French Employees (the "French Plan") was approved by the Board of Directors in
April 1998. Unless terminated sooner, the French Plan will continue in existence
for 5 years. The French Plan provides for the granting of options to employees
of Amkor/Anam EuroServices S.A.R.L. and Amkor Wafer Fabrication Services SARL,
the Company's French subsidiaries (the "French Subsidiaries"). A total of
250,000 shares of Common Stock have been reserved for issuance under the French
Plan plus an annual increase to be added on each anniversary date of the
adoption of the French Plan equal to the lesser of (i) the number of shares of
Common Stock needed to restore the maximum aggregate number of shares of Common
Stock which may be optioned and sold under the French Plan to 250,000, or (ii) a
lesser amount determined by the Board of Directors. Options granted under the
French Plan are not transferable by the optionee other than by will or by the
laws of descent and distribution. The exercise price for each option granted
under the French Plan shall be 100% of the fair market value of the shares of
Common Stock on the date the option is granted and the maximum term of the
option must not exceed ten years.
 
     Stock options granted under the French Plan vest over a five year period
with 50% of the shares subject to cash options vesting on the second anniversary
of the vesting commencement date and 1/24 of the remaining shares subject to
each option vesting each month thereafter. Shares subject to the options granted
under the French Plan may not be transferred, assigned or hypothecated in any
manner other than by will or the laws of descent or distribution before the date
which is five years after the date of grant.
 
     The French Plan may be administered by the Board of Directors or a
committee appointed by the Board of Directors (the "Committee"). The Board of
Directors or the Committee, as applicable, has the power to determine the terms
of options granted, including the exercise price and the fair market value the
number of
 
                                       67
<PAGE>   68
 
shares subject to the option and the exercisability thereof and the form of
consideration payable upon such exercise. In addition, the Board of Directors
has the authority to amend, suspend or terminate the French Plan, provided that
no such action may affect any share of Common Stock previously issued and sold
or any option previously granted under the French Plan.
 
     Unless determined otherwise by the administrators, options granted under
the French Plan are not transferable by the optionee, and each option is
generally exercisable during the lifetime of the optionee only by such optionee.
Options granted under the French Plan must generally be exercised within 30 days
following termination of an optionee's status as an employee of either of the
French Subsidiaries, within six months after an optionee's termination by
disability, and within six months after an optionee's termination by death, but
in no event later than the expiration of the option. The term of all options
granted under the French Plan may not exceed ten years.
 
     The French Plan provides that in the event of a merger of the Company with
or into another corporation, or a sale of substantially all of the Company's
assets, each outstanding option will be assumed or substituted for by the
successor corporation. In the event the successor corporation refuses to assume
or substitute for the option, the optionee shall have the right to exercise all
of the optioned stock, including shares as to which it would not otherwise be
exercisable.
 
     1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. The Company's 1998 Employee Stock
Purchase Plan (the "Purchase Plan") was adopted by the Board of Directors in
January 1998 and was approved by the stockholders in April 1998. The Company
does not intend to implement the Purchase Plan until after the Offerings. A
total of 1,000,000 shares of Common Stock have been made available for sale
under the Purchase Plan and an annual increase is to be added on each
anniversary date of the adoption of the Purchase Plan equal to the lesser of (i)
the number of shares needed to restore the maximum aggregate number of shares
available for sale under the Purchase Plan to 1,000,000, or (ii) a lesser amount
determined by the Board of Directors. The Purchase Plan, which is intended to
qualify under Section 423 of the Code is administered by the Board of Directors
or by a committee appointed by the Board. Employees (including officers and
employee directors of the Company but excluding 5% or greater stockholders) are
eligible to participate if they are customarily employed for at least 20 hours
per week and for more than five months in any calendar year. The Purchase Plan
permits eligible employees to purchase Common Stock through payroll deductions,
which may not exceed 15% of the compensation an employee receives on each pay
day. The Purchase Plan will be implemented by consecutive six-month offering
periods. The initial offering period and the date of subsequent offering periods
under the Purchase Plan will be determined by the Board of Directors after the
effective date of the Offerings. Each participant will be granted an option on
the first day of an offering period, and shares of Common Stock will be
automatically purchased on the last date of each purchase period within the
offering period. If the fair market value of the Common Stock on any purchase
date (other than the final purchase date of the offering period) is lower than
such fair market value on the start date of that offering period, then all
participants in that offering period will be automatically withdrawn from such
offering period and re-enrolled in the immediately following offering period.
The purchase price of the Common Stock under the Purchase Plan will be equal to
85% of the lesser of the fair market value per share of Common Stock on the
start date of the offering period or on the purchase date. Employees may end
their participation in an offering period at any time, and participation ends
automatically on termination of employment with the Company. In the event of a
proposed dissolution or liquidation of the Company, the offering periods then in
progress will be shortened by setting a new exercise date that is before the
dissolution or liquidation, and will terminate immediately prior to the
consummation of the proposed action, unless otherwise provided by the Board. In
the event of a proposed sale of all or substantially all of the Company's assets
or the merger of the Company with or into another corporation, each outstanding
option will be assumed or substituted for by the successor corporation. In the
event the successor corporation refuses to assume or substitute for the options,
the offering periods then in progress will be shortened by setting a new
exercise date that is before the sale or merger and the offering periods then in
progress will end on the new exercise date. Each participant will be notified at
least ten business days prior to the new exercise date, and unless such
participant ends his or her participation, the option will be exercised
automatically on the new exercise date. The Purchase Plan will terminate in
January 2008, unless sooner terminated by the Board of Directors.
 
                                       68
<PAGE>   69
 
401(k) PLAN
 
     The Company participates in a tax-qualified employee savings and retirement
plan (the "401(k) Plan") which covers certain of the Company's employees who are
at least 21 years of age. Pursuant to the 401(k) Plan, employees may elect to
reduce their current eligible compensation by up to 13% of eligible compensation
or the statutorily prescribed annual limit, whichever is lower, and have the
amount of such reduction contributed to the 401(k) Plan. After an eligible
employee completes one year of service and has attained age 21, he or she will
become eligible for the Company matching contributions effective as of the
quarterly entry date after meeting these service and age requirements. The
matching contribution amount is a discretionary amount as determined from time
to time by the Company. The 401(k) Plan is intended to qualify under Section 401
of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, so that contributions by
employees or by the Company to the 401(k) Plan, and income earned on plan
contributions, are not taxable to employees until withdrawn from the 401(k)
Plan, and so that contributions by the Company, if any, will be deductible by
the Company when made. The trustee under the 401(k) Plan, at the direction of
each participant, invests the assets of the 401(k) Plan in any of a number of
designated investment options.
 
PHILIPPINE PENSION PLANS
 
     The Company adopted a retirement plan for its eligible Philippine employees
and those eligible employees of designated affiliated companies and subsidiaries
of the Company, the Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Incorporated Employees' Retirement
Benefit Plan (the "Phillipine Plan"), originally effective January 1, 1988, and
most recently amended on January 1, 1997. Eligible employees are employees with
regular and permanent status that have been employed continuously for one (1)
year by a participating company. Currently, the companies participating in the
Phillipine Plan are AMI, AAAP, and Anam Amkor Precision Machine Company
(Phils.), Incorporated. At normal retirement age (age 60), death, or upon total
and permanent disability, a participant will receive a lump sum benefit payment
based on a percentage of his or her final base monthly salary, as determined by
his or her years of credited service. A participant who retires at age 50 with
at least ten (10) years of service will receive a reduced payment based on the
same formula. Company contributions to the Phillipine Plan are held in trust.
The Phillipine Plan is presently underfunded by $3.8 million. The amount by
which the Phillipine Plan is underfunded decreased from $7.2 million at
September 30, 1997 primarily as a result of payments made by the Company as
required under the plan and the effect of the recent devaluation of the
Phillipine peso to the U.S. dollar. See Note 9 of Notes to Combined Financial
Statements.
 
LIMITATIONS ON LIABILITY AND INDEMNIFICATION MATTERS
 
     The Company has adopted provisions in its Certificate of Incorporation that
eliminate to the fullest extent permissible under Delaware law the liability of
its directors to the Company for monetary damages. Such limitation of liability
does not affect the availability of equitable remedies such as injunctive relief
or rescission. The Bylaws provide that the Company shall indemnify its directors
and officers, and may indemnify its other employees and agents, to the fullest
extent permitted by Delaware law, including in circumstances in which
indemnification is otherwise discretionary under Delaware law. The Company has
entered into indemnification agreements with its officers and directors
containing provisions which may require the Company, among other things, to
indemnify the officers and directors against certain liabilities that may arise
by reason of their status or service as directors or officers (other than
liabilities arising from willful misconduct of a culpable nature), and to
advance their expenses incurred as a result of any proceeding against them as to
which they could be indemnified.
 
     There is no currently pending litigation or proceeding involving a
director, officer, employee or other agent of the Company in which
indemnification would be required or permitted.
 
                                       69
<PAGE>   70
 
                              CERTAIN TRANSACTIONS
 
     AICL was founded in 1956 by Mr. H. S. Kim, who currently serves as the
honorary Chairman and a Representative Director of AICL. AICL is a member of the
Anam Group of companies, consisting principally of companies in Korea in the
electronics industries. The management of AICL and the other companies in the
Anam Group are influenced to a significant degree by the family of H. S. Kim,
which, together with the Company, collectively owned approximately 40.7% of the
outstanding common stock of AICL as of December 31, 1997. A significant portion
of the shares owned by the Kim family are leveraged and as a result of this, or
for other reasons, the family's ownership could be substantially reduced. James
Kim, the founder of the Company and currently its Chairman and Chief Executive
Officer, is the eldest son of H. S. Kim. Since January 1992, in addition to his
other responsibilities, James Kim has been serving as acting Chairman of the
Anam Group and a director of AICL. Mr. In-Kil Hwang, the President and a
Representative Director of AICL, is the brother-in-law of James Kim. In
addition, four other members of Mr. Kim's family are on the 13-member Board of
Directors of AICL. In connection with the Reorganization, Mr. James Kim and
members of his family exchanged their interests in the Amkor Companies in return
for shares of Common Stock. After the Offerings, James Kim and members of his
family will beneficially own approximately 68.9% of the outstanding Common
Stock, and Mr. Kim and other members of his family will continue to exercise
significant control over the Company. The Company and AICL have had a
long-standing relationship. In 1996 and 1997, approximately 72% and 68%,
respectively, of the Company's revenues were derived from sales of services
performed for the Company by AICL. In addition, substantially all of the
revenues of AICL in 1996 and 1997 were derived from services sold by the
Company. The Company expects that the businesses of the Company and AICL will
continue to remain highly interdependent by virtue of their supply relationship,
overlaps and family ties between their respective shareholders and management,
financial relationships, coordination of product and operation plans, joint
research and development activities and shared intellectual property rights. See
"Relationship with AICL." and "Reorganization."
 
     The Company has entered into indemnification agreements with its officers
and directors containing provisions which may require the Company, among other
things, to indemnify the officers and directors against certain liabilities that
may arise by reason of their status or service as directors or officers (other
than liabilities arising from willful misconduct of a culpable nature), and to
advance to them expenses incurred as a result of any proceeding against them as
to which they could be indemnified.
 
     In connection with the Reorganization, the Company entered into tax
indemnification agreements with Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts
pursuant to which the Company will be indemnified by such stockholders with
respect to their proportionate share of any U.S. federal or state corporate
income taxes attributable to the failure of AEI to qualify as an S Corporation
for any period or in any jurisdiction for which S Corporation status was claimed
through the Termination Date. The tax indemnification agreements also provide
that under certain circumstances the Company will indemnify Mr. and Mrs. Kim and
the Kim Family Trusts if such stockholders are required to pay additional taxes
or other amounts attributable to taxable years on or before the Termination Date
as to which AEI filed or files tax returns claiming status as an S Corporation.
AEI has made various distributions to such stockholders which have enabled them
to pay their income taxes on their allocable portions of the income of AEI. Such
distributions totaled approximately $13.0 million and $5.0 million in 1996 and
1997, respectively. The Company declared additional distributions to such
stockholders prior to the consummation of the Reorganization in an amount equal
to $27.7 million, as adjusted for net income (loss) recognized by AEI and Amkor
Technology, Inc. following December 31, 1997 and prior to the consummation of
the Reorganization and less a distribution of $8.1 million to such stockholders
in March 1998, which distributions represented AEI's cumulative net income in
all periods prior to the Termination Date less the aggregate amount of
distributions previously made to such stockholders. These final distributions
are intended to provide such stockholders with the balance of AEI's net income
for which they have already recognized taxable income. Through December 31,
1997, the amount of such undistributed net earnings was $27.7 million. See
"Reorganization" and Notes 1, 10 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial
Statements.
 
     In February 1998 the Company sold its investment in AICL common stock to AK
Investments, Inc. ("AK Investments"), a company owned by Mr. Kim, for $13.9
million, the market value determined by the
                                       70
<PAGE>   71
 
closing price of AICL shares on the Korea Stock Exchange on the date of the
sale. In exchange for such shares, AK Investments assumed $13.9 million of the
Company's long-term borrowing from AUSA. See Note 6 of Notes to Combined
Financial Statements.
 
     Mr. Kim has executed certain guarantees to lenders in connection with
certain debt instruments of the Amkor Companies that remain outstanding. The
total contingent liability under such guarantees equalled approximately $87.0
million as of December 31, 1997. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial
Statements.
 
     The Company and Mr. Kim currently are parties to a loan agreement under
which Mr. Kim may borrow funds from the Company, subject to the Company's
consent. Mr. Kim has recognized compensation in 1996 and 1997 in the amount of
$101,716 and $3,000, respectively of imputed interest for loans under this
agreement. Since the beginning of the 1996 fiscal year, the maximum amount
outstanding under such agreement has been $6.5 million. All amounts due from Mr.
Kim have been repaid in full subsequent to December 31, 1997.
 
     In 1996, Mr. Kim sold his interest in Amkor Anam Test Services, Inc.,
representing half of its outstanding capital stock, to AEI for $910,350. See
Note 14 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
     AK Investments purchased certain securities held by AEI for $49.7 million,
which consideration was paid by assuming from AEI certain non-current payables
from AUSA. Subsequent to the sale of investments to AK Investments, AEI loaned
AK Investments an additional $12.8 million. The amount outstanding on this loan
as of December 31, 1997 was $4.4 million. See Notes 6 and 11 of Notes to
Combined Financial Statements. AK Investments repaid such amount in full during
March 1998.
 
     In 1996, the Kim Family Trusts borrowed $5.3 million at market interest
rates from AEI to purchase the real estate and develop the facilities that
comprise the Company's Chandler, Arizona plant and offices. In 1997, the Kim
Family Trusts, after making improvements, sold the real estate and facilities
back to AEI for $5.7 million which was used to repay the original loan from AEI.
See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
     Members of the Kim family own all the outstanding shares of Forte Systems,
Inc. ("Forte"). The Company and Forte currently are parties to a loan agreement
under which Forte may borrow funds at market interest rates from the Company,
subject to the Company's consent. Since the beginning of the 1996 fiscal year,
the maximum amount outstanding under such agreement has been $3.8 million. See
Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
     Members of the Kim family own all the outstanding shares of The Electronics
Boutique, Inc. (the "Electronics Boutique"). The Company and the Electronics
Boutique currently are parties to a loan agreement under which the Electronics
Boutique may borrow funds at market rates from the Company, subject to the
Company's consent. Since the beginning of the 1996 fiscal year, the maximum
amount outstanding under such agreement in the ordinary course of business of
the Electronics Boutique's business has been $3.0 million. In addition, in 1996,
the Electronics Boutique borrowed $50 million from AEI in connection with a
contemplated acquisition. However, this acquisition was abandoned by the
Electronics Boutique and the $50 million was repaid to AEI within eleven working
days of the date it was borrowed. Finally, the Company has guaranteed certain
vendor obligations and a line of credit of the Electronics Boutique, which total
approximately $24.7 million and $13.6 million, respectively as of December 31,
1997. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
     In addition, in each of the last three years, various Electronics Boutique
expenses were paid by the Company on behalf of Electronics Boutique and various
Company expenses were paid by Electronics Boutique on behalf of the Company.
These expenses include insurance premiums, employee medical claims, interest,
rent and other miscellaneous expenses. In 1995, 1996 and 1997, the Company made
net advancements on behalf of Electronics Boutique of $604,000, $128,000 and
$147,000. In 1997, Electronics Boutique repaid to the Company $2.4 million of
current and prior year advancements.
 
                                       71
<PAGE>   72
 
     The Company has executed a surety and guarantee agreement on behalf of
Electronics Boutique. The Company has unconditionally guaranteed Electronics
Boutique's obligation under a $17 million line of credit and a $9 million term
loan note. As of December 31, 1997, there was $750,000 outstanding under the
line of credit and $9 million outstanding under the term loan note. The Company
has also unconditionally guaranteed obligations of EB Canada, a subsidiary of
Electronics Boutique, under a $4 million term loan agreement and a $1 million
line of credit. As of December 31, 1997, there was $3.8 million outstanding
under the term loan and no amounts outstanding under the line of credit.
 
     The Company leases office space in West Chester, Pennsylvania from the Kim
Family Trusts. The lease expires in 2006. The Company has the option to extend
the lease for an additional 10 years. The monthly rent pursuant to such lease is
$92,000. The Company sub-leases a portion of this office space to Forte for
which the monthly rent is $43,000. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial
Statements.
 
     At December 31, 1996 and 1997, the Company had advances and notes
receivable from affiliates other than AICL and AUSA of $23.0 million and $36.5
million, respectively. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
 
                                       72
<PAGE>   73
 
                       PRINCIPAL AND SELLING STOCKHOLDERS
 
     The following table sets forth certain information regarding the beneficial
ownership of the Common Stock outstanding as of the date of this Prospectus, and
as adjusted to reflect the sale of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby, by
(i) each person or entity who is known by the Company to own beneficially 5% or
more of the outstanding Common Stock; (ii) each director of the Company; (iii)
each of the Named Executive Officers; and (iv) all directors and executive
officers of the Company as a group.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP               BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP
                                                PRIOR TO OFFERING     NUMBER OF    AFTER OFFERING(1)
                                               --------------------    SHARES     --------------------
              NAME AND ADDRESS                   NUMBER     PERCENT    OFFERED      NUMBER     PERCENT
              ----------------                 ----------   -------   ---------   ----------   -------
<S>                                            <C>          <C>       <C>         <C>          <C>
James J. and Agnes C. Kim(2)(3)..............  37,275,000    45.7%    5,000,000   32,275,000    28.7%
  1345 Enterprise Drive
  West Chester, PA 19380
David D. Kim Trust of December 31,
  1987(3)(4).................................  13,750,000    16.6            --   13,750,000    12.2
  1500 E. Lancaster Avenue
  Paoli, PA 19301
John T. Kim Trust of December 31,
  1987(3)(4).................................  13,750,000    16.6            --   13,750,000    12.2
  1500 E. Lancaster Avenue
  Paoli, PA 19301
Susan Y. Kim Trust of December 31,
  1987(3)(4)(5)..............................  13,750,000    16.6            --   13,750,000    12.2
  1500 E. Lancaster Avenue
  Paoli, PA 19301
Thomas D. George.............................          --      --            --           --      --
Gregory K. Hinckley..........................          --      --            --           --      --
John N. Boruch...............................          --      --            --           --      --
Eric R. Larson...............................          --      --            --           --      --
Frank J. Marcucci............................          --      --            --           --      --
Michael D. O'Brien...........................          --      --            --           --      --
All directors and executive officers as a
  group (7 persons)..........................  37,275,000    45.7     5,000,000   32,275,000    28.7
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Assumes no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment options. The number
    and percentage of shares beneficially owned is determined in accordance with
    Rule 13d-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the
    "Exchange Act"), and the information is not necessarily indicative of
    beneficial ownership for any other purpose. Under such rule, beneficial
    ownership includes any share as to which the individual or entity has voting
    power or investment power. Unless otherwise indicated, each person or entity
    has sole voting and investment power with respect to shares shown as
    beneficially owned.
 
(2) James J. and Agnes C. Kim are husband and wife. Accordingly, each may be
    deemed to beneficially own shares of Common Stock held in the name of the
    other.
 
(3) David D. Kim, John T. Kim and Susan Y. Kim are children of James J. and
    Agnes C. Kim. Each of the David D. Kim Trust of December 31, 1987, John T.
    Kim Trust of December 31, 1987 and Susan Y. Kim Trust of December 31, 1987
    has in common Susan Y. Kim and John F.A. Earley as co-trustees, in addition
    to a third trustee (John T. Kim in the case of the Susan Y. Kim Trust and
    the John T. Kim Trust and David D. Kim in the case of the David D. Kim
    Trust) (the trustees of each trust may be deemed to be the beneficial owners
    of the shares held by such trust). In addition, the trust agreement for each
    of these trusts encourages the trustees of the trusts to vote the shares of
    Common Stock held by them, in their discretion, in concert with James Kim's
    family. Accordingly, the trusts, together with their respective trustees and
    James J. and Agnes C. Kim, may be considered a "group" under Section 13(d)
    of the Exchange Act. This group may be deemed to have beneficial ownership
    of 73,525,000 shares or 65.3% of the outstanding shares of Common Stock
    after the Offerings.
 
(4) These three trusts together with the trusts described in note (5) below
    comprise the Kim Family Trusts.
 
(5) Includes 8,200,000 shares held by trusts established for the benefit of
    Susan Y. Kim's children.
 
                                       73
<PAGE>   74
 
                          DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
 
GENERAL
 
     Upon the closing of the Offerings, the Company will be authorized to issue
500,000,000 shares of Common Stock, $.001 par value, and 10,000,000 shares of
Preferred Stock, $.001 par value. Immediately after the closing of the Offerings
and assuming no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment options, the
Company estimates there will be an aggregate of 112,610,000 shares of Common
Stock outstanding, 3,145,900 shares of Common Stock will be issuable upon
exercise of outstanding options, 3,404,100 shares of Common Stock will be
reserved for issuance under the Company's 1998 Stock Plan, 1998 Stock Option
Plan for French Employees, 1998 Director Option Plan and 1998 Employee Stock
Purchase Plan and 13,333,333 shares of Common Stock will be reserved for
issuance upon conversion of the Convertible Notes.
 
     The following description of the Company's capital stock does not purport
to be complete and is subject to and qualified in its entirety by the
Certificate of Incorporation and the Bylaws, which are included as exhibits to
the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part, and by the
provisions of applicable Delaware law.
 
     The Certificate of Incorporation and the Bylaws contain certain provisions
that are intended to enhance the likelihood of continuity and stability in the
composition of the Board of Directors and which may have the effect of delaying,
deferring, or preventing a future takeover or change in control of the Company
unless such takeover or change in control is approved by the Board of Directors.
 
COMMON STOCK
 
     Holders of Common Stock are entitled to one vote per share on all matters
to be voted upon by the stockholders. Holders of Common Stock do not have
cumulative voting rights, and, therefore, holders of a majority of the shares
voting for the election of directors can elect all of the directors. In such
event, the holders of the remaining shares will not be able to elect any
directors. See "Risk Factors -- Benefits of the Offerings to Existing
Stockholders; Continued Control by Existing Stockholders."
 
     Holders of the Common Stock are entitled to receive such dividends as may
be declared from time to time by the Board of Directors out of funds legally
available therefor, subject to the terms of any existing or future agreements
between the Company and its debtholders. The Company has never declared or paid
cash dividends on its capital stock, expects to retain future earnings, if any,
for use in the operation and expansion of its business, and does not anticipate
paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future. See "Dividend Policy." In
the event of the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company, the
holders of Common Stock are entitled to share ratably in all assets legally
available for distribution after payment of all debts and other liabilities and
subject to the prior rights of any holders of Preferred Stock then outstanding.
 
PREFERRED STOCK
 
     The Company's Board of Directors is authorized to issue 10,000,000 shares
of Preferred Stock in one or more series and to fix the price, rights,
preferences, privileges and restrictions thereof, including dividend rights,
dividend rates, conversion rights, voting rights, terms of redemption,
redemption prices, liquidation preferences and the number of shares constituting
a series or the designation of such series, without any further vote or action
by the Company's stockholders. The issuance of Preferred Stock, while providing
desirable flexibility in connection with possible acquisitions and other
corporate purposes, could have the effect of delaying, deferring or making more
difficult a change in control of the Company and may adversely affect the market
price of, and the voting and other rights of, the holders of Common Stock. The
issuance of Preferred Stock with voting and conversion rights may adversely
affect the voting power of the holders of Common Stock, including the loss of
voting control to others. The Company has no current plans to issue any
additional shares of Preferred Stock. See "Risk Factors -- Anti-Takeover Effects
of Delaware Law and Certain Charter Provisions."
 
                                       74
<PAGE>   75
 
EFFECT OF DELAWARE ANTI-TAKEOVER STATUTE
 
     The Company is subject to Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation
Law (the "Anti-Takeover Law"), which regulates corporate acquisitions. The
Anti-Takeover Law prevents certain Delaware corporations, including those whose
securities are listed for trading on the Nasdaq National Market, from engaging,
under certain circumstances in a "business combination" with any "interested
stockholder" for three years following the date that such stockholder became an
interested stockholder. For purposes of the Anti-Takeover Law, a "business
combination" includes, among other things, a merger or consolidation involving
the Company and the interested shareholder and the sale of more than 10% of the
Company's assets. In general, the Anti-Takeover Law defines an "interested
stockholder" as any entity or person beneficially owning 15% or more the
outstanding voting stock of the Company and any entity or person affiliated with
or controlling or controlled by such entity or person. A Delaware corporation
may "opt out" of the Anti-Takeover Law with an express provision in its original
certificate of incorporation or an express provision in its certificate of
incorporation or bylaws resulting from amendments approved by the holders of at
least a majority of the Company's outstanding voting shares. The Company has not
"opted out" of the provisions of the Anti-Takeover Law. See "Risk
Factors -- Anti-Takeover Effects of Delaware Law and Certain Charter
Provisions."
 
TRANSFER AGENT
 
     The Transfer Agent and Registrar for the Common Stock is First Chicago
Trust Company of New York Shareholder Services, 525 Washington Boulevard, Jersey
City, NJ 07310; telephone (201) 324-0014.
 
                                       75
<PAGE>   76
 
                        DESCRIPTION OF CONVERTIBLE NOTES
 
     The Convertible Notes will be issued under an indenture to be dated as of
May 6, 1998 (the "Indenture") between the Company and State Street Bank and
Trust Company, as trustee (the "Trustee"), a copy of which has been filed as an
exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part. The
terms of the Convertible Notes will include those stated in the Indenture and
those made a part of the Indenture by reference to the Trust Indenture Act of
1939, as amended (the "TIA"), as in effect on the date of the Indenture. The
Convertible Notes will be subject to all such terms, and holders of the
Convertible Notes are referred to the Indenture and the TIA for a statement of
such terms. The following is a summary of important terms of the Convertible
Notes and does not purport to be complete. Reference should be made to all
provisions of the Indenture, including the definitions therein of certain terms
and all terms made a part of the Indenture by reference to the TIA. Certain
definitions of terms used in the following summary are set forth under
"-- Certain Definitions" below. As used in this section, the "Company" means
Amkor Technology, Inc., but not any of its Subsidiaries, unless the context
requires otherwise.
 
GENERAL
 
     The Convertible Notes will be general unsecured subordinated obligations of
the Company, will mature on May 1, 2003 (the "Maturity Date"), and will be
limited to an aggregate principal amount of $180,000,000 ($207,000,000 if the
Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised). The Convertible Notes will be
issued in denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in fully
registered form. The Convertible Notes are exchangeable and transfers thereof
will be registrable without charge therefor, but the Company may require payment
of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge in connection
therewith.
 
     The Convertible Notes will accrue interest at a rate of 5 3/4% per annum
from May 6, 1998, or from the most recent interest payment date to which
interest has been paid or duly provided for, and accrued and unpaid interest
will be payable semi-annually in arrears on May 1 and November 1 of each year
beginning November 1, 1998. Interest will be paid to the person in whose name a
Convertible Note is registered at the close of business on the April 15 or
October 15 immediately preceding the relevant interest payment date (other than
with respect to a Convertible Note or portion thereof called for redemption on a
redemption date, or repurchased in connection with a Designated Event on a
repurchase date, during the period from a record date to (but excluding) the
next succeeding interest payment date (in which case accrued interest shall be
payable (unless such Convertible Note of portion thereof is converted) to the
holder of the Convertible Note or portion thereof redeemed or repurchased)).
Interest will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year comprised of twelve
30-day months.
 
     Principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Convertible Notes will
be payable at the office or agency of the Company maintained for such purpose
or, at the option of the Company, payment of interest may be made by check
mailed to the holders of the Convertible Notes at their respective addresses set
forth in the register of holders of Convertible Notes. Until otherwise
designated by the Company, the Company's office or agency maintained for such
purpose will be the principal corporate trust office of the Trustee.
 
CONVERSION
 
     The holders of Convertible Notes will be entitled at any time on or before
the close of business on the last trading day prior to the Maturity Date of the
Convertible Notes, subject to prior redemption or repurchase, to convert any
Convertible Notes or portions thereof (in denominations of $1,000 or multiples
thereof) into Common Stock of the Company, at the conversion price of $13.50 per
share of Common Stock, subject to adjustment as described below (the "Conversion
Price"). Except as described below, no adjustment will be made on conversion of
any Convertible Notes for interest accrued thereon or for dividends on any
Common Stock issued. If Convertible Notes not called for redemption are
converted after a record date for the payment of interest and prior to the next
succeeding interest payment date, such Convertible Notes must be accompanied by
funds equal to the interest payable on such succeeding interest payment date on
the principal amount so converted. The Company is not required to issue
fractional shares of Common Stock upon
 
                                       76
<PAGE>   77
 
conversion of Convertible Notes and, in lieu thereof, will pay a cash adjustment
based upon the market price of the Common Stock on the last trading day prior to
the date of conversion. In the case of Convertible Notes called for redemption,
conversion rights will expire at the close of business on the trading day
preceding the date fixed for redemption, unless the Company defaults in payment
of the redemption price, in which case the conversion right will terminate at
the close of business on the date such default is cured. In the event any holder
exercises its right to require the Company to repurchase Notes upon a Designated
Event, such holder's conversion right will terminate on the close of business on
the Designated Event Offer Termination Date (as defined) unless the Company
defaults in the payment due upon repurchase or the holder elects to withdraw the
submission of election to repurchase. See "-- Repurchase at Option of Holders
Upon a Designated Event."
 
     The right of conversion attaching to any Convertible Note may be exercised
by the holder by delivering the Convertible Note at the specified office of a
conversion agent, accompanied by a duly signed and completed notice of
conversion, together with any funds that may be required as described in the
preceding paragraph. Such notice of conversion can be obtained from the Trustee.
Beneficial owners of interests in a Global Note (as defined) may exercise their
right of conversion by delivering to The Depository Trust Company ("DTC") the
appropriate instruction form for conversion pursuant to DTC's conversion
program. The conversion date shall be the date on which the Convertible Note,
the duly signed and completed notice of conversion, and any funds that may be
required as described in the preceding paragraph shall have been so delivered. A
holder delivering a Convertible Note for conversion will not be required to pay
any taxes or duties payable in respect of the issue or delivery of Common Stock
on conversion, but will be required to pay any tax or duty which may be payable
in respect of any transfer involved in the issue or delivery of the Common Stock
in a name other than the holder of the Convertible Note. Certificates
representing shares of Common Stock will not be issued or delivered unless all
taxes and duties, if any, payable by the holder have been paid.
 
     The Conversion Price is subject to adjustment (under formulae set forth in
the Indenture) in certain events, including: (i) the issuance of Common Stock as
a dividend or distribution on Common Stock; (ii) certain subdivisions and
combinations of the Common Stock; (iii) the issuance to all or substantially all
holders of Common Stock of certain rights or warrants to purchase Common Stock
at a price per share less than the Current Market Price (as defined); (iv) the
dividend or other distribution to all holders of Common Stock of shares of
capital stock of the Company (other than Common Stock) or evidences of
indebtedness of the Company or assets (including securities, but excluding those
rights, warrants, dividends and distributions referred to above or paid
exclusively in cash); (v) dividends or other distributions consisting
exclusively of cash (excluding any cash portion of distributions referred to in
clause (iv)) to all holders of Common Stock to the extent such distributions,
combined together with (A) all such all-cash distributions made within the
preceding 12 months in respect of which no adjustment has been made plus (B) any
cash and the fair market value of other consideration payable in respect of any
tender offers by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries for Common Stock
concluded within the preceding 12 months in respect of which no adjustment has
been made, exceeds 15% of the Company's market capitalization (being the product
of the then current market price of the Common Stock times the number of shares
of Common Stock then outstanding) on the record date for such distribution; and
(vi) the purchase of Common Stock pursuant to a tender offer made by the Company
or any of its subsidiaries to the extent that the aggregate consideration,
together with (X) any cash and the fair market value of any other consideration
payable in any other tender offer expiring within 12 months preceding such
tender offer in respect of which no adjustment has been made plus (Y) the
aggregate amount of any such all-cash distributions referred to in clause (v)
above to all holders of Common Stock within the 12 months preceding the
expiration of such tender offer in respect of which no adjustments have been
made, exceeds 15% of the Company's market capitalization on the expiration of
such tender offer.
 
     In the case of (i) any reclassification or change of the Common Stock or
(ii) a consolidation, merger or combination involving the Company or a sale or
conveyance to another corporation of the property and assets of the Company as
an entirety or substantially as an entirety, in each case as a result of which
holders of Common Stock shall be entitled to receive stock, other securities,
other property or assets (including cash) with respect to or in exchange for
such Common Stock, the holders of the Convertible Notes then outstanding will be
entitled thereafter to convert such Convertible Notes into the kind and amount
of shares of stock, other
 
                                       77
<PAGE>   78
 
securities or other property or assets, which they would have owned or been
entitled to receive upon such reclassification, change, consolidation, merger,
combination, sale or conveyance had such Convertible Notes been converted into
Common Stock immediately prior to such reclassification, change, consolidation,
merger, combination, sale or conveyance (assuming, in a case in which the
Company's stockholders may exercise rights of election, that a holder of
Convertible Notes would not have exercised any rights of election as to the
stock, other securities or other property or assets receivable in connection
therewith and received per share the kind and amount received per share by a
plurality of non-electing shares). Certain of the foregoing events may also
constitute or result in a Designated Event requiring the Company to offer to
repurchase the Convertible Notes. See "-- Repurchase at Option of Holders Upon a
Designated Event."
 
     In the event of a taxable distribution to holders of Common Stock (or other
transaction) that results in any adjustment of the Conversion Price, the holders
of Convertible Notes may, in certain circumstances, be deemed to have received a
distribution subject to United States income tax as a dividend; in certain other
circumstances, the absence of such an adjustment may result in a taxable
dividend to the holders of Common Stock. See "Certain Federal Income Tax
Consequences to Holders of Common Stock and Convertible Notes."
 
     The Company from time to time may, to the extent permitted by law, reduce
the Conversion Price of the Convertible Notes by any amount for any period of at
least 20 days, in which case the Company shall give at least 15 days' notice of
such decrease, if the Board of Directors has made a determination that such
decrease would be in the best interests of the Company, which determination
shall be conclusive. The Company may, at its option, make such reductions in the
Conversion Price, in addition to those set forth above, as the Board of
Directors deems advisable to avoid or diminish any income tax to holders of
Common Stock resulting from any dividend or distribution of stock (or rights to
acquire stock) or from any event treated as such for income tax purposes. See
"Certain Federal Income Tax Consequences to Holders of Common Stock and
Convertible Notes."
 
     No adjustment in the Conversion Price will be required unless such
adjustment would require a change of at least 1% of the Conversion Price then in
effect; provided that any adjustment that would otherwise be required to be made
shall be carried forward and taken into account in any subsequent adjustment.
Except as stated above, the Conversion Price will not be adjusted for the
issuance of Common Stock or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for
Common Stock or carrying the right to purchase any of the foregoing.
 
SUBORDINATION
 
     The payment of principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the
Convertible Notes will be subordinated in right of payment, as set forth in the
Indenture, to the prior payment in full in cash or other payment satisfactory to
the Senior Debt of all Senior Debt, whether outstanding on the date of the
Indenture or thereafter incurred. Upon any distribution to creditors of the
Company in a liquidation or dissolution of the Company or in a bankruptcy,
reorganization, insolvency, receivership or similar proceeding relating to the
Company or its property, an assignment for the benefit of creditors or any
marshaling of the Company's assets and liabilities, the holders of Senior Debt
will be entitled to receive payment in full in cash or other payment
satisfactory to the Senior Debt of all Senior Debt of all obligations in respect
of such Senior Debt before the holders of Convertible Notes will be entitled to
receive any payment with respect to the Convertible Notes.
 
     In the event of any acceleration of the Convertible Notes because of an
Event of Default, the holders of any Senior Debt then outstanding will be
entitled to payment in full in cash or other payment satisfactory to the holders
of such Senior Debt of all obligations in respect of such Senior Debt before the
holders of the Convertible Notes are entitled to receive any payment or
distribution in respect thereof. If payment of the Convertible Notes is
accelerated because of an Event of Default, the Company or the Trustee shall
promptly notify the holders of Senior Debt or the trustee(s) for such Senior
Debt of the acceleration. The Company may not pay the Convertible Notes until
five business days after such holders or trustee(s) of Senior Debt receive
notice of such acceleration and, thereafter, may pay the Convertible Notes only
if the subordination provisions of the Indenture otherwise permit payment at
that time.
 
                                       78
<PAGE>   79
 
     The Company also may not make any payment upon or in respect of the
Convertible Notes if (i) a default in the payment of the principal of, premium,
if any, interest, rent or other obligations in respect of Senior Debt occurs and
is continuing beyond any applicable period of grace or (ii) a default, other
than a payment default, occurs and is continuing with respect to Designated
Senior Debt that permits holders of the Designated Senior Debt as to which such
default relates to accelerate its maturity and the Trustee receives a notice of
such default (a "Payment Blockage Notice") from the Company or other person
permitted to give such notice under the Indenture. Payments on the Convertible
Notes may and shall be resumed (a) in the case of a payment default, upon the
date on which such default is cured or waived or ceases to exist and (b) in case
of a nonpayment default, the earlier of the date on which such nonpayment
default is cured or waived or ceases to exist or 179 days after the date on
which the applicable Payment Blockage Notice is received if the maturity of the
Senior Debt has not been accelerated. No new period of payment blockage may be
commenced unless and until 365 days have elapsed since the effectiveness of the
immediately prior Payment Blockage Notice. No nonpayment default that existed or
was continuing on the date of delivery of any Payment Blockage Notice to the
Trustee shall be, or be made, the basis for a subsequent Payment Blockage
Notice.
 
     By reason of the subordination provisions described above, in the event of
the Company's liquidation or insolvency, holders of Senior Debt may receive
more, ratably, and holders of the Convertible Notes may receive less, ratably,
than the other creditors of the Company. Such subordination will not prevent the
occurrences of any Event of Default under the Indenture.
 
     The Convertible Notes are obligations exclusively of the Company. However,
since the operations of the Company are primarily conducted through
Subsidiaries, the cash flow and the consequent ability of the Company to service
its debt, including the Convertible Notes, are primarily dependent upon the
earnings of its Subsidiaries and the distribution of those earnings to, or upon
loans or other payments of funds by those Subsidiaries to, the Company. The
payment of dividends and the making of loans and advances to the Company by its
Subsidiaries may be subject to statutory or contractual restrictions, are
dependent upon the earnings of those Subsidiaries and are subject to various
business considerations.
 
     Any right of the Company to receive assets of any of its Subsidiaries upon
their liquidation or reorganization (and the consequent right of the holders of
the Convertible Notes to participate in those assets) will be effectively
subordinated to the claims of that Subsidiary's creditors (including trade
creditors), except to the extent that the Company is itself recognized as a
creditor of such Subsidiary, in which case the claims of the Company would still
be subordinate to any security interests in the assets of such Subsidiary and
any indebtedness of such Subsidiary senior to that held by the Company.
 
     As of December 31, 1997 (after giving effect to the Reorganization), the
Company had approximately $32 million of outstanding indebtedness that would
have constituted Senior Debt, and the indebtedness and other liabilities of the
Company's subsidiaries (excluding intercompany liabilities and obligations of a
type not required to be reflected on the balance sheet of such subsidiary in
accordance with GAAP) that would effectively have been senior to the Convertible
Notes were approximately $642 million. After giving effect to debt repayments by
the Company prior to the Offerings and the application of the estimated net
proceeds to the Company of the Offerings, such amounts will be approximately $32
million and $220 million, respectively. The Indenture will not limit the amount
of additional indebtedness, including Senior Debt, that the Company can create,
incur, assume or guarantee, nor will the Indenture limit the amount of
indebtedness and other liabilities that any Subsidiary can create, incur, assume
or guarantee.
 
     In the event that, notwithstanding the foregoing, the Trustee or any holder
of Convertible Notes receives any payment or distribution of assets of the
Company of any kind in contravention of any of the terms of the Indenture,
whether in cash, property or securities, including, without limitation by way of
set-off or otherwise, in respect of the Convertible Notes before all Senior Debt
is paid in full in cash or other payment satisfactory to the holders of Senior
Debt, then such payment or distribution will be held by the recipient in trust
for the benefit of holders of Senior Debt, and will be immediately paid over or
delivered to the holders of Senior Debt or their representative or
representatives to the extent necessary to make payment in full in cash or other
 
                                       79
<PAGE>   80
 
payment satisfactory to such holders of all Senior Debt remaining unpaid, after
giving effect to any concurrent payment or distribution, or provision therefor,
to or for the holders of Senior Debt.
 
OPTIONAL REDEMPTION
 
     The Convertible Notes may not be redeemed by the Company prior to May 3,
2001. The Convertible Notes may be redeemed at the option of the Company, in
whole or from time to time in part, on not less than 15 nor more than 60 days'
prior written notice to the holders thereof by first class mail, at the
following redemption prices (expressed as percentages of principal amount) if
redeemed during the 12-month period beginning May 1 of each year indicated (May
3 with respect to 2001), plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date fixed for
redemption, if the closing price of the Common Stock on the principal stock
exchange or market on which the Common Stock is then quoted or admitted to
trading equals or exceeds 125% of the Conversion Price for at least 20 trading
days within a period of 30 consecutive trading days ending on the fifth trading
day prior to the date the notice of redemption is first mailed to the holders of
the Convertible Notes:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    REDEMPTION
                      YEAR                            PRICE
                      ----                          ----------
<S>                                                 <C>
2001............................................      102.30%
2002............................................      101.15
</TABLE>
 
and 100% at May 1, 2003.
 
     If less than all the Convertible Notes are to be redeemed at any time,
selection of Convertible Notes for redemption will be made by the Trustee in
compliance with the requirements of the principal national securities exchange,
if any, on which the Convertible Notes are listed or, if the Convertible Notes
are not so listed, on a pro rata basis by lot or by any other method that the
Trustee considers fair and appropriate. The Trustee may select for redemption a
portion of the principal of any Convertible Note that has a denomination larger
than $1,000. Convertible Notes and portions thereof will be redeemed in the
amount of $1,000 or integral multiples of $1,000. The Trustee will make the
selection from Convertible Notes outstanding and not previously called for
redemption; provided that if a portion of a holder's Convertible Notes are
selected for partial redemption and such holder converts a portion of such
Convertible Notes, such converted portion shall be deemed to be taken from the
portion selected for redemption.
 
     Provisions of the Indenture that apply to the Convertible Notes called for
redemption also apply to portions of the Convertible Notes called for
redemption. If any Convertible Note is to be redeemed in part, the notice of
redemption will state the portion of the principal amount to be redeemed. Upon
surrender of a Convertible Note that is redeemed in part only, the Company will
execute and the Trustee will authenticate and deliver to the holder a new
Convertible Note equal in principal amount to the unredeemed portion of the
Convertible Note surrendered.
 
     On and after the redemption date, unless the Company shall default in the
payment of the redemption price, interest will cease to accrue on the principal
amount of the Convertible Notes or portions thereof called for redemption and
for which funds have been set apart for payment. In the case of Convertible
Notes or portions thereof redeemed on a redemption date which is also a
regularly scheduled interest payment date, the interest payment due on such date
shall be paid to the person in whose name the Note is registered at the close of
business on the relevant record date.
 
     The Convertible Notes are not entitled to any sinking fund.
 
REPURCHASE AT OPTION OF HOLDERS UPON A DESIGNATED EVENT
 
     Upon the occurrence of a Designated Event, each holder of Convertible Notes
will have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or any part (equal
to $1,000 or an integral multiple thereof) of such holder's Convertible Notes
pursuant to the offer described below (the "Designated Event Offer") at an offer
price in cash equal to 101% of the aggregate principal amount thereof plus
accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the date of purchase (the "Designated
Event Payment"). Within 20 days following any Designated Event, the Company will
mail a notice to each holder describing the transaction or transactions that
constitute the
 
                                       80
<PAGE>   81
 
Designated Event and offering to repurchase Convertible Notes pursuant to the
procedures required by the Indenture and described in such notice.
 
     The Company will comply with the requirements of Rule 14e-1 under the
Exchange Act and any other securities laws and regulations thereunder to the
extent such laws and regulations are applicable in connection with the
repurchase of the Convertible Notes as a result of a Designated Event. Rule
13e-4 under the Exchange Act requires, among other things, the dissemination of
certain information to security holders in the event of an issuer tender offer
and may apply in the event that the repurchase option becomes available to
holders of the Convertible Notes. The Company will comply with this rule to the
extent applicable at that time.
 
     On the date specified for termination of the Designated Event Offer, the
Company will, to the extent lawful, (1) accept for payment all Convertible Notes
or portions thereof properly tendered pursuant to the Designated Event Offer,
(2) deposit with the paying agent an amount equal to the Designated Event
Payment in respect of all Convertible Notes or portions thereof so tendered and
(3) deliver or cause to be delivered to the Trustee the Convertible Notes so
accepted together with an Officers' Certificate stating the aggregate principal
amount of Convertible Notes or portions thereof being purchased by the Company.
On the date specified for payment of the Designated Event Payment (the
"Designated Event Payment Date"), the paying agent will promptly mail to each
holder of Convertible Notes so accepted the Designated Event Payment for such
Convertible Notes, and the Trustee will promptly authenticate and mail (or cause
to be transferred by book entry) to each holder a new Convertible Note equal in
principal amount to any unpurchased portion of the Convertible Notes
surrendered, if any; provided that each such new Convertible Note will be in a
principal amount of $1,000 or an integral multiple thereof.
 
     The foregoing provisions would not necessarily afford holders of the
Convertible Notes protection in the event of highly leveraged or other
transactions involving the Company that may adversely affect holders.
 
     The right to require the Company to repurchase Convertible Notes as a
result of a Designated Event could have the effect of delaying, deferring or
preventing a Change of Control or other attempts to acquire control of the
Company unless arrangements have been made to enable the Company to repurchase
all the Convertible Notes at the Designated Event Payment Date. Consequently,
this right may render more difficult or discourage a merger, consolidation or
tender offer (even if such transaction is supported by the Company's Board of
Directors or is favorable to the stockholders), the assumption of control by a
holder of a large block of the Company's shares and the removal of incumbent
management.
 
     Except as described above with respect to a Designated Event, the Indenture
does not contain provisions that permit the holders of the Convertible Notes to
require that the Company repurchase or redeem the Convertible Notes in the event
of a takeover, recapitalization or similar restructuring. Subject to the
limitation on mergers and consolidations described below, the Company, its
management or its Subsidiaries could in the future enter into certain
transactions, including refinancings, certain recapitalizations, acquisitions,
the sale of all or substantially all of its assets, the liquidation of the
Company or similar transactions, that would not constitute a Designated Event
under the Indenture, but that would increase the amount of Senior Debt (or any
other indebtedness) outstanding at such time or substantially reduce or
eliminate the Company's assets.
 
     The terms of the Company's existing or future credit or other agreements
relating to indebtedness (including Senior Debt) may prohibit the Company from
purchasing any Convertible Notes and may also provide that a Designated Event,
as well as certain other change-of-control events with respect to the Company,
would constitute an event of default thereunder. In the event a Designated Event
occurs at a time when the Company is prohibited from purchasing Convertible
Notes, the Company could seek the consent of its then-existing lenders to the
purchase of Convertible Notes or could attempt to refinance the borrowings that
contain such prohibition. If the Company does not obtain such a consent or repay
such borrowings, the Company would remain prohibited from purchasing Convertible
Notes. In such case, the Company's failure to purchase tendered Convertible
Notes would constitute an Event of Default under the Indenture, which may, in
turn, constitute a further default under the terms of other indebtedness that
the Company has entered into or may enter into from time to time. In such
circumstances, the subordination provisions in the Indenture would likely
restrict payments to the holders of Convertible Notes.
                                       81
<PAGE>   82
 
     A "Designated Event" will be deemed to have occurred upon a Change of
Control or a Termination of Trading.
 
     A "Change of Control" will be deemed to have occurred when: (i) any person
has become an Acquiring Person, (ii) the Company consolidates with or merges
into any other corporation, or conveys, transfers, or leases all or
substantially all of its assets to any person, or any other corporation merges
into the Company, and, in the case of any such transaction, the outstanding
Common Stock of the Company is changed or exchanged as a result, unless the
stockholders of the Company immediately before such transaction own, directly or
indirectly immediately following such transaction, at least a majority of the
combined voting power of the outstanding voting securities of the corporation
resulting from such transaction in substantially the same proportion as their
ownership of the Voting Stock immediately before such transaction, or (iii) any
time the Continuing Directors do not constitute a majority of the Board of
Directors of the Company (or, if applicable, a successor corporation to the
Company); provided that a Change of Control shall not be deemed to have occurred
if either (x) the last sale price of the Common Stock for any five trading days
during the ten trading days immediately preceding the Change of Control is at
least equal to 105% of the Conversion Price in effect on the date of such Change
of Control or (y) at least 90% of the consideration (excluding cash payments for
fractional shares) in the transaction or transactions constituting the Change of
Control consists of shares of common stock that are, or upon issuance will be,
traded on a United States national securities exchange or approved for trading
on an established automated over-the-counter trading market in the United
States.
 
     The definition of Change of Control includes a phrase relating to the
lease, transfer or conveyance of "all or substantially all" of the assets of the
Company. Although there is a developing body of case law interpreting the phrase
"substantially all," there is no precise established definition of the phrase
under applicable law. Accordingly, the ability of a holder of Convertible Notes
to require the Company to repurchase such Convertible Notes as a result of a
lease, transfer or conveyance of less than all of the assets of the Company to
another person or group may be uncertain.
 
     "Continuing Directors" means, as of any date of determination, any member
of the Board of Directors of the Company who (i) was a member of such Board of
Directors on the date of the Indenture or (ii) was nominated for election or
elected to such Board of Directors with the approval of a majority of the
Continuing Directors who were members of such Board at the time of such
nomination or election.
 
     A "Termination of Trading" will be deemed to have occurred if the Common
Stock (or other common stock into which the Convertible Notes are then
convertible) is neither listed for trading on a United States national
securities exchange nor approved for trading on an established automated
over-the-counter trading market in the United States.
 
MERGER AND CONSOLIDATION
 
     The Indenture will provide that the Company may not, in a single
transaction or a series of related transactions, consolidate or merge with or
into (whether or not the Company is the surviving corporation), or sell, assign,
transfer, lease, convey or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of its
properties or assets in one or more related transactions to, another
corporation, person or entity as an entirety or substantially as an entirety
unless either (a)(i) the Company shall be the surviving or continuing
corporation or (ii) the entity or person formed by or surviving any such
consolidation or merger (if other than the Company) or the entity or person
which acquires by sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other
disposition the properties and assets of the Company substantially as an
entirety (x) is a corporation organized and validly existing under the laws of
the United States, any State thereof or the District of Columbia and (y) assumes
the due and punctual payment of the principal of, and premium, if any, and
interest on all the Convertible Notes and the performance of every covenant of
the Company under the Convertible Notes and the Indenture pursuant to a
supplemental indenture in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee; (b)
immediately after such transaction no Default or Event of Default exists; and
(c) the Company or such person shall have delivered to the Trustee an officers'
certificate and an opinion of counsel, each stating that such transaction and
the supplemental indenture comply with the Indenture and that all conditions
precedent in the Indenture relating to such transaction have been satisfied.
 
                                       82
<PAGE>   83
 
     For purposes of the foregoing, the transfer (by lease, assignment, sale or
otherwise, in a single transaction or series of transactions) of all or
substantially all of the properties or assets of one or more Subsidiaries of the
Company, the capital stock of which constitutes all or substantially all of the
properties and assets of the Company, shall be deemed to be the transfer of all
or substantially all of the properties and assets of the Company.
 
     Upon any such consolidation, merger, sale, assignment, conveyance, lease,
transfer or other disposition in accordance with the foregoing, the successor
person formed by such consolidation or into which the Company is merged or to
which such sale, assignment, conveyance, lease, transfer or other disposition is
made will succeed to, and be substituted for, and may exercise every right and
power of, the Company under the Indenture with the same effect as if such
successor had been named as the Company therein, and thereafter (except in the
case of a sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition)
the predecessor corporation will be relieved of all further obligations and
covenants under the Indenture and the Convertible Notes.
 
EVENTS OF DEFAULT AND REMEDIES
 
     An Event of Default is defined in the Indenture as being (i) default in
payment of the principal of, or premium, if any, on the Convertible Notes,
whether or not such payment is prohibited by the subordination provisions of the
Indenture; (ii) default for 30 days in payment of any installment of interest on
the Convertible Notes, whether or not such payment is prohibited by the
subordination provisions of the Indenture; (iii) default by the Company for 60
days after notice in the observance or performance of any other covenants in the
Indenture; (iv) default in the payment of the Designated Event Payment in
respect of the Convertible Notes on the date therefor, whether or not such
payment is prohibited by the subordination provisions of the Indenture; (v)
failure to provide timely notice of a Designated Event; (vi) failure of the
Company or any Material Subsidiary to make any payment at maturity, including
any applicable grace period, in respect of indebtedness for borrowed money of,
or guaranteed or assumed by, the Company or any Material Subsidiary, which
payment is in an amount in excess of $20,000,000, and continuance of such
failure for 30 days after notice; (vii) default by the Company or any Material
Subsidiary with respect to any such indebtedness, which default results in the
acceleration of any such indebtedness of an amount in excess of $20,000,000
without such indebtedness having been paid or discharged or such acceleration
having been cured, waived, rescinded or annulled for 30 days after notice; or
(viii) certain events involving bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of the
Company or any Material Subsidiary.
 
     If an Event of Default (other than an Event of Default specified in clause
(viii) above with respect to the Company) occurs and is continuing, then and in
every such case the Trustee, by written notice to the Company, or the holders of
not less than 25% in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding
Convertible Notes, by written notice to the Company and the Trustee, may declare
the unpaid principal of, premium, if any, and accrued and unpaid interest on all
the Convertible Notes then outstanding to be due and payable. Upon such
declaration, such principal amount, premium, if any, and accrued and unpaid
interest will become immediately due and payable, notwithstanding anything
contained in the Indenture or the Convertible Notes to the contrary, but subject
to the provisions limiting payment described in "-- Subordination." If any Event
of Default specified in clause (viii) above occurs with respect to the Company,
all unpaid principal of, and premium, if any, and accrued and unpaid interest on
the Convertible Notes then outstanding will automatically become due and
payable, subject to the provisions described in "-- Subordination," without any
declaration or other act on the part of the Trustee or any holder of Convertible
Notes.
 
     Holders of the Convertible Notes may not enforce the Indenture or the
Convertible Notes except as provided in the Indenture. Subject to the provisions
of the Indenture relating to the duties of the Trustee, the Trustee is under no
obligation to exercise any of its rights or powers under the Indenture at the
request, order or direction of any of the holders, unless such holders have
offered to the Trustee a security or an indemnity satisfactory to it against any
cost, expense or liability. Subject to all provisions of the Indenture and
applicable law, the holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the
then outstanding Convertible Notes have the right to direct the time, method and
place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or
exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee. If a Default or Event of
Default occurs and
                                       83
<PAGE>   84
 
is continuing and is known to the Trustee, the Indenture requires the Trustee to
mail a notice of Default or Event of Default to each holder within 60 days of
the occurrence of such Default or Event of Default, provided, however, that the
Trustee may withhold from the holders notice of any continuing Default or Event
of Default (except a Default or Event of Default in the payment of principal of,
premium, if any or interest on the Convertible Notes) if it determines in good
faith that withholding notice is in their interest. The holders of a majority in
aggregate principal amount of the Convertible Notes then outstanding by notice
to the Trustee may rescind any acceleration of the Convertible Notes and its
consequences if all existing Events of Default (other than the nonpayment of
principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Convertible Notes that has
become due solely by virtue of such acceleration) have been cured or waived and
if the rescission would not conflict with any judgment or decree of any court of
competent jurisdiction. No such rescission shall affect any subsequent Default
or Event of Default or impair any right consequent thereto.
 
     In the case of any Event of Default occurring by reason of any willful
action (or inaction) taken (or not taken) by or on behalf of the Company with
the intention of avoiding payment of the premium that the Company would have had
to pay if the Company then had elected to redeem the Convertible Notes pursuant
to the optional redemption provisions of the Indenture, an equivalent premium
shall also become and be immediately due and payable to the extent permitted by
law upon the acceleration of the Convertible Notes. If an Event of Default
occurs prior to any date on which the Company is prohibited from redeeming the
Convertible Notes by reason of any willful action (or inaction) taken (or not
taken) by or on behalf of the Company with the intention of avoiding the
prohibition on redemption of the Convertible Notes prior to such date, then the
premium specified in the Indenture shall also become immediately due and payable
to the extent permitted by law upon the acceleration of the Convertible Notes.
 
     The holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Convertible
Notes then outstanding may, on behalf of the holders of all the Convertible
Notes, waive any past Default or Event of Default under the Indenture and its
consequences, except Default in the payment of principal of, premium, if any, or
interest on the Convertible Notes (other than the non-payment of principal of,
premium, if any, and interest on the Convertible Notes that has become due
solely by virtue of an acceleration that has been duly rescinded as provided
above) or in respect of a covenant or provision of the Indenture that cannot be
modified or amended without the consent of all holders of Convertible Notes.
 
     The Company is required to deliver to the Trustee annually a statement
regarding compliance with the Indenture and the Company is required, upon
becoming aware of any Default or Event of Default, to deliver to the Trustee a
statement specifying such Default or Event of Default.
 
BOOK-ENTRY; DELIVERY AND FORM
 
     The Convertible Notes will be issued in the form of one or more global
notes (the "Global Note") deposited with, or on behalf of, DTC and registered in
the name of Cede & Co. as DTC's nominees, or will remain in the custody of the
Trustee pursuant to a FAST Balance Certificate Agreement between DTC and the
Trustee. Owners of beneficial interests in the Convertible Notes represented by
the Global Note will hold such interests pursuant to the procedures and
practices of DTC and must exercise any rights in respect of their interests
(including any right to convert or require repurchase of their interests) in
accordance with those procedures and practices. Such beneficial owners will not
be holders for purposes of the Indenture, and will not be entitled to any rights
under the Global Note or the Indenture, with respect to the Global Note, and the
Company and the Trustee, and any of their respective agents, may treat DTC as
the sole holder and owner of the Global Note for all purposes under the
Indenture.
 
     DTC has advised the Company as follows: DTC is a limited purpose trust
company organized under the New York Banking Law, a "banking organization"
within the meaning of the New York Banking Law, a member of the Federal Reserve
System, a "clearing corporation" within the meaning of the New York Uniform
Commercial Code, and a "clearing agency" registered pursuant to the provisions
of Section 17A of the Exchange Act. DTC holds securities for its participants
and facilitates the clearance and settlement of securities transactions, such as
transfers and pledges, in deposited securities through electronic computerized
book-entry changes in participants' accounts, thereby eliminating the need for
physical movement of securities
 
                                       84
<PAGE>   85
 
certificates. Direct participants include securities brokers and dealers, banks,
trust companies, clearing corporations, and certain other organizations. DTC is
owned by a number of its direct participants and by the New York Stock Exchange,
Inc., the American Stock Exchange, Inc. and the National Association of
Securities Dealers, Inc. Access to the DTC system is also available to others
such as securities brokers and dealers, banks and trust companies that clear
through or maintain a custodial relationship with a direct participant, either
directly or indirectly. The rules applicable to DTC and its participants are on
file with the Commission.
 
     Unless and until they are exchanged in whole or in part for certificated
Convertible Notes in definitive form as set forth below, the Global Note may not
be transferred except as a whole by DTC to a nominee of DTC, or by a nominee of
DTC to DTC or another nominee of DTC.
 
     The Convertible Notes represented by the Global Note will not be
exchangeable for certificated Convertible Notes, provided that if DTC is at any
time unwilling, unable or ineligible to continue as depositary and a successor
depositary is not appointed by the Company within 90 days, the Company will
issue individual Convertible Notes in definitive form in exchange for the Global
Note. In addition, the Company may at any time in its sole discretion determine
not to have a Global Note, and, in such event, will issue individual Convertible
Notes in definitive form in exchange for the Global Note previously representing
all such Convertible Notes. In either instance, an owner of a beneficial
interest in a Global Note will be entitled to physical delivery of Convertible
Notes in definitive form equal in principal amount to such beneficial interest
and to have such Convertible Notes registered in its name. Individual
Convertible Notes so issued in definitive form will be issued in denominations
of $1,000 and any larger amount that is an integral multiple of $1,000 and will
be issued in registered form only, without coupons.
 
     The laws of some states require that certain persons take physical delivery
in definite form of securities that they own and that security interests in
negotiable instruments can only be perfected by delivery of certificates
representing the instruments. Consequently, the ability to transfer Convertible
Notes evidenced by the Global Note will be limited to such extent.
 
     Payments of principal of and interest on the Convertible Notes will be made
by the Company through the Trustee to DTC or its nominee, as the case may be, as
the registered owner of the Global Note. Neither the Company nor the Trustee
will have any responsibility or liability for any aspect of the records relating
to or payments made on account of beneficial ownership interests of the Global
Note or for maintaining, supervising or reviewing any records relating to such
beneficial ownership interests. The Company expects that DTC, upon receipt of
any payment of principal or interest in respect of the Global Note, will credit
the accounts of the related participants with payment in amounts proportionate
to their respective holdings in principal amount of beneficial interest in the
Global Note as shown on the records of DTC. The Company also expects that
payments by participants to owners of beneficial interests in the Global Note
will be covered by standing customer instructions and customary practices, as is
now the case with securities held for the accounts of customers in bearer form
or registered in "street name," and will be the responsibility of such
participants.
 
     So long as the Convertible Notes are represented by a Global Note, DTC or
its nominee will be the only entity that can exercise a right to repayment
pursuant to the holder's option to elect repayment of its Convertible Notes or
the right of conversion of the Convertible Notes. Notice by participants or by
owners of beneficial interests in a Global Note held through such participants
of the exercise of the option to elect repayment, or the right of conversion, of
beneficial interests in Convertible Notes represented by the Global Note must be
transmitted to DTC in accordance with its procedures on a form required by DTC
and provided to participants. In order to ensure that DTC's nominee will timely
exercise a right to repayment, or the right of conversion, with respect to a
particular Convertible Note, the beneficial owner of such Convertible Notes must
instruct the broker or other participant through which it holds an interest in
such Convertible Notes to notify DTC of its desire to exercise a right to
repayment, or the right of conversion. Different firms have different cut-off
times for accepting instructions from their customers and, accordingly, each
beneficial owner should consult the broker or other participant through which it
holds an interest in a Convertible Note in order to ascertain the cut-off time
by which such an instruction must be given in order for timely notice to be
delivered to DTC. The Company will not be liable for any delay in delivery of
such notice to DTC.
 
                                       85
<PAGE>   86
 
     The information in this section concerning DTC and DTC's book-entry system
has been obtained from sources that the Company believes to be reliable. The
Company will have no responsibility for the performance by DTC or its
participants of their respective obligations as described hereunder or under the
rules and procedures governing their respective operations.
 
     Neither the Company nor the Trustee shall be liable for any delay by DTC or
any participant or indirect participant in DTC in identifying the beneficial
owners of the Convertible Notes, and the Company and the Trustee may
conclusively rely on, and shall be protected in relying on, instructions from
DTC for all purposes (including with respect to the registration and delivery,
and the respective principal amounts, of the Convertible Notes to be issued).
 
AMENDMENT, SUPPLEMENT AND WAIVER
 
     Except as provided in the next two succeeding paragraphs, the Indenture or
the Convertible Notes may be amended or supplemented with the consent of the
holders of at least a majority in principal amount of the Convertible Notes then
outstanding (including consents obtained in connection with a tender offer or
exchange offer for Convertible Notes), and any existing default or compliance
with any provision of the Indenture or the Convertible Notes may be waived with
the consent of the holders of a majority in principal amount of the then
outstanding Convertible Notes (including consents obtained in connection with a
tender offer or exchange offer for Convertible Notes).
 
     Without the consent of each holder affected, an amendment or waiver may not
(with respect to any Convertible Notes held by a non-consenting holder): (a)
reduce the principal amount of Convertible Notes whose holders must consent to
an amendment, supplement or waiver, (b) reduce the principal of or change the
fixed maturity of any Convertible Note or, other than as set forth in the next
paragraph, alter the provisions with respect to the redemption of the
Convertible Notes, (c) reduce the rate of or change the time for payment of
interest on any Convertible Notes, (d) waive a Default or Event of Default in
the payment of principal of or premium, if any, or interest on the Convertible
Notes (except a rescission of acceleration of the Convertible Notes by the
holders of at least a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Convertible
Notes and a waiver of the payment default that resulted from such acceleration),
(e) make any Convertible Note payable in money other than that stated in the
Indenture and the Convertible Notes, (f) make any change in the provisions of
the Indenture relating to waivers of past Defaults or the rights of holders of
Convertible Notes to receive payments of principal of, premium, if any, or
interest on the Convertible Notes, (g) waive a redemption payment with respect
to any Convertible Note, (h) except as permitted by the Indenture, increase the
Conversion Price or, other than as set forth in the next paragraph, modify the
provisions of the Indenture relating to conversion of the Convertible Notes in a
manner adverse to the holders thereof or (i) make any change to the abilities of
holders of Convertible Notes to enforce their rights under the Indenture or the
provisions of clause (a) through (i) hereof. In addition, any amendment to the
provisions of Article 11 of the Indenture (which relate to subordination) will
require the consent of the holders of at least 75% in aggregate principal amount
of the Convertible Notes then outstanding if such amendment would adversely
affect the rights of holders of Convertible Notes.
 
     Notwithstanding the foregoing, without the consent of any holder of
Convertible Notes, the Company and the Trustee may amend or supplement the
Indenture or the Convertible Notes to (a) cure any ambiguity, defect or
inconsistency or make any other changes in the provisions of the Indenture which
the Company and the Trustee may deem necessary or desirable, provided such
amendment does not materially and adversely affect the Convertible Notes, (b)
provide for uncertificated Convertible Notes in addition to or in place of
certificated Convertible Notes, (c) provide for the assumption of the Company's
obligations to holders of Convertible Notes in the circumstances required under
the Indenture as described under "-- Merger and Consolidation," (d) provide for
conversion rights of holders of Convertible Notes in certain events such as a
consolidation, merger or sale of all or substantially all of the assets of the
Company, (e) reduce the Conversion Price, (f) make any change that would provide
any additional rights or benefits to the holders of Convertible Notes or that
does not adversely affect the legal rights under the Indenture of any such
holder, or (g) comply with requirements of the Commission in order to effect or
maintain the qualification of the Indenture under the TIA.
                                       86
<PAGE>   87
 
SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE
 
     The Company may discharge its obligations under the Indenture while
Convertible Notes remain outstanding if (i) all outstanding Convertible Notes
will become due and payable at their scheduled maturity within one year or (ii)
all outstanding Convertible Notes are scheduled for redemption within one year,
and, in either case, the Company has (a) deposited with the Trustee an amount
sufficient to pay and discharge all outstanding Convertible Notes on the date of
their scheduled maturity or the scheduled date of redemption and (b) paid all
other sums then payable by the Company under the Indenture.
 
GOVERNING LAW
 
     The Indenture will provide that the Convertible Notes will be governed by,
and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of New York without
giving effect to applicable principles of conflicts of law.
 
TRANSFER AND EXCHANGE
 
     A holder may transfer or exchange Convertible Notes in accordance with the
Indenture. The Registrar and the Trustee may require a holder, among other
things, to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents and the
Company may require a holder to pay any taxes and fees required by law or
permitted by the Indenture. The Company is not required to transfer or exchange
any Convertible Note selected for redemption or repurchase. Also, the Company is
not required to transfer or exchange any Convertible Note for a period of 15
days before a selection of Convertible Notes to be redeemed.
 
     The registered holder of a Convertible Note will be treated as the owner of
it for all purposes.
 
THE TRUSTEE
 
     The Indenture will provide that, except during the continuance of an Event
of Default, the Trustee will perform only such duties as are specifically set
forth in the Indenture. In case an Event of Default shall occur (and shall not
be cured) and holders of the Convertible Notes have notified the Trustee, the
Trustee will be required to exercise its powers with the degree of care and
skill of a prudent person in the conduct of such person's own affairs. Subject
to such provisions, the Trustee is under no obligation to exercise any of its
rights or powers under the Indenture at the request of any of the holders of
Convertible Notes, unless they shall have offered to the Trustee security and
indemnity satisfactory to it.
 
     The Indenture and the TIA will contain certain limitations on the rights of
the Trustee, should it become a creditor of the Company, to obtain payment of
claims in certain cases or to realize on certain property received in respect of
any such claim as security or otherwise. Subject to the TIA, the Trustee will be
permitted to engage in other transactions, provided, however, that if it
acquires any conflicting interest (as described in the TIA), it must eliminate
such conflict or resign.
 
CERTAIN DEFINITIONS
 
     "Acquiring Person" means any person (as defined in Section 13(d)(3) of the
Exchange Act) who or which, together with all affiliates and associates (each as
defined in Rule 12b-2 under the Exchange Act), becomes the beneficial owner (as
defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act and as further defined
below) of shares of Common Stock or other voting securities of the Company
having more than 50% of the total voting power of the Voting Stock of the
Company; provided, however, that an Acquiring Person shall not include (i) the
Company, (ii) any Subsidiary of the Company, (iii) any Permitted Holder, (iv) an
underwriter engaged in a firm commitment underwriting in connection with a
public offering of the Voting Stock of the Company or (v) any current or future
employee or director benefit plan of the Company or any Subsidiary of the
Company or any entity holding Common Stock of the Company for or pursuant to the
terms of any such plan. For purposes hereof, a person shall not be deemed to be
the beneficial owner of (A) any securities tendered pursuant to a tender or
exchange offer made by or on behalf of such person or any of such person's
affiliates until such tendered securities are accepted for purchase or exchange
thereunder, or (B) any securities if such beneficial ownership (1) arises solely
as a result of a revocable proxy delivered in response to a proxy or consent
solicitation made pursuant to the applicable rules and regulations under the
Exchange Act, and (2) is not also then reportable on Schedule 13D (or any
successor schedule) under the Exchange Act.
 
                                       87
<PAGE>   88
 
     "Capital Stock" of any person means any and all shares, interests, rights
to purchase, warrants, options, participations or other equivalents of or
interests in (however designated) equity of such person, but excluding any debt
securities convertible into such equity.
 
     "Default" means any event that is, or after notice or passage of time or
both would be, an Event of Default.
 
     "Designated Senior Debt" means any particular Senior Debt if the instrument
creating or evidencing the same or the assumption or guarantee thereof (or
related agreements or documents to which the Company is a party) expressly
provides that such Indebtedness shall be "Designated Senior Debt" for purposes
of the Indenture (provided that such instrument, agreement or other document may
place limitations and conditions on the right of such Senior Debt to exercise
the rights of Designated Senior Debt).
 
     "Event of Default" has the meaning set forth under "-- Events of Default
and Remedies" herein.
 
     "GAAP" means generally accepted accounting principles set forth in the
opinions and pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board of the American
Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements and pronouncements of
the Financial Accounting Standards Board or in such other statements by such
other entity as may be approved by a significant segment of the accounting
profession of the United States, which are in effect from time to time.
 
     "Indebtedness" means, with respect to any person, all obligations, whether
or not contingent, of such person (i) (a) for borrowed money (including, but not
limited to, any indebtedness secured by a security interest, mortgage or other
lien on the assets of the Company that is (1) given to secure all or part of the
purchase price of property subject thereto, whether given to the vendor of such
property or to another, or (2) existing on property at the time of acquisition
thereof), (b) evidenced by a note, debenture, bond or other written instrument,
(c) under a lease required to be capitalized on the balance sheet of the lessee
under GAAP or under any lease or related document (including a purchase
agreement) that provides that the Company is contractually obligated to purchase
or cause a third party to purchase and thereby guarantee a minimum residual
value of the lease property to the lessor and the obligations of the Company
under such lease or related document to purchase or to cause a third party to
purchase such leased property, (d) in respect of letters of credit, bank
guarantees or bankers' acceptances (including reimbursement obligations with
respect to any of the foregoing), (e) with respect to Indebtedness secured by a
mortgage, pledge, lien, encumbrance, charge or adverse claim affecting title or
resulting in an encumbrance to which the property or assets of such person are
subject, whether or not the obligation secured thereby shall have been assumed
by or shall otherwise be such person's legal liability, (f) in respect of the
balance of deferred and unpaid purchase price of any property or assets, (g)
under interest rate or currency swap agreements, cap, floor and collar
agreements, spot and forward contracts and similar agreements and arrangements;
(ii) with respect to any obligation of others of the type described in the
preceding clause (i) or under clause (iii) below assumed by or guaranteed in any
manner by such person or in effect guaranteed by such person through an
agreement to purchase (including, without limitation, "take or pay" and similar
arrangements), contingent or otherwise (and the obligations of such person under
any such assumptions, guarantees or other such arrangements); and (iii) any and
all deferrals, renewals, extensions, refinancings and refundings of, or
amendments, modifications or supplements to, any of the foregoing.
 
     "Issue Date" means the date on which the Convertible Notes are first issued
and authenticated under the Indenture.
 
     "Material Subsidiary" means any Subsidiary of the Company which at the date
of determination is a "significant subsidiary" as defined in Rule 1-02(w) of
Regulation S-X under the Securities Act and the Exchange Act.
 
     "Maturity Date" means May 1, 2003.
 
     "Obligations" means any principal, interest, penalties, fees,
indemnifications, reimbursements, damages and other liabilities payable under
the documentation governing any Indebtedness.
 
     "Permitted Holders" means James Kim and his estates, spouses, ancestors and
lineal descendants (and spouses thereof), the legal representatives of any of
the foregoing, and the trustee of any bona fide trust of which one or more of
the foregoing are the sole beneficiaries or the grantors, or any person of which
any of the
 
                                       88
<PAGE>   89
 
foregoing, individually or collectively, beneficially own (as defined in Rules
13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act) voting securities representing at least
a majority of the total voting power of all classes of Capital Stock of such
person (exclusive of any matters as to which class voting rights exist).
 
     "Person" means any individual, corporation, partnership, joint venture,
trust, estate, unincorporated organization, limited liability company or
government or any agency or political subdivision thereof.
 
     "Senior Debt" means the principal of, premium, if any, and interest on,
rent under, and any other amounts payable on or in or in respect of any
Indebtedness of the Company (including, without limitation, any Obligations in
respect of such Indebtedness and, in the case of Designated Senior Debt, any
interest accruing after the filing of a petition by or against the Company under
any bankruptcy law, whether or not allowed as a claim after such filing in any
proceeding under such bankruptcy law), whether outstanding on the date of the
Indenture or thereafter created, incurred, assumed, guaranteed or in effect
guaranteed by the Company (including all deferrals, renewals, extensions or
refundings of, or amendments, modifications or supplements to the foregoing);
provided, however, that Senior Debt does not include (v) Indebtedness evidenced
by the Convertible Notes, (w) any liability for federal, state, local or other
taxes owed or owing by the Company, (x) Indebtedness of the Company to any
Subsidiary of the Company except to the extent such Indebtedness is of a type
described in clause (ii) of the definition of Indebtedness, (y) trade payables
of the Company for goods, services or materials purchased in the ordinary course
of business (other than, to the extent they may otherwise constitute such trade
payables, any obligations of the type described in clause (ii) of the definition
of Indebtedness), and (z) any particular Indebtedness in which the instrument
creating or evidencing the same expressly provides that such Indebtedness shall
not be senior in right of payment to, or is pari passu with, or is subordinated
or junior to, the Convertible Notes.
 
     "Subsidiary" means, with respect to any person, (i) any corporation,
association or other business entity of which more than 50% of the total voting
power of shares of capital stock entitled (without regard to the occurrence of
any contingency) to vote in the election of directors, managers or trustees
thereof is at the time owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by such
person or one or more of the other Subsidiaries of that person (or a combination
thereof) and (ii) any partnership (a) the sole general partner or the managing
general partner of which is such person or a Subsidiary of such person or (b)
the only general partners of which are such person or of one or more
Subsidiaries of such person (or any combination thereof).
 
     "Voting Stock" of a corporation means all classes of Capital Stock of such
corporation then outstanding and normally entitled to vote in the election of
directors.
 
                                       89
<PAGE>   90
 
                        SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
 
     Prior to the Offerings, there has been no market for the Common Stock and
there is no assurance that a significant public market for the Common Stock will
develop or be sustained after the Offerings. Sales of substantial amounts of
Common Stock in the public market could adversely affect the market price of the
Common Stock and could impair the Company's future ability to raise capital
through the sale of its equity securities.
 
     Upon the closing of the Offerings, the Company will have outstanding
112,610,000 shares of Common Stock. In addition to the 35,000,000 shares of
Common Stock offered hereby (40,250,000 if the Underwriters' over-allotment
options are exercised in full), upon the closing of the Offerings, there will be
approximately 13,333,333 shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion of the
Convertible Notes, all of which will be freely tradeable. In addition, in
connection with market-making activities in the Convertible Notes, Smith Barney
Inc. may from time to time until the maturity date or redemption date of the
Convertible Notes borrow, return and reborrow up to 7,000,000 shares of Common
Stock from Mr. and Mrs. Kim pursuant to a securities loan agreement (the
"Securities Loan Agreement"), which shares may from time to time be sold in the
market in connection with such market-making activities pursuant to a Form S-1
registration statement (No. 333-49645) (the "Securities Loan Registration
Statement") filed by the Company under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended
(the "Securities Act"). At the end of such period, the shares of Common Stock
borrowed and returned to Mr. and Mrs. Kim (the "Control Shares") may be resold
from time to time by Mr. and Mrs. Kim subject to certain volume, manner of sale
and other restrictions described below under Rule 144 under the Securities Act.
Excluding all such freely tradeable shares and Control Shares, approximately
70,610,000 additional shares of Common Stock will be outstanding upon the
closing of the Offerings (excluding 3,145,900 shares issuable upon the exercise
of outstanding options), all of which are "restricted" shares (the "Restricted
Shares") under the Securities Act. Such Restricted Shares may be sold only if
registered under the Securities Act or sold in accordance with an available
exemption from such registration.
 
     Under Rule 144, a person (or persons whose shares are aggregated in
accordance with the Rule) who has beneficially owned his or her Restricted
Shares for at least one year, including persons who are affiliates of the
Company, will be entitled to sell, within any three month period a number of
Restricted Shares that does not exceed the greater of (i) one percent of the
then outstanding number of shares of Common Stock (1,126,100 shares of Common
Stock immediately after the consummation of the Offerings) or (ii) the average
weekly trading volume of the shares of Common Stock during the four calendar
weeks preceding each such sale. In addition, sales under Rule 144 are also
subject to certain manner of sale provisions and notice requirements and to the
availability of current public information about the Company. After Restricted
Shares are held for two years, a person who is not an affiliate of the Company
is entitled to sell such shares under Rule 144 without regard to such volume
limitations, or manner of sale, notice or public information requirements under
Rule 144. Sales of Restricted Shares by affiliates will continue to be subject
to such volume limitations, and manner of sale, notice and public information
requirements.
 
     The Company has agreed with the Underwriters not to offer, pledge, sell,
contract to sell, or otherwise dispose of (or enter into any transaction which
is designed to, or could be expected to, result in the disposition (whether by
actual disposition or effective economic disposition due to cash settlement or
otherwise) by the Company or any affiliate of the Company or any person in
privity with the Company or any affiliate of the Company), directly or
indirectly, or announce the offering of, any other shares of Common Stock or any
securities or options convertible into, or exchangeable or exercisable for,
shares of Common Stock (other than the Convertible Notes) for a period of 180
days following the date hereof without the prior written consent of Smith Barney
Inc., subject to certain limited exceptions. In addition, each of the Company's
officers, directors and stockholders has agreed with the Underwriters not to
offer, sell, contract to sell, pledge or otherwise dispose of, or file a
registration statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission in respect
of, or establish or increase a put equivalent position or liquidate or decrease
a call equivalent position within the meaning of Section 16 of the Exchange Act
with respect to, any shares of Common Stock or any securities convertible into
or exercisable or exchangeable for shares of Common Stock, or publicly announce
an intention to effect any such transaction, for a period of 180 days after the
date hereof other than pursuant to
                                       90
<PAGE>   91
 
the Securities Loan Agreement or with the prior written consent of Smith Barney
Inc., subject to certain limited exceptions. See "Underwriting."
 
     Beginning April 29, 1999, approximately 70,610,000 Restricted Shares
subject to the lock-up agreements will become eligible for sale in the public
market pursuant to Rule 144.
 
     The Company plans to grant options to purchase 3,145,900 shares of Common
Stock immediately prior to the Offerings under the 1998 Stock Plan, 1998 Stock
Option Plan for French Employees and 1998 Director Option Plan. See
"Management -- Stock Plans." The Company intends to file, within 30 days after
the date of this Prospectus, a Form S-8 registration statement under the
Securities Act to register shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance under
the 1998 Stock Plan, 1998 Director Option Plan and 1998 Employee Stock Purchase
Plan, and shares of Common Stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding options.
Shares of Common Stock issued upon exercise of options after the effective date
of the Form S-8 will be available for sale in the public market, subject to Rule
144 volume limitations applicable to affiliates and to lock-up agreements.
 
                                       91
<PAGE>   92
 
                 CERTAIN UNITED STATES FEDERAL TAX CONSEQUENCES
                TO HOLDERS OF COMMON STOCK AND CONVERTIBLE NOTES
 
GENERAL
 
     The following is a general discussion of certain United States federal
income and estate tax considerations relating to the ownership and disposition
of Common Stock and Convertible Notes by a holder who acquires and owns such
Common Stock or a Convertible Note as a capital asset within the meaning of
Section 1221 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"). This
discussion does not consider specific facts and circumstances that may be
relevant to a particular holder's tax position, does not address all aspects of
United States federal income and estate taxes and does not deal with foreign,
state, and local consequences and United States federal gift taxes that may be
relevant to such holders in light of their personal circumstances. Further, it
does not discuss the rules applicable to holders subject to special tax
treatment under the federal income tax laws (including but not limited to,
banks, insurance companies, dealers in securities, holders of securities held as
part of a "straddle," "hedge," or "conversion transaction," and persons who
undertake a constructive sale of Common Stock or a Convertible Note). In
addition, this discussion is limited to original purchasers of Convertible
Notes, who acquire their Convertible Notes at their original issue price within
the meaning of Section 1273 of the Code, and Common Stock. Furthermore, this
discussion is based on current provisions of the Code, existing and proposed
regulations promulgated thereunder and administrative and judicial
interpretations thereof, all of which are subject to change, possibly on a
retroactive basis. Accordingly, each prospective purchaser of Common Stock or
Convertible Notes is advised to consult a tax advisor with respect to current
and possible future tax consequences of acquiring, holding, and disposing of
Common Stock or Convertible Notes.
 
U.S. HOLDERS
 
     The following discussion is limited to a holder of Common Stock or a
Convertible Note that for United States federal income tax purposes is (i) a
citizen or resident (within the meaning of Section 7701(b) of the Code) of the
United States, (ii) a corporation, partnership or other entity created or
organized in the United States or under the laws of the United States or of any
state, (iii) an estate whose income is includible in gross income for United
States federal income tax purposes, regardless of its source, or (iv) in
general, a trust subject to the primary supervision of a court within the United
States and the control of a United States person as described in Section
7701(a)(30) of the Code (a "U.S. Holder").
 
  Interest
 
     Stated interest on the Convertible Notes will generally be includable in a
U.S. Holder's gross income and taxable as ordinary income for U.S. federal
income tax purposes at the time it is paid or accrued in accordance with the
U.S. Holder's regular method of accounting.
 
  Conversion of Convertible Notes Into Common Stock
 
     A U.S. Holder generally will not recognize any income, gain or loss upon
conversion of a Note into Common Stock except to the extent the Common Stock is
considered attributable to accrued interest not previously included in income
(which is taxable as ordinary income) or with respect to cash received in lieu
of a fractional share of Common Stock. The adjusted basis of shares of Common
Stock received on conversion will equal the adjusted basis of the Convertible
Note converted (reduced by the portion of adjusted basis allocated to any
fractional share of Common Stock exchanged for cash), and the holding period of
the Common Stock received on conversion will generally include the period during
which the converted Convertible Notes were held. However, a U.S. Holder's tax
basis in shares of Common Stock considered attributable to accrued interest as
described above generally will equal the amount of such accrued interest
included in income, and the holding period for such shares shall begin as of the
date of conversion.
 
     The conversion price of the Convertible Notes is subject to adjustment
under certain circumstances. Section 305 of the Code and the Treasury
Regulations issued thereunder may treat the holders of the
 
                                       92
<PAGE>   93
 
Convertible Notes as having received a constructive distribution, resulting in
ordinary income (subject to a possible dividends received deduction in the case
of corporate holders) to the extent of the Company's current or accumulated
earnings and profits, if, and to the extent that, certain adjustments in the
conversion price that may occur in limited circumstances (particularly an
adjustment to reflect a taxable dividend to holders of Common Stock) increase
the proportionate interest of a holder of Convertible Notes in the fully diluted
Common Stock, whether or not such holder ever exercises its conversion
privilege. Moreover, if there is not a full adjustment to the conversion ratio
of the Convertible Notes to reflect a stock dividend or other event increasing
the proportionate interest of the holders of outstanding Common Stock in the
assets or earnings and profits of the Company, then such increase in the
proportionate interest of the holders of the Common Stock generally will be
treated as a distribution to such holders, taxable as ordinary income (subject
to a possible dividends received deduction in the case of corporate holders) to
the extent of the Company's current or accumulated earnings and profits..
 
  Sale, Exchange or Retirement of a Convertible Note
 
     Each U.S. Holder generally will recognize gain or loss upon the sale,
exchange, redemption, retirement or other disposition of a Convertible Note
measured by the difference (if any) between (i) the amount of cash and the fair
market value of any property received (except to the extent that such cash or
other property is attributable to the payment of accrued interest not previously
included in income, which amount will be taxable as ordinary income) and (ii)
such holder's adjusted tax basis in the Convertible Note. Any such gain or loss
recognized on the sale, exchange, redemption, retirement or other disposition of
a Convertible Note will be capital gain or loss. Gain on most capital assets
held or deemed held by an individual for more than 18 months is subject to a
maximum rate of tax of 20%, and gain on most capital assets held or deemed held
by an individual more than one year and up to 18 months is subject to tax at a
maximum rate of 28%. A U.S. Holder's initial basis in a Convertible Note will be
the amount paid therefor.
 
  The Common Stock
 
     In general, dividends paid from current or accumulated earnings and profits
of the Company, as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes, will be
included in a U.S. Holder's income as ordinary income (subject to a possible
dividends received deduction in the case of corporate holders) as they are paid.
Gain or loss realized on the sale or exchange of Common Stock will equal the
difference between the amount realized on such sale or exchange and the U.S.
Holder's adjusted tax basis in such Common Stock. Gain on most capital assets
held by an individual for more than 18 months is subject to tax at a maximum
rate of 20% and gain on most capital assets held by an individual for more than
one year and up to 18 months is subject to tax at a maximum rate of 28%.
 
  Information Reporting and Backup Withholding
 
     A U.S. Holder of Common Stock or a Convertible Note may be subject to
"backup withholding" at a rate of 31% with respect to certain "reportable
payments," including dividend payments, interest payments, and, under certain
circumstances, principal payments on the Convertible Notes. These backup
withholding rules apply if the holder, among other things, (i) fails to furnish
a social security number or other taxpayer identification number ("TIN")
certified under penalties of perjury within a reasonable time after the request
therefor, (ii) furnishes an incorrect TIN, (iii) fails to report properly
interest or dividends, or (iv) under certain circumstances, fails to provide a
certified statement, signed under penalties of perjury, that the TIN furnished
is the correct number and that such holder is not subject to backup withholding.
A holder who does not provide the Company with its correct TIN also may be
subject to penalties imposed by the IRS. Any amount withheld from a payment to a
U.S. Holder under the backup withholding rules is creditable against the
holder's federal income tax liability, provided that the required information is
furnished to the IRS. Backup withholding will not apply, however, with respect
to payments made to certain U.S. Holders, including corporations and tax-exempt
organizations, provided their exemptions from backup withholding are properly
established.
 
                                       93
<PAGE>   94
 
     The Company will report to the U.S. Holders of Convertible Notes and Common
Stock and to the IRS the amount of any "reportable payments" for each calendar
year and the amount of tax withheld, if any, with respect to such payments.
 
NON U.S. HOLDERS
 
     The following discussion is limited to the U.S. federal income tax
consequences relevant to a Non-U.S. Holder. As used herein, the term "Non-U.S.
Holder" means any holder other than a U.S. Holder. For purposes of withholding
tax on interest and dividends discussed below, a Non-U.S. Holder includes a non-
resident fiduciary of an estate or trust. For purposes of the following
discussion, interest, dividends and gain on the sale, exchange or other
disposition of a Convertible Note or Common Stock will generally be considered
to be "U.S. trade or business income" if such income or gain is (i) effectively
connected with the conduct of a U.S. trade or business or (ii) in the case of
most treaty residents, attributable to a permanent establishment (or, in the
case of an individual, a fixed base) in the United States.
 
  Interest
 
     Generally, any interest paid to a Non-U.S. Holder of a Convertible Note
that is not U.S. trade or business income will not be subject to U.S. tax if the
interest qualifies as "portfolio interest." Interest on the Convertible Notes
will generally qualify as portfolio interest if (i) the Non-U.S. Holder does not
actually or constructively own 10% or more of the total voting power of all
voting stock of the Company and is not a "controlled foreign corporation" with
respect to which the Company is a "related person" within the meaning of the
Code, and (ii) the beneficial owner, under penalty of perjury, certifies that
the beneficial owner is not a U.S. person and such certificate provides the
beneficial owner's name and address.
 
     The gross amount of payments of interest to a Non-U.S. Holder that do not
qualify for the portfolio interest exemption and that are not U.S. trade or
business income will be subject to withholding of U.S. federal income tax at a
30% rate, unless a U.S. income tax treaty applies to reduce or eliminate the
rate of withholding. Interest that is U.S. trade or business income will be
subject to United States federal income tax on a net income basis at applicable
graduated individual or corporate rates and would be exempt from the 30%
withholding tax described above. In the case of a Non-U.S. Holder that is a
corporation, interest that is U.S. trade or business income may, under certain
circumstances, be subject to an additional "branch profits tax" at a 30% rate or
such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty. To claim
the benefit of a tax treaty or to claim an exemption from withholding for
interest that is U.S. trade or business income, the Non-U.S. Holder must provide
a properly executed Form 1001 or Form 4224 (or such successor form as the IRS
designates), as applicable, prior to the payment of interest. Under recently
adopted Treasury Regulations that will generally be effective after December 31,
1998 (the "New Regulations"), a Non-U.S. Holder, subject to certain transition
rules, will instead be required to provide a properly executed Form W-8,
certifying to such U.S. Holder's entitlement to treaty benefits or exemption
from withholding for U.S. trade or business income. Special procedures are
provided in the New Regulations for payments through qualified intermediaries.
Other recently adopted Treasury Regulations that will be effective with respect
to payments made after December 31, 1997 (the "Treaty Regulations") provide
special rules applicable to certain entities that are treated as partnerships
for U.S. purposes but as corporations for foreign tax purposes, for purposes of
determining the applicability of a tax treaty. Prospective investors should
consult their tax advisors regarding the effect, if any, of the New Regulations
and the Treaty Regulations on an investment in a Convertible Note or Common
Stock. Prospective investors should consult their tax advisors regarding the
effect, if any, of the New Regulations and the Treaty Regulations on an
investment in the Common Stock or a Convertible Note.
 
  Conversion of Convertible Notes into Common Stock
 
     A Non-U.S. Holder generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax
on the conversion of Convertible Notes into Common Stock, except with respect to
cash (if any) received in lieu of a fractional share or interest not previously
included in income. Cash received in lieu of a fractional share may give rise to
gain that would be subject to the rules described below for the sale of
Convertible Notes. Cash or Common Stock treated as issued for accrued interest
would be treated as interest under the rules described above.
                                       94
<PAGE>   95
 
  Dividends
 
     In general, dividends paid to a Non-U.S. Holder of Common Stock will be
subject to withholding of United States federal income tax at a 30% rate or such
lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty, unless the
dividends are U.S. trade or business income. If the dividend is U.S. trade or
business income, the dividend would be subject to United States federal income
tax on a net income basis at applicable graduated individual or corporate rates
and would be exempt from the 30% withholding tax described above. Any such
dividends that are U.S. trade or business income received by a foreign
corporation may, under certain circumstances, be subject to the additional
"branch profits tax" at a 30% rate or such lower rate as may be specified by an
applicable income tax treaty. Certain certification and disclosure requirements
must be complied with in order to be exempt from withholding under the U.S.
trade or business income exemption discussed above (which requirements have been
modified by the New Regulations).
 
     Under current United States Treasury regulations, dividends paid to a
stockholder at an address in a foreign country are presumed to be paid to a
resident of such country for purposes of the withholding discussed above (unless
the payor has knowledge to the contrary), including for purposes of determining
the applicability of a tax treaty rate. Under the New Regulations, to obtain a
reduced rate of withholding under a treaty, a Non-U.S. Holder would generally be
required to provide an Internal Revenue Service Form W-8 (or suitable substitute
form) certifying such Non-U.S. Holder's entitlement to benefits under a treaty.
These certification requirements may be relaxed somewhat in the case of a
Non-U.S. Holder who holds Common Stock through an account maintained at a
non-U.S. office of a financial institution. Certain other special rules may be
applicable to a Non-U.S. Holder under the New Regulation or the Treaty
Regulations. See "-- Non-U.S. Holders -- Interest".
 
     A Non-U.S. Holder of Common Stock that is eligible for a reduced rate of
United States withholding tax pursuant to a tax treaty or whose dividends have
otherwise been subjected to withholding in an amount that exceeds such holder's
United States federal income tax liability, may obtain a refund or credit of any
excess amounts withheld by filing an appropriate claim for refund with the
United States Internal Revenue Service (the "Service").
 
  Gain on Disposition of Common Stock or a Convertible Note
 
     A Non-U.S. Holder generally will not be subject to United States federal
income tax with respect to gain realized on a sale or other disposition of
Common Stock or a Convertible Note unless (i) the gain is U.S. trade or business
income, (ii) in the case of a Non-U.S. Holder who is a nonresident alien
individual and holds Common Stock or a Convertible Note as a capital asset, such
holder is present in the United States for 183 or more days in the taxable year
of the sale or other disposition and certain other conditions are met, (iii) the
Non-U.S. Holder is subject to tax pursuant to provisions of United States tax
law that apply to certain expatriates, or (iv) under certain circumstances, in
the case of disposition of Common Stock if the Company is or has been during
certain time periods a "U.S. real property holding corporation" for United
States federal income tax purposes. The Company is not and does not anticipate
becoming a "U.S. real property holding corporation" for United States federal
income tax purposes.
 
  Federal Estate Taxes
 
     Common Stock that is owned, or treated as owned, by a non-resident alien
individual (as specifically determined under residence rules for United States
federal estate tax purposes) at the time of death or that has been the subject
of certain lifetime transfers will be included in such holder's gross estate for
United States federal estate tax purposes, unless an applicable estate tax
treaty provides otherwise. A Convertible Note that is owned, or treated as
owned, by a non-resident alien individual (as specifically determined under
residence rules for United States federal estate tax purposes) at the time of
death will not be subject to U.S. federal estate tax provided that the interest
thereon qualifies as portfolio interest and was not U.S. trade or business
income.
 
                                       95
<PAGE>   96
 
  United States Information Reporting and Backup Withholding Tax
 
     The Company must report annually to the Service and to each Non-U.S. Holder
the amount of dividends or interest paid to such holder and any tax withheld
with respect to such dividends or interest. These information reporting
requirements apply regardless of whether withholding is required. Copies of the
information returns reporting such dividends and interest and withholding with
respect thereof may also be made available under the provisions of an applicable
treaty or agreement, to the tax authorities in the country in which such
Non-U.S. Holder resides.
 
     Treasury Regulations provide that backup withholding and additional
information reporting will not apply to payments of principal on the Convertible
Notes by the Company to a Non-U.S. Holder if the holder certifies as to its
Non-U.S. status under penalties of perjury or otherwise establishes an exemption
(provided that neither the Company nor its paying agent has actual knowledge
that the holder is a U.S. person or that the conditions of any other exemption
are not, in fact, satisfied). United States backup withholding tax (which
generally is a withholding tax imposed at the rate of thirty-one percent (31%)
on certain payments to persons that fail to furnish certain information under
the United States information reporting requirements) generally will not apply
to dividends paid on Common Stock to a Non-U.S. Holder at an address outside the
United States, except that with regard to payments made after December 31, 1998,
a Non-U.S. Holder will be entitled to such an exemption only if it provides a
Form W-8 (or satisfies certain documentary evidence requirements for
establishing that it is a non-United States person) or otherwise establishes an
exemption. Except as provided below, Non-U.S. Holders will not be subject to
backup withholding with respect to the payment of proceeds from the disposition
of Common Stock or Convertible Notes effected by the foreign office of a broker;
except that if the broker is a United States person or a "U.S. related person,"
information reporting (but not backup withholding) is required with respect to
the payment, unless the broker has documentary evidence in its files that the
owner is a Non-U.S. Holder (and the broker has no actual knowledge to the
contrary) and certain other requirements are met or the holder otherwise
establishes an exemption. For this purpose, a "U.S. related person" is (i) a
"controlled foreign corporation" for United States federal income tax purposes,
(ii) a foreign person 50% or more of whose gross income from all sources for the
three-year period ending with the close of its taxable year preceding the
collection or payment of such proceeds (or for such part of the period that the
broker has been in existence) is derived from activities that are effectively
connected with the conduct of a United States trade or business, or (iii) with
respect to payments made after December 31, 1998, a foreign partnership that, at
any time during its taxable year is 50% or more (by income or capital interest)
owned by U.S. persons or is engaged in the conduct of a U.S. trade or business.
The payment of the proceeds of a sale of shares of Common Stock or of a
Convertible Note to or through a United States office of a broker is subject to
information reporting and possible backup withholding unless the owner certifies
its non-United States status under penalties of perjury or otherwise establishes
an exemption. Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld
under the backup withholding rules from a payment to a Non-U.S. Holder will be
allowed as a refund or a credit against such Non-U.S. Holder's United States
federal income tax liability, provided that the required information is
furnished to the Service.
 
     THE FOREGOING DISCUSSION IS INCLUDED FOR GENERAL INFORMATION ONLY.
ACCORDINGLY, EACH PROSPECTIVE PURCHASER IS URGED TO CONSULT WITH HIS TAX ADVISOR
WITH RESPECT TO THE UNITED STATES FEDERAL INCOME TAX AND FEDERAL ESTATE TAX
CONSEQUENCES OF THE OWNERSHIP AND DISPOSITION OF COMMON STOCK AND CONVERTIBLE
NOTES, INCLUDING THE APPLICATION AND EFFECT OF THE LAWS OF ANY STATE, LOCAL,
FOREIGN, OR OTHER TAXING JURISDICTION.
 
                                       96
<PAGE>   97
 
                                  UNDERWRITING
 
     Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in an underwriting agreement
(the "International Underwriting Agreement") among the Company, the Selling
Stockholder and each of the underwriters named below (the "International
Underwriters"), for whom Smith Barney Inc., BancAmerica Robertson Stephens
International Limited and Cowen International L.P. are acting as representatives
(the "International Representatives"), (i) the Company and the Selling
Stockholder have agreed to sell to each of the International Underwriters and
each of the International Underwriters has severally agreed to purchase from the
Company and the Selling Stockholder the aggregate number of Shares set forth
opposite its name in the table below and (ii) the Company has agreed to sell to
certain of the International Underwriters and each such International
Underwriter has severally agreed to purchase from the Company the principal
amount of the Convertible Notes set forth opposite its name below.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            PRINCIPAL
                                                            AMOUNT OF
                                              NUMBER OF    CONVERTIBLE
         INTERNATIONAL UNDERWRITERS            SHARES         NOTES
         --------------------------           ---------    ------------
<S>                                           <C>          <C>
Smith Barney Inc. ..........................  1,867,000    $21,000,000
BancAmerica Robertson Stephens International
  Limited...................................  1,866,500      4,500,000
Cowen International L.P.....................  1,866,500      4,500,000
ABN AMRO Rothchild..........................    350,000
Banque Nationale de Paris...................    350,000
Bayerische Vereinsbank Aktiengesellschaft...    350,000
J. Henry Schroder & Co. Limited.............    350,000
                                              ---------    -----------
          Total.............................  7,000,000    $30,000,000
                                              =========    ===========
</TABLE>
 
     The International Underwriting Agreement provides that the obligations of
the International Underwriters to purchase the Shares and Convertible Notes
listed above are subject to certain conditions set forth therein. The
International Underwriters are committed to purchase all of the Shares and
Convertible Notes agreed to be purchased by the International Underwriters
pursuant to the International Underwriting Agreement (other than those covered
by the over-allotment options described below), if any Shares or Convertible
Notes are purchased. In the event of default by any International Underwriter,
the International Underwriting Agreement provides that, in certain
circumstances, the purchase commitments of the non-defaulting International
Underwriters may be increased or the International Underwriting Agreement may be
terminated.
 
     The International Representatives have advised the Company and the Selling
Stockholder that the International Underwriters propose initially to offer such
Shares to the public at the initial public offering price thereof set forth on
the cover page of this Prospectus, and to certain dealers at such price less a
discount not in excess of $.40 per share. The International Underwriters may
allow, and such dealers may reallow, a discount not in excess of $.10 per share
on sales to certain other dealers. After the initial public offering of the
Shares, the public offering price and such discounts may be changed.
 
     The International Representatives have also advised the Company that the
relevant International Underwriters propose initially to offer such Convertible
Notes to the public at the initial public offering price thereof set forth on
the cover page of this Prospectus, and to certain dealers at such price less a
concession not in excess of 1.95% of the principal amount of such Convertible
Notes. The relevant International Underwriters may allow, and such dealers may
reallow, a discount not in excess of 0.25% of the principal amount of the
Convertible Notes on sales to certain other dealers. After the initial public
offering of the Convertible Notes, the public offering price and such
concessions may be changed.
 
     Purchasers of the Shares offered hereby may be required to pay stamp taxes
and other charges in accordance with the laws and practices of the country of
purchase in addition to the initial public offering price set forth on the cover
page hereof.
 
                                       97
<PAGE>   98
 
     The Company and the Selling Stockholder also have entered into an
underwriting agreement (the "U.S. Underwriting Agreement") with the U.S.
Underwriters named therein, for whom Smith Barney Inc., BancAmerica Robertson
Stephens and Cowen & Company are acting as representatives (the "U.S.
Representatives" and, together with the International Representatives, the
"Representatives"), providing for the concurrent offer and sale of 28,000,000 of
the Shares and $150,000,000 principal amount of the Convertible Notes in the
United States and Canada.
 
     The closing with respect to the sale of the Shares and the Convertible
Notes pursuant to the International Underwriting Agreement is a condition to the
closing with respect to the sale of the Shares and the Convertible Notes
pursuant to the U.S. Underwriting Agreement, and the closing with respect to the
sale of the Shares and the Convertible Notes pursuant to the U.S. Underwriting
Agreement is a condition to the closing with respect to the sale of the Shares
and the Convertible Notes pursuant to the International Underwriting Agreement.
The initial public offering price and underwriting discount per Share and per
Convertible Note for the International Offering and the U.S. Offering will be
identical.
 
     Each International Underwriter has severally agreed that, as part of the
distribution of the 7,000,000 Shares and $30,000,000 principal amount of the
Convertible Notes by the International Underwriters, (i) it is not purchasing
any Shares or Convertible Notes for the account of any United States or Canadian
Person, (ii) it has not offered or sold, and will not offer or sell, directly or
indirectly, any Shares or Convertible Notes or distribute any Prospectus to any
person in the United States or Canada, or to any United States or Canadian
Person and (iii) any dealer to whom it may sell any Shares or Convertible Notes
will represent that it is not purchasing for the account of any United States or
Canadian Person and agree that it will not offer or resell, directly or
indirectly, any Shares or Convertible Notes in the United States or Canada, or
to any United States or Canadian Person or to any other dealer who does not so
represent and agree.
 
     Each U.S. Underwriter has severally agreed that, as part of the
distribution of the 28,000,000 Shares and $150,000,000 principal amount of the
Convertible Notes by the U.S. Underwriters, (i) it is not purchasing any Shares
or Convertible Notes for the account of anyone other than a United States or
Canadian Person, (ii) it has not offered or sold, and will not offer or sell,
directly or indirectly, any Shares or Convertible Notes or distribute any
Prospectus relating to the U.S. Offering to any person outside of the United
States or Canada, or to anyone other than a United States or Canadian Person and
(iii) any dealer to whom it may sell any Shares or Convertible Notes will
represent that it is not purchasing for the account of anyone other than a
United States or Canadian Person and agree that it will not offer or resell,
directly or indirectly, any Shares or Convertible Notes outside of the United
States or Canada, or to anyone other than a United States or Canadian Person or
to any other dealer who does not so represent and agree.
 
     The foregoing limitations do not apply to stabilization transactions or to
certain other transactions specified in the Agreement Between U.S. Underwriters
and International Underwriters. "United States or Canadian Persons" means any
person who is a national or resident of the United States or Canada, any
corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in or under the
laws of the United States or Canada or of any political subdivision thereof, and
any estate or trust the income of which is subject to United States or Canadian
federal income taxation, regardless of its source (other than a foreign branch
of such entity) and includes any United States or Canadian branch of a person
other than a United States or Canadian Person.
 
     Pursuant to the Agreement Between U.S. Underwriters and International
Underwriters, sales may be made between the International Underwriters and the
U.S. Underwriters of such number of Shares and such principal amount of the
Convertible Notes as may be mutually agreed. The price of any Shares or
Convertible Notes so sold shall be the initial public offering price thereof set
forth on the cover page of this Prospectus, less an amount not greater than the
concession to securities dealers set forth above. To the extent that there are
sales between the International Underwriters and the U.S. Underwriters pursuant
to the Agreement Between U.S. Underwriters and International Underwriters, the
number of Shares and the principal amount of the Convertible Notes initially
available for sale by the International Underwriters or by the U.S. Underwriters
may be more or less than the amount specified on the cover page of this
Prospectus.
 
                                       98
<PAGE>   99
 
     Each International Underwriter has severally represented and agreed that
(i) it has not offered or sold and, prior to the expiration of six months from
the closing of the International Offering, will not offer or sell any Shares or
Convertible Notes in the United Kingdom other than to persons whose ordinary
activities involve them in acquiring, holding, managing or disposing of
investments (whether as principal or agent) for the purposes of their businesses
or otherwise in circumstances which have not resulted in and will not result in
an offer to the public within the meaning of the Public Offers of Securities
Regulations 1995; (ii) it has complied and will comply with all applicable
provisions of the Financial Services Act 1986 with respect to anything done by
it in relation to the Shares or the Convertible Notes in, from or otherwise
involving the United Kingdom; and (iii) it has only issued or passed on and will
only issue or pass on in the United Kingdom any document received by it in
connection with the issue of the Shares or the Convertible Notes to a person who
is of a kind described in Article 11(3) of the Financial Services Act 1986
(Investment Advertisements) (Exemptions) Order 1996 or is a person to whom such
document may otherwise lawfully be issued or passed on.
 
     The Company has granted to the International Underwriters and the U.S.
Underwriters options to purchase up to an additional 1,050,000 and 4,200,000
Shares, respectively, and an additional $4,500,000 and $22,500,000 principal
amount of the Convertible Notes, respectively, in each case at the applicable
price to the public less the applicable underwriting discount set forth on the
cover page of this Prospectus, solely to cover over-allotments, if any. Such
options may be exercised at any time up to 30 days after the date of this
Prospectus. To the extent such options are exercised, each of the International
Underwriters and the U.S. Underwriters will become obligated, subject to certain
conditions, to purchase approximately the same percentage of such additional
shares of Common Stock or such additional principal amount of Convertible Notes
as the percentage it was obligated to purchase pursuant to the International
Underwriting Agreement or the U.S. Underwriting Agreement, as applicable.
 
     The Company has agreed with the Underwriters not to offer, pledge, sell,
contract to sell, or otherwise dispose of (or enter into any transaction which
is designed to, or could be expected to, result in the disposition (whether by
actual disposition or effective economic disposition due to cash settlement or
otherwise) by the Company or any affiliate of the Company or any person in
privity with the Company or any affiliate of the Company), directly or
indirectly, or announce the offering of, any other shares of Common Stock (other
than the Convertible Notes) or any securities or options convertible into, or
exchangeable or exercisable for, shares of Common Stock for a period of 180 days
following the date hereof without the prior written consent of Smith Barney
Inc., subject to certain limited exceptions. In addition, each of the Company's
officers, directors and stockholders has agreed with the Underwriters not to
offer, sell, contract to sell, pledge or otherwise dispose of, or file a
registration statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission in respect
of, or establish or increase a put equivalent position or liquidate or decrease
a call equivalent position within the meaning of Section 16 of the Exchange Act
with respect to any shares of Common Stock or any securities convertible into or
exercisable or exchangeable for shares of Common Stock, or publicly announce an
intention to effect any such transaction, for a period of 180 days after the
date hereof unless pursuant to the Securities Loan Agreement (as described
below) or with the prior written consent of Smith Barney Inc., subject to
certain limited exceptions. Smith Barney Inc. currently does not intend to
release any securities subject to such lock-up agreements, but may, in its sole
discretion and at any time without notice, release all or any portion of the
securities subject to such lock-up agreements.
 
     The International Underwriting Agreement and the U.S. Underwriting
Agreement provide that the Company and the Selling Stockholder will indemnify
the several International Underwriters and U.S. Underwriters against certain
liabilities under the Securities Act, or contribute to payments the
International Underwriters and the U.S. Underwriters may be required to make in
respect thereof.
 
     BancAmerica Robertson Stephens International Limited is an affiliate of
Bank of America, which will be repaid approximately $43 million of short-term
loans to the Company from the net proceeds of the Offerings. See "Use of
Proceeds." Because more than 10% of the net proceeds of the Offerings may be
paid to Bank of America, the Offerings are being conducted in accordance with
Rule 2710(c)(8) and Rule 2720 ("Rule 2720") of the Conduct Rules of the National
Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. Smith Barney Inc. will serve as a
"qualified independent underwriter" in the Offerings and, in such capacity, will
recommend
                                       99
<PAGE>   100
 
a price in compliance with Rule 2720 and has performed due diligence
investigations in accordance with Rule 2720.
 
     Affiliates of Smith Barney Inc., Mr. James Kim and AICL are among the
principal shareholders of a securities and investment banking firm in Korea. In
addition, certain of the Underwriters and their affiliates have been engaged
from time to time, and may in the future be engaged, to perform investment
banking and other advisory-related services to the Company and its affiliates,
including the Selling Stockholder, in the ordinary course of business. In
connection with rendering such services in the past, such Underwriters and
affiliates have received customary compensation, including reimbursement of
related expenses.
 
     In connection with the Offerings, certain Underwriters and selling group
members and their respective affiliates may engage in transactions that
stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the market price of the Common Stock or
the Convertible Notes. Such transactions may include stabilization transactions
effected in accordance with Rule 104 of Regulation M, pursuant to which such
persons may bid for or purchase Common Stock or Convertible Notes for the
purpose of stabilizing their market price. The Underwriters also may create a
short position for the account of the Underwriters by selling more Common Stock
or Convertible Notes in connection with the Offerings than they are committed to
purchase from the Company and the Selling Stockholder, and in such case may
purchase Common Stock or Convertible Notes in the open market following
completion of the Offerings to cover all or a portion of such short position.
The Underwriters may also cover all or a portion of such short position, up to
5,250,000 shares of Common Stock and $27,000,000 principal amount of the
Convertible Notes, by exercising the Underwriters' over-allotment options
referred to above. In addition, the Representatives, on behalf of the
Underwriters, may impose "penalty bids" under contractual arrangements with the
Underwriters whereby it may reclaim from an Underwriter (or dealer participating
in the Offerings), for the account of the other Underwriters, the selling
concession with respect to Common Stock or Convertible Notes that is distributed
in the Offerings but subsequently purchased for the account of the Underwriters
in the open market. Any of the transactions described in this paragraph may
result in the maintenance of the price of the Common Stock and the Convertible
Notes at a level above that which might otherwise prevail in the open market.
None of the transactions described in this paragraph is required, and, if they
are undertaken, they may be discontinued at any time.
 
     In connection with the Offerings, Mr. and Mrs. Kim (referred to herein as
the "Lenders") and Smith Barney Inc. intend to enter into a securities loan
agreement (the "Securities Loan Agreement") which provides that, subject to
certain restrictions and with the agreement of the Lenders, Smith Barney Inc.
may from time to time until the maturity date or redemption date of the
Convertible Notes borrow, return and reborrow shares of Common Stock from the
Lenders (the "Borrowed Securities"); provided, however, that the number of
Borrowed Securities at any time may not exceed 7,000,000 shares of Common Stock,
subject to adjustment for certain dilutive events. The Securities Loan Agreement
is intended to facilitate market-making activity in the Convertible Notes by
Smith Barney Inc. Smith Barney Inc. may from time to time borrow shares of
Common Stock under the Securities Loan Agreement to settle short sales of Common
Stock (or to return Common Stock previously borrowed by Smith Barney Inc. to
settle such short sales) entered into by Smith Barney Inc. to hedge any long
position in the Convertible Notes resulting from its market-making activities.
Such sales will be made on the Nasdaq National Market or in the over-the-counter
market at market prices prevailing at the time of sale or at prices related to
such market prices. Market conditions will dictate the extent and timing of
Smith Barney Inc.'s market-making transactions in the Convertible Notes and the
consequent need to borrow and sell shares of Common Stock. The availability of
shares of Common Stock under the Securities Loan Agreement at any time is not
assured and any such availability does not assure market-making activity with
respect to the Convertible Notes. Any market-making engaged in by Smith Barney
Inc. or any other Underwriter may cease at any time. The foregoing description
of the Securities Loan Agreement does not purport to be complete and is
qualified in its entirety by reference to such agreement, which is an exhibit to
the Securities Loan Registration Statement.
 
     The Underwriters do not intend to confirm sales in the Offerings to any
accounts over which they exercise discretionary authority.
 
                                       100
<PAGE>   101
 
     Prior to the Offerings, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock. Accordingly, the initial public offering price for the Shares was
determined by negotiation among the Company, the Selling Stockholder and the
Representatives. Among the factors considered in determining the initial public
offering price were the Company's record of operations, its current financial
condition, its future prospects, the market for its services, the experience of
management, the economic conditions of the Company's industry in general, the
general condition of the equity securities market and the demand for similar
securities of companies considered comparable to the Company and other relevant
factors. There can be no assurance, however, that the prices at which the Common
Stock will sell in the public market after the Offerings will not be lower than
the price at which the Shares are sold by the Underwriters.
 
                                 LEGAL MATTERS
 
     The validity of the Shares and the Convertible Notes offered hereby will be
passed upon for the Company by Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati, Professional
Corporation, Palo Alto, California. Cleary, Gottlieb, Steen & Hamilton, New
York, New York, is acting as counsel for the Underwriters in connection with
certain legal matters relating to the Shares and the Convertible Notes offered
hereby.
 
                                    EXPERTS
 
     The combined financial statements and schedule of Amkor Technology, Inc.
and AK Industries, Inc. as of December 31, 1996 and 1997, and for each of the
years in the three-year period ended December 31, 1997, included in this
Prospectus and elsewhere in this Registration Statement have been audited by
Arthur Andersen LLP, independent public accountants, as set forth in their
reports dated February 3, 1998 (except with respect to the sale of the
investment in Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. ("AICL") common stock discussed in Note
6 to the Combined Financial Statements, as to which the date is February 16,
1998 and the Reorganization discussed in Note 16, as to which the date is April
29, 1998) with respect thereto, and are included herein in reliance upon the
authority of said firm as experts in giving said reports. In those reports, such
firm states that with respect to the investment in AICL its opinion is based on
the report of other independent public accountants, namely Samil Accounting
Corporation.
 
     Reference is made to said reports which include an explanatory paragraph
with respect to the ability of Amkor Technology, Inc. and AK Industries, Inc. to
continue as a going concern as discussed in Note 1 of Notes to the Combined
Financial Statements.
 
     The consolidated financial statements of AICL as of December 31, 1996 and
1997, and for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 1997
(not included in this Prospectus or elsewhere in this Registration Statement)
have been audited by Samil Accounting Corporation, independent public
accountants, as set forth in their report dated March 20, 1998 with respect
thereto, which report is included herein in reliance upon the authority of said
firm as experts. In that report, such firm states that with respect to Anam
Engineering & Construction Co., Ltd. ("AEC") and AUSA, subsidiaries of AICL, and
the investment in AAP, its opinion is based on the reports of other independent
public accountants, namely Chong Un & Company, Siana, Carr and O' Connor, LLP
and SyCip Gorres, Velayo & Co, respectively.
 
     Reference is made to the reports regarding AAP and AEC,which include
explanatory paragraphs with respect to the ability of AAP and AEC, respectively,
to continue as a going concern, and the report regarding AICL, which includes an
explanatory paragraph regarding a change in accounting principles, the impact of
the Korean economic situation on AICL and the ability of AICL to continue as a
going concern.
 
                                       101
<PAGE>   102
 
                             ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 
     The Company has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the
"Commission") a Registration Statement on Form S-1 (the "Registration
Statement") under the Securities Act with respect to the securities offered
hereby. This Prospectus does not contain all of the information set forth in the
Registration Statement and the exhibits and schedules thereto. For further
information with respect to the Company, the Common Stock and the Convertible
Notes, reference is made to the Registration Statement and the exhibits and
schedules filed as a part thereof. Statements contained in this Prospectus as to
the contents of any contract or any other document referred to are not
necessarily complete. In each instance, reference is made to the copy of such
contract or document filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement, and each
such statement is qualified in all respects by such reference. The Registration
Statement, including exhibits and schedules thereto, may be inspected without
charge at the public reference facilities maintained by the Commission at 450
Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549 and at the regional offices of the
Commission located at Seven World Trade Center, Suite 1300, New York, New York
10048 and Northwestern Atrium Center, 500 Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago,
Illinois 60661-2511. Copies of such materials may be obtained from the Public
Reference Section of the Commission, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C.
20549, at prescribed rates and through the National Association of Securities
Dealers, Inc. located at 1735 K Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20006. The
Commission maintains a World Wide Web site that contains reports, proxy and
information statements and other information regarding registrants that file
electronically with the Commission. The address of the Commission's Web site is
http://www.sec.gov.
 
                                       102
<PAGE>   103
 
                                    GLOSSARY
 
ASIC.......................  Application Specific Integrated Circuit. A
                             custom-designed integrated circuit that performs
                             specific functions which would otherwise require a
                             number of off-the-shelf integrated circuits to
                             perform. The use of an ASIC in place of a
                             conventional integrated circuit reduces product
                             size and cost and also improves reliability.
 
BGA........................  Ball grid array.
 
Bus........................  A common pathway, or channel, between multiple
                             devices.
 
CMOS.......................  Complementary Metal Oxide Silicon. Currently the
                             most common integrated circuit fabrication process
                             technology, CMOS is one of the latest fabrication
                             techniques to use metal oxide semiconductor
                             transistors.
 
DAC........................  Digital Analog Converter. A device that converts
                             digital pulses into analog signals.
 
Die........................  A piece of a semiconductor wafer containing the
                             circuitry of a single chip.
 
DRAM.......................  Dynamic Random Access Memory. A type of volatile
                             memory product that is used in electronic systems
                             to store data and program instructions. It is the
                             most common type of RAM and must be refreshed with
                             electricity thousands of times per second or else
                             it will fade away.
 
DSP........................  Digital Signal Processor. A type of integrated
                             circuit that processes and manipulates digital
                             information after it has been converted from an
                             analog source.
 
EEPROM.....................  Electrically Erasable and Programmable Read-Only
                             Memory. A form of non-volatile memory that can be
                             erased electronically before being reprogrammed.
 
EPROM......................  Erasable Programmable Read-Only Memory. A
                             programmable and reusable chip that holds its
                             content until erased under ultraviolet light.
 
Ethernet...................  A type of local area network (LAN). Most widely
                             used LAN access method.
 
Flash Memory...............  A type of non-volatile memory, similar to an EEPROM
                             in that it is erasable and reprogrammable.
 
FlipChip...................  Package type where silicon die is attached to the
                             packaging substrate using solder balls instead of
                             wires. See "Business -- Products."
 
GPS........................  Global Positioning System. A system for identifying
                             earth locations.
 
GUI........................  Graphical User Interface. A graphics-based user
                             interface that incorporates icons, pull-down menus
                             and a mouse.
 
IC.........................  Integrated Circuit. A combination of two or more
                             transistors on a base material, usually silicon.
                             All semiconductor chips, including memory chips and
                             logic chips, are just very complicated ICs with
                             thousands of transistors.
 
Input/Output...............  A connector which interconnects the chip to the
                             package or one package level to the next level in
                             the hierarchy. Also referred to as pin out
                             connections or terminals.
 
ISDN.......................  Integrated Services Digital Network. An
                             international telecommunications standard for
                             transmitting voice, video and data over digital
                             lines running at 64 Kbps.
 
Logic Device...............  A device that contains digital integrated circuits
                             that process, rather than store, information.
 
                                       103
<PAGE>   104
 
Mask.......................  A piece of glass on which an IC's circuitry design
                             is laid out. Integrated circuits may require up to
                             20 different layers of design, each with its own
                             mask. In the IC production process, a light shines
                             through the mask leaving an image of the design on
                             the wafer. Also known as a reticle.
 
MBGA.......................  Micro Ball Grid Array. See "Business -- Products."
 
Micron.....................  1/25,000 of an inch. Circuitry on an IC typically
                             follows lines that are less than one micron wide.
 
MOS........................  A device which consists of three layers (metal,
                             oxide and semiconductors) and operates as a
                             transistor.
 
MQFP.......................  Metric Quad Flat Package. See
                             "Business -- Products."
 
PBGA.......................  Plastic Ball Grid Array. See
                             "Business -- Products."
 
PC.........................  Personal Computer.
 
PCMCIA.....................  Standard for connecting peripherals to computers.
 
PDA........................  Personal Digital Assistant.
 
PDIP.......................  Plastic Dual In-Line Packages. See
                             "Business -- Products."
 
Photolithography...........  A lithographic technique used to transfer the
                             design of the circuit paths and electronic elements
                             on a chip onto a wafer's surface.
 
PLCC.......................  Plastic Leaded Chip Carrier. See
                             "Business -- Products."
 
PLD........................  A logic chip that is programmed at the customer's
                             site.
 
PQFP.......................  Plastic Quad Flat Packages. See
                             "Business -- Products."
 
RF.........................  Radio Frequency. The range of electromagnetic
                             frequencies above the audio range and below visible
                             light.
 
SIP........................  Single In-Line Package. See "Business -- Products."
 
SOIC.......................  Small Outline IC Packages. See
                             "Business -- Products."
 
SRAM.......................  Static Random Access Memory. A type of volatile
                             memory product that is used in electronic systems
                             to store data and program instructions. Unlike the
                             more common DRAM, it does not need to be refreshed.
 
SSOP.......................  Shrink Small Outline Packages. See
                             "Business -- Products."
 
Surface Mount Technology...  A circuit board packaging technique in which the
                             leads (pins) on the chips and components are
                             soldered on top of the board.
 
TQFP.......................  Thin Quad Flat Packages. See
                             "Business -- Products."
 
TSOP.......................  Thin Small Outline Packages. See
                             "Business -- Products."
 
TSSOP......................  Thin Shrink Small Outline Packages. See
                             "Business -- Products."
 
Wafer......................  Thin, round, flat piece of silicon that is the base
                             of most integrated circuits.
 
Wire Bonding...............  The method used to attach very fine wire to
                             semiconductor components in order to provide
                             electrical continuity between the semiconductor die
                             and a terminal.
 
                                       104
<PAGE>   105
 
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
                     INDEX TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              PAGE
                                                              ----
<S>                                                           <C>
Report of Independent Public Accountants (Arthur Andersen
  LLP)......................................................   F-2
Combined Statements of Income -- Years ended December 31,
  1995, 1996 and 1997.......................................   F-3
Combined Balance Sheets -- December 31, 1996 and 1997.......   F-4
Combined Statements of Stockholders' Equity -- Years ended
  December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997..........................   F-5
Combined Statements of Cash Flows -- Years ended December
  31, 1995, 1996 and 1997...................................   F-6
Notes to Combined Financial Statements......................   F-7
Independent Auditors' Report (Samil Accounting Corporation)
  with respect to Anam Industrial Co., Ltd..................  F-25
Independent Auditors' Report (Chong Un & Company) with
  respect to Anam Engineering & Construction Co., Ltd.......  F-27
Report of Independent Public Accountants (SyCip Gorres
  Velayo & Co) with respect to Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc....  F-28
Independent Auditors' Report (Siana Carr & O'Connor, LLP)
  with respect to Anam USA, Inc.............................  F-29
</TABLE>
 
                                       F-1
<PAGE>   106
 
                    REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
To Amkor Technology, Inc. and AK Industries, Inc.:
 
     We have audited the accompanying combined balance sheets of Amkor
Technology, Inc. and AK Industries, Inc. and subsidiaries (see Note 1) as of
December 31, 1996 and 1997, and the related combined statements of income,
stockholders' equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period
ended December 31, 1997. These financial statements are the responsibility of
the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these
financial statements based on our audits. We did not audit the financial
statements of Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. ("AICL"), the investment in which is
reflected in the accompanying financial statements using the equity method of
accounting. The investment in AICL represents 4% and 2% of total assets at
December 31, 1996 and 1997, respectively, and the equity in its net income
represents 5% of net income in 1995 and the equity in its net loss represents 4%
and 29% of net income before the equity in income (loss) of AICL in 1996 and
1997, respectively. The statements of AICL were audited by other auditors whose
report has been furnished to us and our opinion, insofar as it relates to
amounts included for AICL, is based solely on the report of the other auditors.
 
     We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
     In our opinion, based upon our audit and the report of other auditors, the
financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects,
the combined financial position of Amkor Technology, Inc. and AK Industries,
Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 1996 and 1997, and the results of their
operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended
December 31, 1997, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.
 
     The accompanying financial statements have been prepared assuming that the
Company will continue as a going concern. As discussed in Note 1 to the combined
financial statements, the Company is not in compliance with certain debt
agreements and has a net working capital deficiency at December 31, 1997. These
matters raise substantial doubt about the Company's ability to continue as a
going concern. Management's plans in regard to this matter are also described in
Note 1. The financial statements do not include any adjustments that might
result from the outcome of this uncertainty.
 
     The report of the other auditors referred to above indicates that the
financial statements of AICL have been prepared assuming that AICL will continue
as a going concern. The operations of AICL have been significantly affected, and
will continue to be affected for the foreseeable future, by Korea's unstable
economy caused by currency volatility and unstable finance markets in Korea.
AICL has traditionally operated with a significant amount of debt relative to
its equity and has a significant working capital deficit at December 31, 1997.
Because of Korea's unstable economy and AICL's dependence on debt financing,
there are significant uncertainties that may affect AICL's future operations and
its abilities to maintain or refinance certain debt obligations as they mature,
which raise substantial doubt regarding AICL's ability to continue as a going
concern. The ultimate outcome of these uncertainties cannot be determined
presently and AICL's financial statements do not include any adjustments that
might result from these uncertainties. AICL's plans to address these matters are
included in the notes to the AICL financial statements.
 
                                          ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
 
Philadelphia, Pa.
 
February 3, 1998 (except with respect to the sale of the investment in Anam
Industrial Co., Ltd. common stock discussed in Note 6, as to which the date is
February 16, 1998 and the Reorganization discussed in Note 16, as to which the
date is April 29, 1998).
 
                                       F-2
<PAGE>   107
 
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
                         COMBINED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
                     (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED
                                                                         DECEMBER 31,
                                                              ----------------------------------
                                                                1995        1996         1997
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
<S>                                                           <C>        <C>          <C>
NET REVENUES................................................  $932,382   $1,171,001   $1,455,761
COST OF REVENUES -- including purchases from AICL (Note
  11).......................................................   783,335    1,022,078    1,242,669
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
GROSS PROFIT................................................   149,047      148,923      213,092
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
OPERATING EXPENSES:
  Selling, general and administrative.......................    55,459       66,625      103,726
  Research and development..................................     8,733       10,930        8,525
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
     Total operating expenses...............................    64,192       77,555      112,251
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
OPERATING INCOME............................................    84,855       71,368      100,841
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
OTHER (INCOME) EXPENSE:
  Interest expense, net.....................................     9,797       22,245       32,241
  Foreign currency (gain) loss..............................     1,512        2,961         (835)
  Other expense, net........................................     6,523        3,150        8,429
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
     Total other expense....................................    17,832       28,356       39,835
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES, EQUITY IN INCOME (LOSS) OF AICL
  AND MINORITY INTEREST.....................................    67,023       43,012       61,006
PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES..................................     6,384        7,876        7,078
EQUITY IN INCOME (LOSS) OF AICL.............................     2,808       (1,266)     (17,291)
MINORITY INTEREST...........................................     1,515          948       (6,644)
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
NET INCOME..................................................  $ 61,932   $   32,922   $   43,281
                                                              ========   ==========   ==========
PRO FORMA DATA (UNAUDITED):
  Historical income before income taxes, equity in income
     (loss) of AICL and minority interest...................  $ 67,023   $   43,012   $   61,006
  Pro forma provision for income taxes......................    16,784       10,776       10,691
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
  Pro forma income before equity in income (loss) of AICL
     and minority interest..................................    50,239       32,236       50,315
  Historical equity in income (loss) of AICL................     2,808       (1,266)     (17,291)
  Historical minority interest..............................     1,515          948       (6,644)
                                                              --------   ----------   ----------
  Pro forma net income......................................  $ 51,532   $   30,022   $   39,668
                                                              ========   ==========   ==========
  Basic and diluted pro forma net income per common share...  $    .62   $      .36   $      .48
                                                              ========   ==========   ==========
Shares used in computing pro forma net income per common
  share.....................................................    82,610       82,610       82,610
                                                              ========   ==========   ==========
</TABLE>
 
        The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                       F-3
<PAGE>   108
 
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
                            COMBINED BALANCE SHEETS
                                 (IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       DECEMBER 31,
                                                            -----------------------------------
                                                                          1997         1997
                                                              1996       ACTUAL      PRO FORMA
                                                            --------    --------    -----------
                                                                                    (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                         <C>         <C>         <C>
                                            ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and cash equivalents...............................  $ 49,664    $ 90,917     $ 63,217
  Short-term investments..................................       881       2,524        2,524
  Accounts receivable --
     Trade, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of
       $1,179, $4,234 and $4,234..........................   170,892     102,804      102,804
     Due from affiliates..................................    26,886      14,431       14,431
     Other................................................     6,426       4,879        4,879
  Inventories.............................................   101,920     115,870      115,870
  Other current assets....................................     8,618      26,997       26,997
                                                            --------    --------     --------
          Total current assets............................   365,287     358,422      330,722
                                                            --------    --------     --------
PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT, net........................   324,895     427,061      427,061
                                                            --------    --------     --------
INVESTMENTS:
  AICL at equity..........................................    31,154      13,863       13,863
  Other...................................................    38,090       5,958        5,958
                                                            --------    --------     --------
          Total investments...............................    69,244      19,821       19,821
                                                            --------    --------     --------
OTHER ASSETS:
  Due from affiliates.....................................    20,699      29,186       29,186
  Other...................................................    24,739      21,102       21,102
                                                            --------    --------     --------
                                                              45,438      50,288       50,288
                                                            --------    --------     --------
          Total assets....................................  $804,864    $855,592     $827,892
                                                            ========    ========     ========
                             LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Short-term borrowings and current portion of long-term
     debt.................................................  $191,813    $325,968     $325,968
  Trade accounts payable..................................    45,798     113,037      113,037
  Due to affiliates.......................................    33,379      15,581       15,581
  Bank overdraft..........................................    14,518      29,765       29,765
  Accrued expenses........................................    30,156      43,973       43,973
  Accrued income taxes....................................    12,838      26,968       26,968
                                                            --------    --------     --------
          Total current liabilities.......................   328,502     555,292      555,292
                                                            --------    --------     --------
LONG-TERM DEBT............................................   167,444      38,283       38,283
                                                            --------    --------     --------
DUE TO ANAM USA, INC. (Note 11)...........................   234,894     149,776      149,776
                                                            --------    --------     --------
OTHER NONCURRENT LIABILITIES..............................    12,286      12,084       14,184
                                                            --------    --------     --------
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Notes 1 and 13)
MINORITY INTEREST.........................................    15,926       9,282        9,282
                                                            --------    --------     --------
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
  Amkor Technology, Inc. -- common stock..................        45          45           45
  AK Industries, Inc. -- common stock.....................         1           1            1
  Additional paid-in capital..............................    16,770      20,871       20,871
  Retained earnings.......................................    32,340      70,621       40,821
  Unrealized losses on investments........................    (1,586)         --           --
  Cumulative translation adjustment.......................    (1,758)       (663)        (663)
                                                            --------    --------     --------
          Total stockholders' equity......................    45,812      90,875       61,075
                                                            --------    --------     --------
          Total liabilities and stockholders' equity......  $804,864    $855,592     $827,892
                                                            ========    ========     ========
</TABLE>
 
        The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                       F-4
<PAGE>   109
 
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
                  COMBINED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
             FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1996, AND 1997
                                 (IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   AMKOR          AK                                 UNREALIZED
                                 TECHNOLOY,   INDUSTRIES,                               GAINS
                                    INC.         INC.       ADDITIONAL                (LOSSES)      CUMULATIVE
                                   COMMON       COMMON       PAID-IN     RETAINED        ON        TRANSLATION
                                   STOCK         STOCK       CAPITAL     EARNINGS    INVESTMENTS    ADJUSTMENT     TOTAL
                                 ----------   -----------   ----------   ---------   -----------   ------------   --------
<S>                              <C>          <C>           <C>          <C>         <C>           <C>            <C>
BALANCE AT JANUARY 1, 1995.....     $45           $ 1        $16,494     $ (6,359)     $   (35)      $  (529)     $  9,617
  Net income...................      --            --             --       61,932           --            --        61,932
  Distributions................      --            --             --      (19,922)          --            --       (19,922)
  Change in division equity
    account....................      --            --             --       (4,505)          --            --        (4,505)
  Unrealized gains (losses) on
    investments................      --            --             --           --       (2,015)           --        (2,015)
  Currency translation
    adjustments................      --            --             --           --           --           182           182
                                    ---           ---        -------     --------      -------       -------      --------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1995...      45             1         16,494       31,146       (2,050)         (347)       45,289
  Net income...................      --            --             --       32,922           --            --        32,922
  Distributions................      --            --             --      (15,123)          --            --       (15,123)
  Change in division equity
    account....................      --            --             --      (16,605)          --            --       (16,605)
  Unrealized gains (losses) on
    investments................      --            --             --           --          464            --           464
  Currency translation
    adjustments................      --            --             --           --           --        (1,411)       (1,411)
  Acquisition of AATS (Note
    14)........................      --            --            276           --           --            --           276
                                    ---           ---        -------     --------      -------       -------      --------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1996...      45             1         16,770       32,340       (1,586)       (1,758)       45,812
  Net income...................      --            --             --       43,281           --            --        43,281
  Distributions................      --            --             --       (5,000)          --            --        (5,000)
  Change in division equity
    account....................      --            --          4,101           --           --            --         4,101
  Unrealized gains (losses) on
    investments................      --            --             --           --        1,586            --         1,586
  Currency translation
    adjustments................      --            --             --           --           --         1,095         1,095
                                    ---           ---        -------     --------      -------       -------      --------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1997...     $45           $ 1        $20,871     $ 70,621      $     0       $  (663)     $ 90,875
                                    ===           ===        =======     ========      =======       =======      ========
</TABLE>
 
        The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                       F-5
<PAGE>   110
 
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
                       COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                                 (IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         FOR THE YEAR ENDED
                                                                            DECEMBER 31,
                                                              -----------------------------------------
                                                                 1995           1996           1997
                                                              -----------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                           <C>            <C>            <C>
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income................................................  $    61,932    $    32,922    $    43,281
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided
    by operating activities --
    Depreciation and amortization...........................       26,614         57,825         81,864
    Provision for accounts receivable.......................          444          1,271          3,490
    Provision for excess and obsolete inventory.............        1,000            500         12,659
    Deferred income taxes...................................       (1,147)          (324)       (11,715)
    Equity (gain) loss of investees.........................       (2,713)           605         16,779
    (Gain) loss on sale of investments......................          126           (139)          (239)
    Minority interest.......................................        1,515            948         (6,644)
  Changes in assets and liabilities excluding effects of
    acquisitions --
    Accounts receivable.....................................      (53,264)       (36,695)       (19,802)
    Proceeds from accounts receivable sale..................           --             --         90,700
    Other receivables.......................................       (2,565)          (925)         1,547
    Inventories.............................................      (32,668)       (16,380)       (26,609)
    Due to/from affiliates, net.............................       (3,001)        (8,203)       (19,138)
    Other current assets....................................       (4,764)         1,694         (7,239)
    Other non-current assets................................         (326)        (6,108)         3,322
    Accounts payable........................................       35,017        (16,852)        60,939
    Accrued expenses........................................       17,687        (12,658)        13,817
    Accrued taxes...........................................          404          7,433         14,130
    Other long-term liabilities.............................        9,034           (108)        (1,089)
    Other, net..............................................           --          3,750             --
                                                              -----------    -----------    -----------
         Net cash provided by operating activities..........       53,325          8,556        250,053
                                                              -----------    -----------    -----------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchases of property, plant and equipment, including
    purchase of AATS........................................     (123,645)      (185,112)      (178,990)
  Sale of property, plant and equipment.....................          110          2,228          1,413
  Purchases of investments and issuances of notes
    receivable..............................................      (25,123)       (15,633)       (15,187)
  Proceeds from sale of investments.........................          351            520             --
                                                              -----------    -----------    -----------
         Net cash used in investing activities..............     (148,307)      (197,997)      (192,764)
                                                              -----------    -----------    -----------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Net change in bank overdrafts and short-term borrowings...       41,308         64,852         52,393
  Proceeds from issuance of Anam USA, Inc. debt.............    1,059,759      1,205,174      1,408,086
  Payments of Anam USA, Inc. debt...........................   (1,052,415)    (1,189,317)    (1,443,464)
  Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt..................       50,080        102,193         11,389
  Payments of long-term debt................................       (3,021)        (3,138)       (43,541)
  Distributions to stockholders.............................      (20,003)       (15,205)        (5,000)
  Change in division equity account.........................       (4,505)       (16,605)         4,101
                                                              -----------    -----------    -----------
         Net cash provided by (used in) financing
           activities.......................................       71,203        147,954        (16,036)
                                                              -----------    -----------    -----------
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS........      (23,779)       (41,487)        41,253
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF PERIOD..............      114,930         91,151         49,664
                                                              -----------    -----------    -----------
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF PERIOD....................  $    91,151    $    49,664    $    90,917
                                                              ===========    ===========    ===========
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
  Cash paid during the period for:
    Interest................................................  $    12,594    $    24,125    $    37,070
    Income taxes............................................          495          2,256          3,022
</TABLE>
 
        The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                       F-6
<PAGE>   111
 
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
                     NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
 1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
  Principles of Combination
 
     The combined financial statements of Amkor Technology, Inc. ("ATI") and its
subsidiaries and AK Industries, Inc. and its subsidiary ("Amkor" or the
"Company") include the accounts of the following (these companies are referred
to as the "Amkor Companies"):
 
     - Amkor Electronics, Inc. ("AEI"), a U.S. S Corporation and its wholly
       owned subsidiaries Amkor Receivables Corp and Amkor Wafer Fabrication
       Services SARL (a French Limited Company).
 
     - T.L. Limited ("TLL") (a British Cayman Island Corporation) and its
       Philippine subsidiaries, Amkor Anam Advanced Packaging, Inc. ("AAAP")
       (wholly owned) and Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. ("AAP") (which is currently
       owned 60% by TLL and 40% by Anam Semiconductor Inc. which changed its
       name in 1998 from Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. ("AICL"-- see Notes 11 and
       16) and its wholly-owned subsidiary Automated MicroElectronics, Inc.
       ("AMI");
 
     - C.I.L., Limited ("CIL") (a British Cayman Islands Corporation) and its
       wholly-owned subsidiary Amkor/Anam Euroservices S.A.R.L. ("AAES") (a
       French Corporation);
 
     - Amkor Anam Test Services, Inc. (a U.S. Corporation) (see Note 14); and
 
     - The semiconductor packaging and test business unit of Chamterry
       Enterprises, Ltd. ("Chamterry"). During the third quarter of 1997
       Chamterry transferred its customers to AEI and CIL and ceased operations
       of its semiconductor and test business unit.
 
     - AK Industries, Inc. ("AKI") (a U.S. Corporation) and its wholly-owned
       subsidiary, Amkor-Anam, Inc. (a U.S. Corporation);
 
     All of the Amkor Companies are substantially wholly owned by Mr. and Mrs.
James Kim or entities controlled by members of Mr. James Kim's immediate family
(the "Founding Stockholders"), except for AAP which is 40% owned by AICL and one
third of AEI and all of AKI which are owned by trusts established for the
benefit of other members of Mr. James Kim's family ("Kim Family Trusts"). The
Amkor Companies are an interdependent group of companies involved in the same
business under the direction of common management. ATI was formed in September
1997 to facilitate the Reorganization and consolidate the ownership of the Amkor
Companies. In connection with the Reorganization, AEI was merged into ATI. Amkor
International Holdings ("AIH") a newly formed Cayman Islands holding company
became a wholly owned subsidiary of ATI. AIH holds the following entities: First
Amkor Caymans, Inc. ("FACI"), a newly formed holding company, and its
subsidiaries AAAP and AAP and AAP's subsidiary AMI, TLL and its subsidiary CIL
and CIL's subsidiary AAES. The relative number of shares of common stock issued
by the Company in connection with each of the transactions comprising the
Reorganization was based upon the relative amounts of stockholders' equity at
December 31, 1997. In exchange for their interests in AEI, Mr. and Mrs. James
Kim and the Kim Family Trusts received two-thirds (9,746,760 shares) and
one-third (4,873,380 shares) of the ATI common stock then outstanding,
respectively. ATI then issued 67,989,851 shares of common stock, representing
approximately 82% of its shares immediately after the Reorganization, in
exchange for all of the outstanding shares of AIH and its subsidiaries. Of such
shares, 27,528,234 shares and, 36,376,617 shares were gifted to Mr. and Mrs.
James Kim and the Kim Family Trusts, respectively, such that Mr. and Mrs. James
Kim and the Kim Family Trusts own 45.1% and 49.9%, respectively, of the ATI
common shares outstanding after the Reorganization. Following such transactions
the Founding Stockholders beneficially owned a majority of the outstanding
shares of ATI common stock. In addition, ATI acquired all of the stock of AKI
from the Kim Family Trusts for $3,000. The merger of AEI and ATI, the creation
of AIH and FACI, the issuance of ATI common stock for AIH and the acquisition of
AKI are collectively referred to as the Reorganization.
 
                                       F-7
<PAGE>   112
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
     Included within the Amkor Companies following the Reorganization are ATI,
AIH and its subsidiaries and AKI and its subsidiary. All of the subsidiaries are
wholly owned except for 40% of the common stock of AAP which is owned by AICL
(see Note 16), and a small number of shares of each of AAP, AAAP and AMI which
are required to be owned by directors of these companies pursuant to Philippine
law.
 
     Except for the acquisition of the shares of AKI which has been accounted
for as a purchase transaction, the Reorganization described above was treated
similar to a pooling of interests as it represents an exchange of equity
interests among companies under common control. The purchase price for the AKI
stock, which represents the fair value of these shares, approximates the book
value of AKI. The financial statements are presented on a combined basis as a
result of the common ownership and business operations of all of the Amkor
Companies, including AKI. As a result of the acquisition of AKI, AKI became a
wholly owned subsidiary of ATI; accordingly, future financial statements will be
presented for ATI and its subsidiaries on a consolidated basis.
 
     The financial statements reflect the elimination of all significant
intercompany accounts and transactions.
 
     The investments in and the operating results of 20%- to 50%-owned companies
are included in the combined financial statements using the equity method of
accounting.
 
  Basis of Presentation
 
     The accompanying financial statements have been prepared on a going concern
basis which contemplates realization of assets and liquidation of liabilities in
the ordinary course of business. At December 31, 1997 the Company was not in
compliance with certain restrictive covenants of its principal long-term debt
agreements and, as a result, amounts due under these agreements are required to
be classified as current liabilities in the combined balance sheet.
Consequently, at December 31, 1997, current liabilities exceeded current assets
by $196,870. To date, the Company has not received any notification that the
Company's repayment obligations with respect to these loans have been
accelerated as a result of such covenant violations. However, there is no
assurance that the Company could generate sufficient cash flow from operations
or other sources to satisfy these liabilities should they become due before
maturity. If the planned public offering of common stock and convertible debt is
successful (see Note 16), the Company will use part of the net proceeds to the
Company to repay these bank loans. The financial statements do not include any
adjustments that might result from the outcome of these uncertainties.
 
  Nature of Operations
 
     The Company provides semiconductor packaging and test services to
semiconductor and computer manufacturers located in strategic markets throughout
the world. Such services are provided by the Company and by AICL under a
long-standing arrangement. Approximately 79%, 72% and 68% of the Company's
packaging and test revenues in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively, relate to the
packaging and test services provided by AICL.
 
  Concentrations of Credit Risk
 
     Financial instruments, for which the Company is subject to credit risk,
consist principally of trade receivables. The Company has mitigated this risk by
selling primarily to well established companies, performing ongoing credit
evaluations and making frequent contact with customers.
 
     At December 31, 1996 and 1997, the Company maintained $34,330 and $53,071,
respectively, in deposits at one U.S. financial institution and $1,861 and
$2,548, respectively, in deposits at U.S. banks which exceeded federally insured
limits.
 
                                       F-8
<PAGE>   113
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
     Additionally, at December 31, 1996 and 1997, the Company maintained
deposits and certificates of deposits totaling approximately $14,649 and
$34,622, respectively, at foreign owned banks.
 
  Significant Customers
 
     The Company has a number of major customers in North America, Asia and
Europe. The Company's largest customer, Intel Corporation, accounted for
approximately 13.3%, 23.5% and 23.4% of net revenues in 1995, 1996 and 1997,
respectively. The Company's five largest customers collectively accounted for
34.1%, 39.2% and 40.1% of net revenues in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. The
Company anticipates that significant customer concentration will continue for
the foreseeable future, although the companies which constitute the Company's
largest customers may change.
 
  Risks and Uncertainties
 
     The Company's future results of operations involve a number of risks and
uncertainties. Factors that could affect the Company's future operating results
and cause actual results to vary materially from expectations include, but are
not limited to, dependence on the highly cyclical nature of both the
semiconductor and the personal computer industries, competitive pricing and
declines in average selling prices, risks associated with leverage, dependence
on the Company's relationship with and the financial support provided by AICL
(see Note 11), reliance on a small group of principal customers, timing and
volume of orders relative to the Company's production capacity, availability of
manufacturing capacity and fluctuations in manufacturing yields, availability of
financing, competition, dependence on international operations and sales,
dependence on raw material and equipment suppliers, exchange rate fluctuations,
dependence on key personnel, difficulties in managing growth, enforcement of
intellectual property rights, environmental regulations and fluctuations in
quarterly operating results.
 
  Foreign Currency Translation
 
     Substantially all of the Company's foreign subsidiaries use the U.S. dollar
as their functional currency. Accordingly, monetary assets and liabilities which
were originally denominated in a foreign currency are translated into U.S.
dollars at month-end exchange rates. Non-monetary items which were originally
denominated in foreign currencies are translated at historical rates. Gains and
losses from such transactions and from transactions denominated in foreign
currencies are included in other (income) expense, net. The cumulative
translation adjustment reflected in stockholders' equity in the combined balance
sheets relates primarily to investments in unconsolidated companies which use
the local currency as the functional currency (see Note 6).
 
  Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
     The Company considers all highly liquid investments with a maturity of
three months or less when purchased to be cash equivalents.
 
  Accounts Receivable
 
     At December 31, 1997, trade accounts receivable represent the Company's
interest in receivables sold in excess of amounts purchased by banks under an
accounts receivable sale agreement (see Note 2). Of the total net trade accounts
receivable amount at December 31, 1997, $19,905 relates to the trade accounts
receivable of CIL which were not sold under the Agreement.
 
  Inventories
 
     Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market. Cost is determined
principally by using a moving average method.
 
                                       F-9
<PAGE>   114
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
  Property, Plant and Equipment
 
     Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost. Depreciation is
calculated by the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of
depreciable assets. Accelerated methods are used for tax purposes. Depreciable
lives follow:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>
Building and improvements.............................  10 to 30 years
Machinery and equipment...............................    3 to 5 years
Furniture, fixtures, and other equipment..............   3 to 10 years
</TABLE>
 
     Cost and accumulated depreciation for property retired or disposed of are
removed from the accounts and any resulting gain or loss is included in
earnings. Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are charged to expense as
incurred. Depreciation expense was $27,381, $58,497 and $81,159 for 1995, 1996
and 1997, respectively.
 
  Other Noncurrent Assets
 
     Other noncurrent assets consist principally of security deposits, deferred
income taxes and the cash surrender value of life insurance policies.
 
  Other Noncurrent Liabilities
 
     Other noncurrent liabilities consist primarily of pension obligations and
noncurrent income taxes payable.
 
  Income Taxes
 
     The Company accounts for income taxes following the provisions of Statement
of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 109, "Accounting for Income Taxes,"
which requires the use of the liability method. If it is more likely than not
that some portion or all of a deferred tax asset will not be realized, a
valuation allowance is provided.
 
     The Company reports certain income and expense items for income tax
purposes on a basis different from that reflected in the accompanying combined
financial statements. The principal differences relate to the timing of the
recognition of accrued expenses which are not deductible for federal income tax
purposes until paid, the use of accelerated methods of depreciation for income
tax purposes and unrecognized foreign exchange gains and losses.
 
     AEI elected to be taxed as an S Corporation under the provisions of the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable state tax provisions. As a result,
AEI does not recognize U.S. federal corporate income taxes. Instead, the
stockholders of AEI are taxed on their proportionate share of AEI's taxable
income. Accordingly, no provision for U.S. federal income taxes was recorded for
AEI. Given the pending Offerings (see Note 16), for informational purposes, the
accompanying combined statements of income include an unaudited pro forma
adjustment to reflect income taxes which would have been recorded if AEI had not
been an S Corporation, based on the tax laws in effect during the respective
periods (see Note 17).
 
  Earnings Per Share
 
     The pro forma net income per common share was calculated by dividing the
pro forma net income by the weighted average number of shares outstanding for
the respective periods, adjusted for the effect of the Reorganization (see Note
16).
 
     In the fourth quarter of 1997, the Company adopted SFAS No. 128, "Earnings
Per Share," which requires dual presentation of basic and diluted earnings per
share on the face of the income statement. Basic
 
                                      F-10
<PAGE>   115
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
EPS is computed using only the weighted average number of common shares
outstanding for the period while diluted EPS is computed assuming conversion of
all dilutive securities, such as options. In accordance with the statement, all
prior period per share amounts have been revised to reflect the new
presentation. The Company's basic and diluted per share amounts are the same for
all periods presented. There have been no changes to historical per share
amounts.
 
  Revenue Recognition and Risk of Loss
 
     The Company records revenues upon shipment of packaged semiconductors to
its customers. The Company does not take ownership of customer-supplied
semiconductors. Title and risk of loss remains with the customer for these
materials at all times. Risk of loss for Amkor packaging costs passes upon
completion of the packaging process and shipment to the customer. Accordingly,
the cost of the customer-supplied materials is not included in the combined
statements of income.
 
  Research and Development Costs
 
     Research and development costs are charged to expense as incurred.
 
  Use of Estimates in the Preparation of Financial Statements
 
     The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles ("GAAP") requires management to make estimates
and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and
disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial
statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the
reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
  Recently Issued Accounting Standards
 
     In June 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued SFAS
No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive Income." This statement establishes standards
for reporting and display of income and its components in financial statements.
The Company will be required to adopt this statement in 1998.
 
     In June 1997, the FASB issued SFAS No. 131, "Disclosures about Segments of
an Enterprise and Related Information." Under this statement, reporting
standards were established for the way that public business enterprises report
information about operating segments in annual financial statements and selected
information about operating segments in interim financial reports issued to
shareholders. Generally, financial information is required to be reported on the
basis that it is used internally for evaluating segment performance and deciding
how to allocate resources to segments. This statement is effective for financial
statements for periods beginning after December 15, 1997. In the initial year of
application, comparative information for earlier years presented is to be
restated. This statement need not be applied to interim financial statements in
the initial year of its application, but comparative information for interim
periods in the initial year of application is to be reported in financial
statements for interim periods in the second year of application. The Company
will adopt this statement prospectively for the year ended December 31, 1998.
 
  Reclassifications
 
     Certain previously reported amounts have been reclassified to conform with
the current presentation.
 
 2. ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE SALE AGREEMENT
 
     Effective July 7, 1997, the Company entered into an agreement to sell
receivables (the "Agreement") with certain banks (the "Purchasers"). The
transaction qualifies as a sale under the provisions of SFAS
                                      F-11
<PAGE>   116
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
No. 125 "Accounting For Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and
Extinguishments of Liabilities." Under the Agreement, the Purchasers have
committed to purchase, with limited recourse, all right, title and interest in
selected accounts receivable of the Company, up to a maximum of $100,000. In
connection with the Agreement, the Company established a wholly owned,
bankruptcy remote subsidiary, Amkor Receivables Corp., to purchase accounts
receivable at a discount from the Company on a continuous basis, subject to
certain limitations as described in the Agreement. Amkor Receivables Corp.
simultaneously sells the accounts receivable at the same discount to the
Purchasers. AICL has guaranteed AEI's obligations under the Agreement (see Note
11). The Agreement is structured as a three year facility subject to annual
renewals based upon the mutual consent of the Company and purchasers. The first
such renewal date is June 18, 1998. The Company and AICL did not comply with
certain financial covenants under the Agreement as of December 31, 1997. The
Purchasers have agreed to waive compliance with these covenants through January
2, 1999. The Company applied approximately $83.4 million of the Receivables Sale
proceeds together with approximately $17 million of working capital to reduce
the Company's indebtedness to AUSA which amounts were advanced by AUSA to
entities controlled by members of James Kim's family.
 
     Proceeds from the sale of receivables were $84,400 in 1997. Losses on
receivables sold under the Agreement were approximately $2,414 in 1997 and are
included in other expense, net. As of December 31, 1997, approximately $6,300 is
included in current liabilities for amounts to be refunded to the Purchasers as
a result of a reduction in selected accounts receivable.
 
 3. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
 
     Property, plant and equipment consist of the following:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     DECEMBER 31,
                                                 --------------------
                                                   1996        1997
                                                 --------    --------
<S>                                              <C>         <C>
Land...........................................  $     --    $  2,346
Building and improvements......................    81,602     109,528
Machinery and equipment........................   333,188     448,032
Furniture, fixtures and other equipment........    31,330      33,050
Construction in progress.......................     5,240      31,964
                                                 --------    --------
                                                  451,360     624,920
Less -- Accumulated depreciation and
  amortization.................................   126,465     197,859
                                                 --------    --------
                                                 $324,895    $427,061
                                                 ========    ========
</TABLE>
 
 4. COMMON STOCK AND ADDITIONAL PAID-IN CAPITAL
 
     The common stock and additional paid-in-capital of the Company are
reflected at the original cost of the Amkor Companies. In connection with the
Reorganization, the Company authorized 500,000,000 shares of $.001 par value
common stock, of which 82,610,000 shares were issued to the stockholders of the
Amkor Companies in exchange for their interests in these Companies.
 
     In addition, the Company authorized 10,000,000 shares of $.001 par value
preferred stock, designated as Series A.
 
     Changes in the division equity account reflected in the combined statement
of stockholders' equity represent the net cash flows resulting from the
operations of the Chamterry semiconductor packaging and test business for the
periods indicated. Such cash flows have been presented as distributions or
capital contributions since these amounts were retained in Chamterry
Enterprises, Ltd. for the benefit of the owners.
 
                                      F-12
<PAGE>   117
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
 5. INVENTORIES
 
     Inventories consist of raw materials and purchased components which are
used in the semiconductor packaging process. The Company's inventories are
located at its facilities in the Philippines or at AICL on a consignment basis.
Components of inventories follow:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     DECEMBER 31,
                                                 --------------------
                                                   1996        1997
                                                 --------    --------
<S>                                              <C>         <C>
Raw materials and purchased components.........  $ 93,112    $105,748
Work-in-process................................     8,808      10,122
                                                 --------    --------
                                                 $101,920    $115,870
                                                 ========    ========
</TABLE>
 
 6. INVESTMENTS
 
     The Company's investments include investments in affiliated companies which
provide services to the Company (see Note 11) and certain other technology based
companies. Investments are summarized as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                      DECEMBER 31,
                                                   ------------------
                                                    1996       1997
                                                   -------    -------
<S>                                                <C>        <C>
Equity Investment in AICL (10.2% and 8.1% at
  December 31, 1996 and 1997, respectively)......  $31,154    $13,863
                                                   -------    -------
Other Equity Investments (20%-50% owned)
  Anam Semiconductor & Technology Co., Ltd.......   10,700         --
  Datacom International, Inc.....................    1,335         --
  Sunrise Capital Fund...........................    1,328         --
  Other..........................................    1,373        738
                                                   -------    -------
          Total other equity investments.........   14,736        738
                                                   -------    -------
Available for Sale (cost based investments)......   23,354      5,220
                                                   -------    -------
                                                   $69,244    $19,821
                                                   =======    =======
</TABLE>
 
     The Company had net unamortized investment costs in excess of the
proportionate share of the investee companies' net assets of approximately
$1,284 and $0 at December 31, 1996 and 1997, respectively.
 
     On August 1, 1997, the Company sold its equity investment in Anam
Semiconductor & Technology Co., Ltd. ("Anam S&T") and certain investments and
notes receivable from companies unrelated to the semiconductor packaging and
test business to AK Investments, Inc., an entity owned by James J. Kim, at cost
($49,740) and AK Investments, Inc. assumed $49,740 of the Company's long-term
borrowings from Anam USA, Inc. Management estimates that the fair value of these
investments and notes receivable approximated the carrying value at August 1,
1997. Subsequent to the sale on August 1, 1997 the Company loaned AK
Investments, Inc. $12,800 for the purchase of additional investments. The amount
outstanding on this loan at December 31, 1997 was $4,350.
 
     The Company's investment in AICL is accounted for using the equity method
of accounting. Although the Company does not own in excess of 20% of the
outstanding common stock of AICL, the Company through its common ownership with
the Kim family and entities controlled by the Kim family owns 40.7% of the
outstanding common stock of AICL and may exercise a significant influence over
AICL. Accordingly the Company applies the equity method based on its ownership
interest. A significant portion of the shares owned by the Kim family are
leveraged and as a result of this, or for other reasons, the family's ownership
could be substantially reduced.
 
                                      F-13
<PAGE>   118
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
     In 1997, the Company recognized a loss of $17,291, resulting principally
from the impairment of value of its investment in AICL as well as the current
year equity in income (loss) of AICL. The amount of the loss was determined
based upon the market value of the AICL shares on the Korean Stock Exchange on
February 16, 1998, the date that the Company sold its investment in AICL common
stock to AK Investments, Inc. In exchange for the shares, AK Investments, Inc.
assumed $13,863 of the Company's long-term borrowings from Anam USA, Inc.
 
     The Company is advised that AICL, as a public company in Korea, has
published its most recent consolidated financial statements as of December 31,
1997.
 
     The Korean economy is undergoing changes as evidenced by the agreement
between the Korean government and the International Monetary Fund. Among other
things, this agreement includes a restructuring plan of the banking industry as
a whole which will most likely have a material effect on AICL's operations. The
overall impact of these economic changes on AICL is uncertain at this time.
AICL's independent auditors' report indicates that the financial statements of
AICL have been prepared assuming that AICL will continue as a going concern. The
operations of AICL have been significantly affected, and will continue to be
affected for the foreseeable future, by Korea's unstable economy caused by
currency volatility and unstable finance markets in Korea. AICL has
traditionally operated with a significant amount of debt relative to its equity
and has a significant working capital deficit at December 31, 1997. Because of
Korea's unstable economy and AICL's dependence on debt financing, the report
indicates that there are significant uncertainties that may affect AICL's future
operations and its abilities to maintain or refinance certain debt obligations
as they mature, which raise substantial doubt regarding AICL's ability to
continue as a going concern. The ultimate outcome of these uncertainties cannot
be determined presently and AICL's financial statements do not include any
adjustments that might result from these uncertainties. AICL's plans to address
these matters are included in the notes to the AICL's financial statements.
 
     AICL's financial statements are prepared on the basis of Korean GAAP, which
differs from U.S. GAAP in certain significant respects. The Company's equity in
income (loss) of AICL is based upon the Korean GAAP information noted above and
the Company's estimate of significant U.S. GAAP adjustments. These adjustments
were not significant in 1995 and 1996. In 1997, AICL recognized a W349 billion
loss principally as a result of foreign exchange losses on U.S. dollar
denominated liabilities due to the significant depreciation of the won relative
to the U.S. dollar. For purposes of determining the Company's equity in income
(loss) of AICL under U.S. GAAP, losses on remeasuring U.S. dollar denominated
liabilities are not recognized as the U.S. dollar is the functional currency for
AICL. Such U.S. dollar denominated liabilities were W2,144 billion at December
31, 1997. Also, at December 31, 1997, the carrying value of the investment in
AICL, adjusted for the loss on the 1998 disposition discussed above, is less
than the Company's portion of AICL's net assets after consideration of the
estimated U.S. GAAP adjustments. The most significant such adjustment affecting
net assets is the remeasurement of property, plant and equipment to historical
costs as required as the U.S. dollar is the functional currency.
 
     The following summary of consolidated financial information pertaining to
AICL was derived from the consolidated financial statements referred to above.
All amounts are in millions of Korean Won:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  1995         1996          1997
                                               ----------   ----------    ----------
<S>                                            <C>          <C>           <C>
SUMMARY INCOME STATEMENT INFORMATION:
Sales........................................  W1,105,273   W1,338,718    W1,786,457
Net income (loss)............................      18,333       (9,385)     (348,729)
SUMMARY BALANCE SHEET INFORMATION:
Total assets.................................                2,225,288     3,936,030
Total liabilities............................                1,975,431     3,834,096
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-14
<PAGE>   119
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
 7. SHORT-TERM CREDIT FACILITIES
 
     At December 31, 1996 and 1997, short-term borrowings consisted of various
operating lines of credit and working capital facilities maintained by the
Company. These borrowings are secured by receivables, inventories or property.
These facilities, which are typically for one-year renewable terms, generally
bear interest at current market rates appropriate for the country in which the
borrowing is made (ranging from 7.2% to 13.0% at December 31, 1997). For 1996
and 1997, the weighted average interest rate on these borrowings was 7.8% and
8.6%, respectively. Included in cash and cash equivalents is $1,200 of
certificates of deposit pledged as collateral for certain of these lines. The
unused portion of lines of credit total $36,169 at December 31, 1997.
 
 8. DEBT
 
     Following is a summary of the Company's short-term borrowings and long-term
debt:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   DECEMBER 31,
                                                              ----------------------
                                                                1996         1997
                                                              ---------    ---------
<S>                                                           <C>          <C>
Short-term borrowings (see Note 7)..........................  $ 150,513    $ 187,659
Bank loan, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (6.78% at
  December 31, 1997), due October, 2000.....................     50,000       50,000
Bank loan, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (6.68% at
  December 31, 1997), due in installments beginning March,
  1998 through April, 2001..................................     71,250       71,250
Floating rate notes (FRNs), interest at LIBOR plus annual
  spread (7.38% at August 20, 1997, date of redemption).....     40,000           --
Bank debt, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (9.37% at
  December 31, 1997), due December, 2001....................     20,000       20,000
Bank debt, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (12.22% at
  December 31, 1997,) due October, 1998.....................      5,000        5,000
Bank debt, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (9.09% at
  December 31, 1997), due in installments with balance due
  September, 1999...........................................      4,000        3,500
Bank debt, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (11.88% at
  December 31, 1997), due in equal installments through
  January, 2001.............................................      5,926        5,502
Note payable, interest at prime (8.50% at December 31,
  1997), due in semiannual installments beginning November
  1999 through April, 2004..................................         --        9,530
Note payable, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (12.48%
  at December 31, 1997), due in installments with balance
  due November, 1999........................................     11,000        9,000
Other, primarily capital lease obligations and other debt...      1,568        2,810
                                                              ---------    ---------
                                                                359,257      364,251
Less -- Short-term borrowings and current portion of
  long-term debt............................................   (191,813)    (325,968)
                                                              ---------    ---------
                                                              $ 167,444    $  38,283
                                                              =========    =========
</TABLE>
 
     The Bank loans were obtained to finance the expansion of the Company's
factories in the Philippines. The Company has the option to prepay all or part
of the loans on any interest payment date. These Bank loans are unconditionally
and irrevocably guaranteed by AICL. The Bank loans contain provisions pertaining
to the maintenance of specified debt-to-equity ratios, restrictions with respect
to corporate reorganization, acquisition of capital stock or substantially all
of the assets of any other corporations and advances and dispositions of all
 
                                      F-15
<PAGE>   120
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
or a substantial portion of the borrower's assets, except in the ordinary course
of business. AAP has not been in compliance with covenants regarding the
maintenance of certain debt-to-equity ratios and advances to affiliates.
Consequently, amounts due under these agreements and certain other agreements
with cross-default clauses have been classified as current liabilities in the
accompanying combined balance sheet.
 
     Other bank debt instruments have interest rates based on Singapore
interbank rates and LIBOR plus an annual spread. The loans are secured by assets
of the Company and assets acquired through proceeds from the loans.
 
     Principal payments required under long-term debt borrowings at December 31,
1997 are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     AMOUNT
                                                    --------
<S>                                                 <C>
1998..............................................  $138,309
1999..............................................     9,153
2000..............................................     2,360
2001..............................................    22,003
2002..............................................     1,905
Thereafter........................................     2,862
                                                    --------
Total.............................................  $176,592
                                                    ========
</TABLE>
 
 9. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
 
  U.S. Pension Plans
 
     AEI has a defined contribution benefit plan covering substantially all U.S.
employees under which AEI matches 75% of the employee's contributions of between
6% and 10% of salary, up to a defined maximum on an annual basis. The pension
expense for this plan was $483, $776 and $959 in 1995, 1996 and 1997,
respectively. The pension plan assets are invested primarily in equity and fixed
income securities.
 
  Philippine Pension Plans
 
     AAAP, AAP and AMI sponsor several defined benefit plans that cover
substantially all employees who are not covered by statutory plans. Charges to
expense are based upon costs computed by independent actuaries.
 
     The components of net periodic pension cost for the defined benefit plans
are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                   --------------------------
                                                    1995      1996      1997
                                                   ------    ------    ------
<S>                                                <C>       <C>       <C>
Service cost of current period...................  $  974    $1,542    $1,274
Interest cost on projected benefit obligation....     811     1,228       957
Actual return on plan assets.....................    (609)     (677)     (585)
Net amortization and deferrals...................     100        98       132
                                                   ------    ------    ------
          Total pension expense..................  $1,276    $2,191    $1,778
                                                   ======    ======    ======
</TABLE>
 
     It is the Company's policy to make contributions sufficient to meet the
minimum contributions required by law and regulation.
 
                                      F-16
<PAGE>   121
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
     The following table sets forth the funded status and the amounts recognized
in the combined balance sheets for the defined benefit pension plans:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            1996       1997
                                                           -------    -------
<S>                                                        <C>        <C>
Actuarial present value of:
  Vested benefit obligation..............................  $ 1,696    $ 1,546
                                                           =======    =======
  Accumulated benefit obligation.........................  $ 2,848    $ 2,669
                                                           =======    =======
Actuarial present value of projected benefit
  obligation.............................................  $12,699     10,428
Plan assets at fair value................................    6,077      6,614
                                                           -------    -------
Plan assets less than projected benefit obligation.......   (6,622)    (3,814)
Prior service cost.......................................    1,125        967
Unrecognized net loss....................................    1,800        953
                                                           -------    -------
Accrued pension cost.....................................  $(3,697)   $(1,894)
                                                           =======    =======
</TABLE>
 
     The weighted average interest rate used in determining the projected
benefit obligation was 12% as of December 31, 1996 and 1997. The rates of
increase in future compensation levels was 11% as of December 31, 1996 and 1997.
The expected long-term rate of return on plan assets was 12% as of December 31,
1996 and 1997.
 
10. INCOME TAXES
 
     The provision for income taxes includes federal, state and foreign taxes
currently payable and those deferred because of temporary differences between
the financial statement and the tax bases of assets and liabilities. The
components of the provision for income taxes follow:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                  ---------------------------------
                                                    1995        1996        1997
                                                  --------    --------    ---------
<S>                                               <C>         <C>         <C>
Current:
  Federal.......................................   $6,125      $5,880      $16,126
  State.........................................      908          60        2,639
  Foreign.......................................      498       2,260           28
                                                   ------      ------      -------
                                                    7,531       8,200       18,793
                                                   ------      ------      -------
Deferred:
  Federal.......................................     (173)       (226)      (4,991)
  Foreign.......................................     (974)        (98)      (6,724)
                                                   ------      ------      -------
                                                   (1,147)       (324)     (11,715)
                                                   ------      ------      -------
          Total provision.......................   $6,384      $7,876      $ 7,078
                                                   ======      ======      =======
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-17
<PAGE>   122
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
     The reconciliation between the tax payable based upon the U.S. federal
statutory income tax rate and the recorded provision follow:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                              -------------------------------
                                                1995       1996        1997
                                              --------    -------    --------
<S>                                           <C>         <C>        <C>
Federal statutory rate......................  $ 23,458    $15,054    $ 21,352
State taxes, net of federal benefit.........       908         60       1,285
S Corp. status of AEI.......................   (10,400)    (2,900)     (3,613)
(Income) losses of foreign subsidiaries
  subject to tax holiday....................        --      4,957      (5,106)
Foreign exchange losses recognized for
  income taxes..............................    (1,649)        --     (21,147)
Valuation allowance.........................                           22,000
Difference in rates on foreign
  subsidiaries..............................    (5,933)    (9,295)     (7,693)
                                              --------    -------    --------
          Total.............................  $  6,384    $ 7,876    $  7,078
                                              ========    =======    ========
</TABLE>
 
     The Company has structured its global operations to take advantage of lower
tax rates in certain countries and tax incentives extended to encourage
investment. AAP had a tax holiday in the Philippines which expired in 1995. AAAP
has a tax holiday in the Philippines which expires at the end of 2002. Foreign
exchange losses recognized for income taxes relate to unrecognized net foreign
exchange losses on U.S. dollar denominated monetary assets and liabilities.
These losses, which are not recognized for financial reporting purposes as the
U.S. dollar is the functional currency (see Note 1), result in deferred tax
assets that will be realized, for Philippine tax reporting purposes, upon
settlement of the related asset or liability. The deferred tax asset related to
these losses increased in 1997 as a result of the dramatic devaluation of the
Philippine peso relative to the U.S. dollar. The Company's ability to utilize
these assets depends on the timing of the settlement of the related assets or
liabilities and the amount of taxable income recognized within the Philippine
statutory carryforward limit of three years. Accordingly, a valuation allowance
has been established in 1997 for a portion of the related deferred tax assets.
 
     The following is a summary of the significant components of the Company's
deferred tax assets and liabilities:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              DECEMBER 31,
                                                           ------------------
                                                            1996       1997
                                                           ------    --------
<S>                                                        <C>       <C>
Deferred tax assets (liabilities):
  Retirement benefits....................................  $  888    $    816
  Receivables............................................     344         227
  Inventories............................................   1,057       6,509
  Unrealized foreign exchange losses.....................     398      37,447
  Unrealized foreign exchange gains......................    (614)     (9,084)
  Other..................................................     225          98
                                                           ------    --------
  Net deferred tax asset.................................   2,298      36,013
  Valuation allowance....................................      --     (22,000)
                                                           ------    --------
  Net deferred tax asset.................................  $2,298    $ 14,013
                                                           ======    ========
</TABLE>
 
     Non-U.S. income before taxes and minority interest of the Company was
$23,800, $20,420 and $32,920 in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively.
 
                                      F-18
<PAGE>   123
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
     At December 31, 1996 and 1997 current deferred tax assets of $1,919 and
$13,439, respectively, are included in other current assets and noncurrent
deferred tax assets of $379 and $574, respectively, are included in other assets
in the combined balance sheet. The Company's net deferred tax assets include
amounts which management believes are realizable through future taxable income.
 
     The Company's tax returns have been examined through 1993 in the
Philippines and through 1994 in the U.S. The recorded provision for open years
is subject to changes upon final examination of these tax returns. Changes in
the mix of income from the Company's foreign subsidiaries, expiration of tax
holidays and changes in tax laws or regulations could result in increased
effective tax rates for the Company.
 
     At December 31, 1997, the financial reporting basis of AEI's net assets
were greater than the tax basis of the net assets by approximately $5,200. In
connection with the Offerings, the Company and the stockholders of AEI will
enter into a Tax Indemnification Agreement providing that the Company and AEI
will be indemnified by such stockholders, with respect to their proportionate
share of any federal or state corporate income taxes attributable to the failure
of AEI to qualify as an S Corporation for any period or in any jurisdiction for
which S Corporation status was claimed through the date AEI terminates its S
Corporation status. The Tax Indemnification Agreement will also provide that the
Company and AEI will indemnify the stockholders if such stockholders are
required to include in income additional amounts attributable to taxable years
on or before the date AEI terminates its S Corporation status as to which AEI
filed or files tax returns claiming status as an S Corporation.
 
11. RELATED-PARTY TRANSACTIONS
 
     At December 31, 1997, the Company owned 8.1% of the outstanding stock of
AICL (see Note 6), and AICL owned 40% of AAP. After the Offerings (see Note 16)
the Company intends to purchase AICL's interest in AAP for approximately
$34,000. In 1996 and 1997, approximately 72% and 68%, respectively, of the
Company's net revenues (see Note 1) were derived from services performed for the
Company by AICL, a Korean public company in which the Company and certain of the
Company's principal stockholders hold a minority interest. By the terms of a
long-standing agreement, the Company has been responsible for marketing and
selling AICL's semiconductor packaging and test services, except to customers in
Korea and certain customers in Japan to whom AICL has historically sold such
services directly. The Company has worked closely with AICL in developing new
technologies and products. The Company has recently entered into five-year
supply agreements with AICL giving the Company the first right to market and
sell substantially all of AICL's packaging and test services and the exclusive
right to market and sell all of the wafer output of AICL's new wafer foundry.
The Company's business, financial condition and operating results have been and
will continue to be significantly dependent on the ability of AICL to
effectively provide the contracted services on a cost-efficient and timely
basis. The termination of the Company's relationship with AICL for any reason,
or any material adverse change in AICL's business resulting from
underutilization of its capacity, the level of its debt and its guarantees of
affiliate debt, labor disruptions, fluctuations in foreign exchange rates,
changes in governmental policies, economic or political conditions in Korea or
any other change could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations.
 
     The Company has obtained a significant portion of its financing from
financing arrangements provided by Anam USA, Inc. ("AUSA"), AICL's wholly-owned
financing subsidiary. A majority of the amount due to AUSA represents
outstanding amounts under financing obtained by AUSA for the benefit of the
Company with the balance representing payables to AUSA for packaging and service
charges paid to AICL. Based on guarantees provided by AICL, AUSA obtains for the
benefit of the Company a continuous series of short-term financing arrangements
which generally are less than six months in duration, and typically are less
than two months in duration. Because of the short-term nature of these loans,
the flows of cash to and from AUSA under this arrangement are significant.
Purchases from AICL through AUSA were $354,062, $460,282 and
 
                                      F-19
<PAGE>   124
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
$527,858 for 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. Charges from AUSA for interest
and bank charges were $4,484, $7,074 and $6,002 for 1995, 1996 and 1997,
respectively. Amounts payable to AICL and AUSA were $252,221, and $156,350 at
December 31, 1996 and 1997, respectively.
 
     AICL's ability to continue to provide services to the Company will depend
on AICL's financial condition and performance. AICL currently has a significant
amount of debt relative to its equity, which debt the Company expects will
continue to increase in the foreseeable future. The Company is advised that
AICL, as a public company in Korea, has published its most recent annual
consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 1997. These consolidated
financial statements are prepared on the basis of Korean GAAP, which differs
from U.S. GAAP. U.S. GAAP financial statements are not available (See Note 6).
As of December 31, 1997, AICL, on a consolidated basis, had current liabilities
of approximately W2,124 billion, including approximately W1,721 billion of
short-term borrowings and approximately W121 billion of current maturities of
long-term debt, and had long-term liabilities of approximately W1,710 billion,
including approximately W737 billion of long-term debt and approximately W862
billion of long-term capital lease obligations. As of such date, the total
shareholders' equity of AICL amounted to approximately W77 billion. The
deterioration of the Korean economy in recent months and the resulting liquidity
crisis in Korea have led to sharply higher domestic interest rates and reduced
opportunities for refinancing or refunding maturing debts as financial
institutions in Korea, which are experiencing financial difficulties, are
increasingly looking to limit their lending, particularly to highly leveraged
companies, and to increase their reserves and provisions for non-performing
assets. Therefore, there can be no assurance that AICL will be able to refinance
its existing loans or obtain new loans, or continue to make required interest
and principal payments on such loans or otherwise comply with the terms of its
loan agreements. Any inability of AICL to obtain financing or generate cash flow
from operations sufficient to fund its capital expenditure, debt service and
repayment and other working capital and liquidity requirements could have a
material adverse effect on AICL's ability to continue to provide services and
otherwise fulfill its obligations to the Company.
 
     As of December 31, 1997, AICL and its consolidated subsidiaries were
contingently liable under guarantees in respect of debt of its non-consolidated
subsidiaries and affiliates in the aggregate amount of approximately W857
billion. As of December 31, 1997, such guarantees included those in respect of
all of AUSA's debt totaling $319,200, $176,250 of the Company's debt to banks
and the Company's obligations under a receivables sales arrangement (see Note
2). The Company has met a significant portion of its financing needs through
financing arrangements obtained by AUSA for the benefit of the Company based on
guarantees provided by AICL. There can be no assurance that AUSA will be able to
obtain additional guarantees, if necessary, from AICL. Further, a deterioration
in AICL's financial condition could trigger defaults under AICL's guarantees,
causing acceleration of such loans. In addition, as an overseas subsidiary of
AICL, AUSA was formed with the approval of the Bank of Korea. If the Bank of
Korea were to withdraw such approval, or if AUSA otherwise ceased operations for
any reason, the Company and AICL would be required to meet their financing needs
through alternative arrangements. There can be no assurance that the Company or
AICL will be able to obtain alternative financing on acceptable terms or at all.
In addition, if any relevant subsidiaries or affiliates of AICL were to fail to
make interest or principal payments or otherwise default under their debt
obligations guaranteed by AICL, AICL could be required under its guarantees to
repay such debt, which event could have a material adverse effect on its
financial condition and results of operations.
 
     Anam Engineering and Construction, an affiliate of AICL, built the
packaging facility for AAAP in the Philippines. Payments to Anam Engineering and
Construction were $22,167 and $3,844 in 1996 and 1997, respectively. Anam
Precision Equipment and Anam Instruments manufacture certain equipment used by
the Philippine operations. Payments to Anam Precision Equipment and Anam
Instruments were $6,652 and $4,211 in 1996 and 1997, respectively. The Company
purchases direct materials from Anam S&T. Payments to Anam S&T were
approximately $16,400, $27,300 and $26,000 during 1995, 1996 and 1997,
respectively.
                                      F-20
<PAGE>   125
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
     During 1996, the Company extended guarantees on behalf of an affiliate to
vendors used by this affiliate. Outstanding guarantees as of December 31, 1996
and 1997 were $25,100 and $24,655 respectively. Amounts guaranteed under this
agreement fluctuate due to the cyclical nature of the affiliate's retail
business. Balances guaranteed at December 31 are generally the largest.
 
     The Company has executed a surety and guarantee agreement on behalf of an
affiliate. The Company has unconditionally guaranteed the affiliate's obligation
under a $17,000 line of credit and a $9,000 term loan note. As of December 31,
1997, there was $750 outstanding under the line of credit and $9,000 outstanding
under the term loan note. The Company has also unconditionally guaranteed
another affiliate's obligation under a $4,000 term loan agreement and a $1,000
line of credit. As of December 31, 1997, there was $3,800 outstanding under the
term loan and no amounts outstanding under the line of credit.
 
     A principal stockholder of the Company has extended guarantees on behalf of
the Company in the amount of $87,000 at December 31, 1997. Also in 1997, a
company controlled by this stockholder purchased investments in the amount of
$49,740 (see Note 6).
 
     The Company leases office space in West Chester, PA from certain
stockholders of the Company. The lease expires in 2006. The Company has the
option to extend the lease for an additional 10 years through 2016. On September
11, 1997, the office previously being leased in Chandler, Arizona was purchased
from certain stockholders of the Company. The total purchase price of the
building ($5,710) represents the carrying value to the stockholders. Amounts
paid for these leases in 1996 and 1997 were $1,343 and $1,458, respectively.
 
     At December 31, 1996 and 1997, the Company had advances and notes
receivable from affiliates other than AICL and AUSA of $22,988 and $36,501,
respectively. Realization of these notes is dependent upon the ability of the
affiliates to repay the notes. In management's opinion, these receivables are
recorded at the net realizable value.
 
12. FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
 
     The estimated fair value of financial instruments has been determined by
the Company using available market information and appropriate methodologies;
however, considerable judgment is required in interpreting market data to
develop the estimates for fair value. Accordingly, these estimates are not
necessarily indicative of the amounts that the Company could realize in a
current market exchange. Certain of these financial instruments are with major
financial institutions and expose the Company to market and credit risks and may
at times be concentrated with certain counterparties or groups of
counterparties. The creditworthiness of counterparties is continually reviewed,
and full performance is anticipated.
 
     The methods and assumptions used to estimate the fair value of significant
classes of financial instruments is set forth below:
 
     Available for sale investments. The fair value of these financial
instruments was estimated based on market quotes, recent offerings of similar
securities, current and projected financial performance of the company and net
asset positions.
 
     Short-term borrowings. Short-term borrowings have variable rates that
reflect currently available terms and conditions for similar borrowings. The
carrying amount of this debt is a reasonable estimate of fair value.
 
     Long-term debt and due to affiliates. Long-term debt and due to affiliates
have variable rates that reflect currently available terms and conditions for
similar debt. The carrying amount of this debt is a reasonable estimate of fair
value.
 
                                      F-21
<PAGE>   126
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
13. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
     The Company is involved in various claims incidental to the conduct of its
business. Based on consultation with legal counsel, management does not believe
that any claims to which the Company is a party will have a material adverse
effect on the Company's financial condition or results of operations.
 
     Future minimum lease payments under operating leases that have initial or
remaining noncancelable lease terms in excess of one year at December 31, 1997,
are:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                  <C>
1998...............................................  $ 7,805
1999...............................................    7,230
2000...............................................    6,463
2001...............................................    5,689
2002...............................................    2,338
Thereafter.........................................   36,404
                                                     -------
          Total....................................  $65,929
                                                     =======
</TABLE>
 
     Rent expense amounted to $3,692, $5,520 and $6,709 for 1995, 1996 and 1997,
respectively.
 
     The Company has various purchase commitments for materials, supplies and
capital equipment incidental to the ordinary conduct of business. As of December
31, 1997 the Company had commitments for capital equipment of approximately
$27,000. In the aggregate, such commitments are not at prices in excess of
current market.
 
14. ACQUISITION OF AMKOR ANAM TEST SERVICES, INC.
 
     On September 30, 1996, AEI and a principal stockholder each acquired 50% of
the outstanding common stock of Amkor Anam Test Services, Inc. (AATS), formerly
Navell Test Consultants, Inc., a provider of test engineering services for the
semiconductor industry located in San Jose, California, for approximately
$2,860. Subsequent to September 30, 1996, AEI purchased the 50% interest owned
by a principal stockholder at the stockholder's original cost. The acquisition
was accounted for using the purchase method of accounting and the results of
AATS' operations are included in the Company's combined statements of income
effective October 1, 1996. Accordingly, the total purchase price has been
allocated to the combined assets and liabilities based upon their estimated
respective fair values. This acquisition resulted in goodwill of approximately
$2,356, which is being amortized over 20 years.
 
                                      F-22
<PAGE>   127
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
15. BUSINESS SEGMENT AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION
 
     The Company is primarily engaged in one industry segment, namely, the
packaging and testing of integrated circuits. Financial information, summarized
by geographic area, is as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                    UNITED
                                    STATES       EUROPE     PHILIPPINES    ELIMINATIONS     COMBINED
                                  ----------    --------    -----------    ------------    ----------
<S>                               <C>           <C>         <C>            <C>             <C>
Year ended December 31, 1997:
  Net revenues from unaffiliated
     customers..................  $1,258,110    $197,651     $     --       $      --      $1,455,761
  Net revenues from
     affiliates.................          --          --      256,895        (256,895)             --
                                  ----------    --------     --------       ---------      ----------
  Total net revenues............   1,258,110     197,651      256,895        (256,895)      1,455,761
  Income before income taxes and
     minority interest..........      28,086      23,522        9,398              --          61,006
  Identifiable assets...........     352,503      21,873      506,397        (176,134)        704,639
  Corporate assets..............                                                              146,299
                                                                                           ----------
          Total assets..........                                                           $  850,938
                                                                                           ==========
Year ended December 31, 1996:
  Net revenues from unaffiliated
     customers..................  $1,013,182    $157,819     $     --       $      --      $1,171,001
  Net revenues from
     affiliates.................          --          --      198,637        (198,637)             --
                                  ----------    --------     --------       ---------      ----------
  Total net revenues............   1,013,182     157,819      198,637        (198,637)      1,171,001
  Income before income taxes and
     minority interest..........      22,592      12,473        7,947              --          43,012
  Identifiable assets...........     245,781      19,422      424,653         (91,552)        598,304
  Corporate assets..............                                                              199,309
                                                                                           ----------
          Total assets..........                                                           $  797,613
                                                                                           ==========
Year ended December 31, 1995:
  Net revenues from unaffiliated
     customers..................  $  792,285    $140,097     $     --       $      --      $  932,382
  Net revenues from
     affiliates.................          --          --      128,164        (128,164)             --
                                  ----------    --------     --------       ---------      ----------
  Total net revenues............     792,285     140,097      128,164        (128,164)        932,382
  Income before income taxes and
     minority interest..........      43,223      13,019       10,781              --          67,023
  Identifiable assets...........     235,707      18,699      270,185        (100,385)        424,206
  Corporate assets..............                                                              211,662
                                                                                           ----------
          Total assets..........                                                           $  635,868
                                                                                           ==========
</TABLE>
 
     Sales between affiliates are priced at customer selling price less material
costs provided by the segment, less a sales commission. Net revenues from
unaffiliated customers for the United States include $109,532, $160,507 and
$208,062 of revenues from unaffiliated foreign customers for 1995, 1996 and
1997, respectively. Identifiable assets are those assets that can be directly
associated with a particular geographic area. Corporate assets are those assets
which are not directly associated with a particular geographic area and consist
primarily of cash and cash equivalents, investments and advances or loans to
another geographic segment.
 
                                      F-23
<PAGE>   128
                 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC.
 
               NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
             (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
 
16. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS
 
     On April 14, 1998, Mr. and Mrs. James Kim and the Kim Family Trusts
exchanged their interests in AEI for 9,746,766 shares and 4,873,383 shares of
ATI common stock, respectively. On April 29, 1998 ATI issued 67,989,851 shares
of common stock in exchange for all of the outstanding shares of AIH and its
subsidiaries. Of such shares, 19,328,234 shares, 36,376,617 shares and 8,200,000
shares were gifted to Mr. and Mrs. James Kim, the Kim Family Trusts and other
members of Mr. Kim's immediate family, respectively. In addition, ATI acquired
all of the stock of AKI from the Kim Family Trusts for $3,000.
 
     Except for the acquisition of the shares of AKI which has been accounted
for as a purchase transaction, the Reorganization described above is treated
similar to a pooling of interests as it represents an exchange of equity
interests among companies under common control. The purchase price for the AKI
stock, which represents the fair value of these shares, approximates the book
value of AKI. ATI filed an amended registration statement on April 29, 1998 with
the Securities and Exchange Commission as part of a proposed plan to reduce
outstanding borrowings and to increase the stockholders' equity. ATI intends to
raise approximately $449,950 (after deducting the underwriting discount and
estimated offering expenses) from the sale of shares of common stock and
convertible notes (the "Offerings"). The convertible notes will be 1)
convertible into ATI common stock at a premium over the initial public offering
price; 2) callable in certain circumstances after three years; 3) unsecured and
subordinate to senior debt; 4) carry a coupon rate of approximately 5 3/4%; and
5) have a maturity of five years. Approximately $225,000 of the proceeds will be
used to reduce short-term and long-term borrowings. Approximately $105,000 of
the proceeds will be used to reduce amounts due to AUSA. In connection with the
Offerings, certain existing stockholders intend to sell approximately 5,000,000
of their shares.
 
     The Company established stock option plans in 1998 pursuant to which
6,550,000 shares of common stock were reserved for future issuance upon the
exercise of stock options granted to employees, consultants and directors. The
options will be issued at fair value and generally will vest over five years.
 
     After the Offerings, the Company intends to purchase AICL's 40% interest in
AAP for approximately $34,000. The Company will account for this transaction as
a purchase which will result in the elimination of the minority interest
liability reflected on the combined balance sheet and result in additional
amortization of approximately $2,500 per year.
 
17. PRO FORMA ADJUSTMENTS
 
  Statement of Income
 
     Pro forma adjustments are presented to reflect a provision for income taxes
as if AEI had not been an S Corporation for all of the periods presented. Pro
forma net income per common share is based on the weighted average number of
shares outstanding as if the Exchange had occurred at the beginning of the
period presented.
 
  Balance Sheet
 
     As discussed in Note 1, the Company reorganized prior to the effective date
of the contemplated offering. AEI terminated its S Corporation status at which
time additional deferred tax liabilities of $2,100 were recorded for existing
temporary differences between the book and tax bases of assets and liabilities.
If the termination of AEI's S Corporation status would have occurred on December
31, 1997, AEI would have declared a distribution of $27,700 of previously taxed
income. The pro forma balance sheet is presented to reflect these changes as if
they occurred on December 31, 1997.
 
                                      F-24
<PAGE>   129
 
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
 
To the Shareholders and
  Board of Directors
Anam Industrial Co., Ltd.
 
     We have audited the consolidated balance sheets of Anam Industrial Co.,
Ltd. and its subsidiaries (the "Company") as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, and
the related consolidated statements of operations, capital surplus and retained
earnings (accumulated deficit), and cash flows for each of the three years in
the period ended December 31, 1997 (which financial statements are prepared
under generally accepted accounting principles in the Republic of Korea and are
not included in this Registration Statement). These financial statements are the
responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We did not audit the
financial statements of Anam USA, Inc. ("Anam USA"), a wholly owned subsidiary,
and Anam Engineering and Construction Co., Ltd. ("Anam Construction"), a 59.6%
owned subsidiary, which statements reflect total assets of W913,721 million and
W660,729 million as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively, and total net
income (loss) of W(10,011) million in 1997, W5,738 million in 1996 and W(2,925)
million in 1995. Additionally, we did not audit the financial statements of
Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. ("AAPI"), a 40% owned affiliate, the investment in
which is reflected in the accompanying financial statements using the equity
method of accounting. The Company's investment in AAPI was W38,612 million and
W19,077 million as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively, and the equity
in its net income (loss) was W(44,491) million in 1997, W2,050 million in 1996
and W(1,570) million in 1995. The aforementioned financial statements were
audited by other auditors whose reports have been furnished to us, and our
opinion, insofar as it relates to the amounts included for Anam USA, Anam
Construction and AAPI, is based solely on the reports of the other auditors. The
auditors of Anam Construction and AAPI expressed uncertainties in their audit
reports about the respective companies' ability to continue as a going concern.
 
     We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards in the Republic of Korea, which are substantially the same as those
followed in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan
and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial
statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a
test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial
statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and
significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits and the reports of
other auditors provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
     In our opinion, based on our audits and the reports of other auditors, the
consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all
material respects, the financial position of Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. and its
subsidiaries as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, and the results of their
operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended
December 31, 1997, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles
in the Republic of Korea.
 
     As discussed in Note 2 to the financial statements, in accordance with
revised Financial Accounting Standards in the Republic of Korea effective in
1997 and 1996, respectively, the Company changed its method of accounting for
unrealized foreign currency translation gains or losses on long-term assets and
liabilities denominated in foreign currencies. In 1997, such gains or losses are
deferred and amortized over the lives or maturities of corresponding assets and
liabilities using the straight-line method. In 1996, such gains or losses had
been recorded as a capital adjustment to shareholders' equity. Prior to 1996,
such gains or losses had been recognized currently.
 
     The financial statements referred to above have been prepared assuming that
the Company will continue as a going concern. As discussed in Note 3 to the
financial statements, the operations of the Company have been significantly
affected, and will continue to be affected for the foreseeable future, by
Korea's unstable economy caused by currency volatility and unstable finance
markets in Korea. The Company has traditionally operated with a significant
amount of debt relative to its equity and has a significant working capital
deficit at
 
                                      F-25
<PAGE>   130
 
December 31, 1997. Because of Korea's unstable economy and the Company's
dependence on debt financing, there are significant uncertainties that may
affect the Company's future operations and its ability to maintain or refinance
certain debt obligations as they mature, which raise substantial doubt regarding
the Company's ability to continue as a going concern. The ultimate outcome of
these uncertainties cannot be determined presently and the financial statements
do not include any adjustments that might result from these uncertainties.
Management's plans to address these matters are also included in Note 3.
 
                                          SAMIL ACCOUNTING CORPORATION
 
Seoul, Korea
March 20, 1998
 
                                      F-26
<PAGE>   131
 
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
 
To the Board of Directors and Stockholders
Anam Engineering & Construction Co., Ltd.
 
     We have audited the balance sheets of Anam Engineering & Construction Co.,
Ltd. (the Company) as of December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, and the related
statements of operations and accumulated deficit and cash flows for the years
then ended (not included in this Prospectus or elsewhere in this Registration
Statement). These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's
management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial
statements based on our audits.
 
     We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards in the Republic of Korea which are substantially the same as those
followed in the United States. Those standards require that we plan and perform
the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements
are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis,
evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An
audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant
estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial
statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis
for our opinion.
 
     In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly,
in all material respects, the financial position of Anam Engineering &
Construction Co., Ltd. as of December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, and the results
of its operations and the changes in its accumulated deficit and its cash flows
for the years then ended, in conformity with generally accepted financial
accounting standards in the Republic of Korea.
 
     The financial statements referred to above have been prepared assuming that
the Company will continue as a going concern. As discussed in Note 20 to the
financial statements, the operations of the Company have been significantly
affected, and will continue to be affected for the foreseeable future, by
Korea's unstable economy caused by the currency volatility and unstable
financial markets in Korea. The Company has traditionally operated with a
significant amount of debt relative to its equity. Because of Korea's unstable
economy and the Company's dependence on debt financing, there are significant
uncertainties that may affect the Company's future operations and its abilities
to maintain or regarding the Company's ability to continue as a going concern.
The ultimate outcome of these uncertainties cannot be determined presently and
financial statements do not include adjustments that might result from these
uncertainties.
 
     As discussed in Note 17 to the financial statements, the Company executed a
merger in which the operations of Hanyong Corporation were combined with the
Company as of July 31, 1997. This merger was accounted for as a transfer of
assets and liabilities under common control at historical costs in a manner
similar to a pooling of interest of U.S. GAAP reporting purposes.
 
     As discussed in Note 14 to financial statements, the Company sells its
product to Anam Semiconductor Inc. (Anam Industrial Co., Ltd.) and other
affiliated companies. The amounts of sales are W244,013 million, W313,894
million and W47,109 million during the year ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and
1995, and balances of account receivable are W31,844 million, W53,816 million
and W79,316 million at December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995 respectively and
balances of account payable are W4,834 million, W122 million and W403 million at
December 31 of 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively.
 
     The amounts expressed in U.S. Dollars, presented solely for the convenience
of the reader, have been translated on the basis set forth in Note 3 to
financial statements.
 
                                          Chong Un & Company
 
Seoul, Korea
March 4, 1998
 
                                      F-27
<PAGE>   132
 
                    REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
The Stockholders and the Board of Directors
Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc.
NSC Compound, Km. 22 East Service Road
South Superhighway, Muntinlupa City
 
     We have audited the consolidated balance sheets of Amkor/Anam Pilipinas,
Inc. and Subsidiary as of December 31, 1997 and December 29, 1996, and the
related consolidated statements of income and retained earnings (deficit) and
cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997
(not included in this Prospectus or elsewhere in this Registration Statement).
These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management.
Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based
on our audits.
 
     We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan
and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial
statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a
test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial
statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and
significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a
reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
     In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above
present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Amkor/Anam
Pilipinas, Inc. and Subsidiary as of December 31, 1997 and December 29, 1996,
and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the three years in
the period ended December 31, 1997, in conformity with generally accepted
accounting principles in the Philippines.
 
     The consolidated financial statements have been prepared assuming that the
Company will continue as a going concern. As discussed in Note 1 to the
consolidated financial statements, the Company, is not in compliance with
certain debt agreements and has a net working capital deficiency at December 31,
1997. These matters raise substantial doubt about the Company's ability to
continue as a going concern. Management's plans in regard to this matter are
also described in Note 1. The consolidated financial statements do not include
any adjustments that might result from the outcome of this uncertainty.
 
                                          SyCip Gorres Velayo & Co
 
January 30, 1998
Makati City, Philippines
 
                                      F-28
<PAGE>   133
 
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
 
To the Board of Directors
Anam USA, Inc.
West Chester, Pennsylvania
 
     We have audited the balance sheets of Anam USA, Inc. (a Pennsylvania
Corporation and a wholly-owned subsidiary of Anam Industrial Co., Ltd., Seoul,
ROK) as of December 31, 1997 and 1996 and the related statements of income,
stockholder's equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period
ended December 31, 1997. These financial statements are the responsibility of
the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these
financial statements based on our audits.
 
     We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
     In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly,
in all material respects, the financial position of Anam USA, Inc. as of
December 31, 1997 and 1996 and the results of its operations and its cash flows
for the years then ended in conformity with generally accepted accounting
principles.
 
                                          SIANA CARR & O'CONNOR, LLP
 
Paoli, Pennsylvania
February 13, 1998
 
                                      F-29
<PAGE>   134
 
======================================================
 
NO DEALER, SALESPERSON OR ANY OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY
INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS
PROSPECTUS IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFER MADE BY THIS PROSPECTUS AND, IF GIVEN OR
MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN
AUTHORIZED BY THE COMPANY, THE SELLING STOCKHOLDER OR ANY OF THE UNDERWRITERS.
NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF THIS PROSPECTUS NOR ANY SALE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL, UNDER
ANY CIRCUMSTANCES, CREATE ANY IMPLICATION THAT THERE HAS BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE
AFFAIRS OF THE COMPANY SINCE THE DATES AS OF WHICH THE INFORMATION IS GIVEN IN
THIS PROSPECTUS. THIS PROSPECTUS DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER OR SOLICITATION BY
ANYONE IN ANY JURISDICTION IN WHICH SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT AUTHORIZED
OR IN WHICH THE PERSON MAKING SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT QUALIFIED TO DO
SO OR TO ANY PERSON TO WHOM IT IS UNLAWFUL TO MAKE SUCH SOLICITATION.
 
                               ------------------
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                         PAGE
                                         ----
<S>                                      <C>
Prospectus Summary.....................    3
Risk Factors...........................    9
Reorganization.........................   26
Relationship with AICL.................   28
Use of Proceeds........................   33
Dividend Policy........................   33
Capitalization.........................   34
Dilution...............................   36
Selected Combined Financial Data.......   37
Management's Discussion and Analysis of
  Financial Condition and Results of
  Operations...........................   39
Business...............................   49
Management.............................   64
Certain Transactions...................   70
Principal and Selling Stockholders.....   73
Description of Capital Stock...........   74
Description of Convertible Notes.......   76
Shares Eligible for Future Sale........   90
Certain United States Federal Tax
  Consequences to Holders of Common
  Stock and Convertible Notes..........   92
Underwriting...........................   97
Legal Matters..........................  101
Experts................................  101
Additional Information.................  102
Glossary...............................  103
Index to Combined Financial
  Statements...........................  F-1
</TABLE>
 
                               ------------------
 
Until May 25, 1998 (25 days after the commencement of the Offerings), all
dealers effecting transactions in the Common Stock and Convertible Notes,
whether or not participating in this distribution, may be required to deliver a
Prospectus. This is in addition to the obligation of dealers to deliver a
Prospectus when acting as Underwriters and with respect to their unsold
allotments or subscriptions.
======================================================
======================================================
 
                               35,000,000 SHARES
                                  COMMON STOCK
 
                                  $180,000,000
                               5 3/4% CONVERTIBLE
                               SUBORDINATED NOTES
                                    DUE 2003
 
                                     AMKOR
                                TECHNOLOGY, INC.
 
                                  [AMKOR LOGO]
                                  ------------
 
                                   PROSPECTUS
 
                                 APRIL 30, 1998
 
                                  ------------
 
                              SALOMON SMITH BARNEY
                                 INTERNATIONAL
 
                             BA ROBERTSON STEPHENS
                             INTERNATIONAL LIMITED
 
                            COWEN INTERNATIONAL L.P.
 
======================================================


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission